9578b21a2978ccbe2459b08f9696e7c88869b68d
[exim.git] / doc / doc-docbook / spec.xfpt
1 . $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.29 2008/01/17 13:10:37 nm4 Exp $
2 .
3 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
5 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
6 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
7 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
8 .
9 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
10 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
11 . unwanted vertical space.
12 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
13
14 .include stdflags
15 .include stdmacs
16
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
19 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20
21 .docbook
22
23 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
25 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
26 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
27 . processors.
28 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29
30 .literal xml
31 <?sdop
32 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
33 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
34 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
35 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
36 ?>
37 .literal off
38
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
41 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42
43 .book
44
45 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
46 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
47 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
48 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
49
50 .set previousversion "4.69"
51 .set version "4.70"
52
53 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
54 .set I "&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;&nbsp;"
55
56
57 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
58 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
59 . provided in the xfpt library.
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61
62 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
63
64 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
65
66 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
67 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
68
69 .flag &!! "</emphasis>&dagger;<emphasis>"
70 .flag &!? "</emphasis>&Dagger;<emphasis>"
71
72 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
73 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
74 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
75 . --- index entry.
76
77 .macro option
78 .arg 5
79 .oindex "&%$5%&"
80 .endarg
81 .arg -5
82 .oindex "&%$1%&"
83 .endarg
84 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
85 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
86 .endtable
87 .endmacro
88
89 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
90 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
91 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
92
93 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
94 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
95 .endmacro
96
97 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
98 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
99 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
100
101 .macro irow
102 .arg 4
103 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
104 .endarg
105 .arg -4
106 .arg 3
107 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
108 .endarg
109 .arg -3
110 .row "&I;$1" "$2"
111 .endarg
112 .endarg
113 .endmacro
114
115 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
116 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
117 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
118 . --- ID that ties them together.
119
120 .macro cindex
121 &<indexterm role="concept">&
122 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
123 .arg 2
124 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
125 .endarg
126 &</indexterm>&
127 .endmacro
128
129 .macro scindex
130 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
131 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
132 .arg 3
133 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
134 .endarg
135 &</indexterm>&
136 .endmacro
137
138 .macro ecindex
139 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
140 .endmacro
141
142 .macro oindex
143 &<indexterm role="option">&
144 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
145 .arg 2
146 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
147 .endarg
148 &</indexterm>&
149 .endmacro
150
151 .macro vindex
152 &<indexterm role="variable">&
153 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
154 .arg 2
155 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
156 .endarg
157 &</indexterm>&
158 .endmacro
159
160 .macro index
161 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
162 .endmacro
163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
164
165
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
168 . output formats.
169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
170
171 .literal xml
172 <bookinfo>
173 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
174 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
175 <date>23 August 2007</date>
176 <author><firstname>Philip</firstname><surname>Hazel</surname></author>
177 <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
178 <affiliation><orgname>University of Cambridge Computing Service</orgname></affiliation>
179 <address>New Museums Site, Pembroke Street, Cambridge CB2 3QH, England</address>
180 <revhistory><revision>
181 <revnumber>4.68</revnumber>
182 <date>23 August 2007</date>
183 <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>2007</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
186 </bookinfo>
187 .literal off
188
189
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
191 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
192 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
193 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
194 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
195
196 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
197 .literal xml
198
199 <indexterm role="variable">
200 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
201 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
202 </indexterm>
203 <indexterm role="concept">
204 <primary>address</primary>
205 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
206 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
207 </indexterm>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
211 </indexterm>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
215 </indexterm>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CR character</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
219 </indexterm>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>CRL</primary>
222 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
223 </indexterm>
224 <indexterm role="concept">
225 <primary>delivery</primary>
226 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
227 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
228 </indexterm>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>dialup</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
232 </indexterm>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>exiscan</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
236 </indexterm>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>failover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
240 </indexterm>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>fallover</primary>
243 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
244 </indexterm>
245 <indexterm role="concept">
246 <primary>filter</primary>
247 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
248 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
249 </indexterm>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>ident</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
253 </indexterm>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>LF character</primary>
256 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
257 </indexterm>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>maximum</primary>
260 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
261 </indexterm>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>monitor</primary>
264 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
265 </indexterm>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
268 <see>entry for xxx</see>
269 </indexterm>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>NUL</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
273 </indexterm>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>passwd file</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
277 </indexterm>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>process id</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
281 </indexterm>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>RBL</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
285 </indexterm>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>redirection</primary>
288 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
289 </indexterm>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>return path</primary>
292 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
293 </indexterm>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>scanning</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
297 </indexterm>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>SSL</primary>
300 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
301 </indexterm>
302 <indexterm role="concept">
303 <primary>string</primary>
304 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
305 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
306 </indexterm>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>top bit</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
310 </indexterm>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>variables</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
314 </indexterm>
315 <indexterm role="concept">
316 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
317 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
318 </indexterm>
319
320 .literal off
321
322
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
324 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
325 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
326 . chapter "Introduction"
327 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
328
329 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
330 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
331 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
332 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
333
334 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
335 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
336 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
337 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
338 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
339 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
340 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
341
342 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
343 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
344 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
345
346 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
347 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
348 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
349
350 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
351 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
352 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
353 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
354 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
355
356 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
357 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
358 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
359 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
360 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
361
362 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
363 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
364 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
365 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
366 contributors.
367
368
369 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
370 .new
371 .cindex "documentation"
372 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
373 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
374 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
375 capable of showing a change indicator.
376 .wen
377
378 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
379 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
380 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
381 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
382 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
383 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
384 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
385 very wide interest.
386
387 .cindex "books about Exim"
388 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
389 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
390 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
391 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
392
393 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
394 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
395 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
396 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
397
398 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
399 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
400 Debian-specific features in the file
401 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
402 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
403 information.
404
405 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
406 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
407 .cindex "change log"
408 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
409 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
410 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
411 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
412 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
413
414 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
415 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
416 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
417 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
418
419 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
420 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
421
422 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
423 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
424 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
425 directory are:
426
427 .table2 100pt
428 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
429 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
430 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
431 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
432 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
433 .row &_pcrepattern.txt_& "specification of PCRE regular expressions"
434 .row &_pcretest.txt_& "specification of the PCRE testing program"
435 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
437 .endtable
438
439 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
440 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
441 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
442
443
444
445 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
446 .cindex "web site"
447 .cindex "FTP site"
448 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
449 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
450 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
451 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
452 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
453 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
454
455 .cindex "wiki"
456 .cindex "FAQ"
457 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
458 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459 online information is the Exim wiki &new("(&url(http://wiki.exim.org))"),
460 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
462
463 .cindex Bugzilla
464 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &new("&url(http://bugs.exim.org)"). You can use
465 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
467
468
469
470 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
473
474 .table2 140pt
475 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
476 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-future@exim.org'& "Discussion of long-term development"
479 .endtable
480
481 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
486 via this web page:
487 .display
488 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
489 .endd
490 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
491 lists.
492
493 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
494 .cindex "training courses"
495 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
496 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
497 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
498 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
499
500 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
501 .cindex "bug reports"
502 .cindex "reporting bugs"
503 Reports of obvious bugs &new("can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
504 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)).") However, if you are unsure
505 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
506 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
507
508
509
510 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
511 .cindex "FTP site"
512 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
513 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
514 .display
515 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
516 .endd
517 This is mirrored by
518 .display
519 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
520 .endd
521 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
522 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
523 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
524
525 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
526 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
527 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
528 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
529 .display
530 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz_&
531 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
532 .endd
533 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
534 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
535 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
536
537 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
538 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
539 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
540 The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
541 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
542 also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
543 in:
544 .display
545 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
546 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
547 .endd
548 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
549 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
550 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
551
552 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
553 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
554 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
555 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
556 .display
557 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
558 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
559 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
560 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
561 .endd
562 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
563 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
564
565
566 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
567 .ilist
568 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
569 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
570 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
571 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
572 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
573 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
574 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
575 .next
576 .cindex "domainless addresses"
577 .cindex "address" "without domain"
578 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
579 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
580 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
581 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
582 arrival.
583 .next
584 .cindex "transport" "external"
585 .cindex "external transports"
586 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
587 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
588 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
589 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
590 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
591 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
592 .next
593 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
594 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
595 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
596 other means.
597 .next
598 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
599 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
600 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
601 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
602 a number of common scanners are provided.
603 .endlist
604
605
606 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
607 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
608 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
609 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
610 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
611 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
612
613
614 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
615 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
616 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
617 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
618 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
619 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
620 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
621 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
622 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
623 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
624 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
625 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
626
627 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
628 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
629 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
630 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
631
632
633
634 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
635 .cindex "terminology definitions"
636 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
637 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
638 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
639 below) by a blank line.
640
641 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
642 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
643 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
644 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
645 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
646 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
647 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
648 rise to further bounce messages.
649
650 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
651 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
652 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
653 otherwise.
654
655 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
656 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
657 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
658 until a later time.
659
660 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
661 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
662 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
663
664 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
665 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
666 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
667 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
668 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
669 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
670 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
671 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
672
673 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
674 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
675 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
676 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
677 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
678 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
679 line.
680
681 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
682 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
683 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
684 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
685 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
686
687 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
688 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
689 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
690 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
691 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
692 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
693
694 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
695 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
696 message's envelope.
697
698 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
699 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
700 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
701 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
702 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
703
704 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
705 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
706 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
707 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
708 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
709
710 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
711 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
712 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
713 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
714 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
715 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
716
717
718
719
720
721
722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
723 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
724
725 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
726 .cindex "incorporated code"
727 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
728 .cindex "PCRE"
729 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
730
731 .ilist
732 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
733 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
734 &copy; University of Cambridge. The source to a cut down version of PCRE
735 used to be distributed in the directory &_src/pcre_&. However, this is
736 no longer the case and you will need to use a system PCRE library or
737 obtain and install the full version of the library from
738 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
739 .next
740 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
741 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
742 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
743 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
744 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
745 following statements:
746
747 .blockquote
748 Copyright &copy; 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
749
750 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
751 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
752 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
753 version.
754 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
755 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
756 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
757 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
758 restrictions applied to it).
759 .endblockquote
760 .next
761 .cindex "SPA authentication"
762 .cindex "Samba project"
763 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
764 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
765 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
766 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
767 under the Gnu GPL.
768 .next
769 .cindex "Cyrus"
770 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
771 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
772 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
773 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
774 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
775 conditions expressed therein.
776
777 .blockquote
778 Copyright &copy; 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
779
780 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
781 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
782 are met:
783
784 .olist
785 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
786 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
787 .next
788 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
789 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
790 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
791 distribution.
792 .next
793 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
794 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
795 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
796 details, please contact
797 .display
798 Office of Technology Transfer
799 Carnegie Mellon University
800 5000 Forbes Avenue
801 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
802 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
803 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
804 .endd
805 .next
806 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
807 acknowledgment:
808
809 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
810 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
811
812 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
813 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
814 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
815 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
816 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
817 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
818 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
819 .endlist
820 .endblockquote
821
822 .next
823 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
824 .cindex "X-windows"
825 .cindex "Athena"
826 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
827 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
828 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
829 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
830
831 .blockquote
832 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
833 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
834
835 All Rights Reserved
836
837 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
838 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
839 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
840 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
841 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
842 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
843 software without specific, written prior permission.
844
845 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
846 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
847 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
848 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
849 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
850 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
851 SOFTWARE.
852 .endblockquote
853
854 .next
855 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
856 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
857 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
858 .endlist
859
860
861
862
863
864 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
865 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
866
867 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
868 "Receiving and delivering mail"
869
870
871 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
872 .cindex "design philosophy"
873 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
874 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
875 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
876 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
877 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
878 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
879
880
881 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
882 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
883 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
884 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
885 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
886 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
887 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
888
889 .ilist
890 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
891 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
892 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
893 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
894 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
895 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
896 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
897 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
898 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
899 error code.
900 .next
901 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
902 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
903 .next
904 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
905 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
906 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
907 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
908 .next
909 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
910 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
911 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
912 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
913 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
914 .next
915 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
916 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
917 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
918 .next
919 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
920 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
921 runs at the start of every delivery process.
922 .endlist
923
924
925
926 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
927 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
928 .cindex "Sieve filter"
929 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
930 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
931 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
932 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
933 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
934 of filtering are available:
935
936 .ilist
937 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
938 by RFC 3028.
939 .next
940 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
941 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
942 .endlist
943
944 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
945
946
947
948 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
949 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
950 .cindex "format" "of message id"
951 .cindex "id of message"
952 .cindex "base62"
953 .cindex "base36"
954 .cindex "Darwin"
955 .cindex "Cygwin"
956 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
957 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
958 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
959 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
960 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
961 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
962 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
963 not always case-sensitive.
964
965 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
966 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
967 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
968 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
969 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
970 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
971 somewhat eccentric:
972
973 .ilist
974 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
975 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
976 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
977 way of representing the date and time of day).
978 .next
979 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
980 received the message.
981 .next
982 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
983 .olist
984 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
985 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
986 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
987 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
988 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
989 .next
990 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
991 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
992 (1/100) of a second.
993 .endlist
994 .endlist
995
996 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
997 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
998 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
999 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1000 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1001
1002
1003 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1004 .cindex "receiving mail"
1005 .cindex "message" "reception"
1006 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1007 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1008 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1009 there are several possibilities:
1010
1011 .ilist
1012 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1013 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1014 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1015 .next
1016 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1017 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1018 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1019 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1020 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1021 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1022 .next
1023 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1024 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1025 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1026 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1027 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1028 .next
1029 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1030 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1031 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1032 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1033 .endlist
1034
1035
1036 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1037 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1038 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1039 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1040 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1041 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1042 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1043 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1044 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1045 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1046 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1047 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1048 users to change sender addresses.
1049
1050 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1051 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1052 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1053 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1054 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1055 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1056 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1057
1058 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1059 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1060 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1061 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1062 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1063 message is received.
1064
1065
1066
1067
1068
1069 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1070 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1071 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1072 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1073 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1074 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1075 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1076 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1077
1078 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1079 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1080 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1081 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1082 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1083 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1084 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1085 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1086 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1087 affect file system performance.
1088
1089 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1090 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1091 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1092 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1093 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1094
1095 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1096 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1097 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1098 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1099 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1100 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1101 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1102 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1103 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1104 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1105 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1106 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1107
1108
1109
1110 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1111 .cindex "message" "life of"
1112 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1113 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1114 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1115 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1116 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1117 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1118 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1119
1120 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1121 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1122 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1123 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1124 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1125 to be sent.
1126
1127 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1128 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1129 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1130 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1131 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1132
1133 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1134 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1135 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1136 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1137 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1138 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1139 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1140 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1141 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1142 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1143 systems.
1144
1145 .cindex "journal file"
1146 .cindex "file" "journal"
1147 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1148 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1149 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1150 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1151 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1152 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1153 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1154 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1155
1156 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1157 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1158 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1159 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1160 deliveries caused by crashes.
1161
1162
1163
1164 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1165 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1166 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1167 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1168 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1169 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1170 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1171 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1172 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1173
1174 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1175 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1176 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1177 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1178 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1179 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1180 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1181 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1182 the driver's features in general.
1183
1184 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1185 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1186 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1187 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1188 to be bounced.
1189
1190 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1191 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1192 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1193 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1194 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1195 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1196
1197 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1198 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1199 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1200 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1201 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1202 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1203
1204 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1205 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1206 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1207 configuration.
1208
1209 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1210 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1211 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1212 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1213 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1214 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1215 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1216 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1217 configured to fail the address.
1218
1219 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1220 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1221 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1222 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1223 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1224 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1225
1226 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1227 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1228 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1229 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1230 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1231 the address is bounced.
1232
1233
1234
1235 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1236 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1237 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1238 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1239 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1240 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1241 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1242 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1243
1244 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1245 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1246 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1247 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1248 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1249 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1250 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1251 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1252
1253
1254
1255
1256 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1257 .cindex "router" "running details"
1258 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1259 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1260 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1261 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1262 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1263 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1264 the following:
1265
1266 .ilist
1267 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1268 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1269 original address ceases,
1270 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1271 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1272 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1273 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1274 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1275 end of routing.
1276
1277 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1278 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1279 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1280 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1281 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1282 .next
1283 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1284 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1285 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1286 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1287 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1288 .next
1289 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1290 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1291 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1292 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1293 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1294 .next
1295 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1296 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1297 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1298 .next
1299 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1300 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1301 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1302 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1303 .next
1304 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1305 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1306 .endlist
1307
1308 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1309 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1310 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1311 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1312 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1313
1314 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1315 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1316 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1317 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1318 facility for this purpose.
1319
1320
1321 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1322 .cindex "case of local parts"
1323 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1324 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1325 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1326 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1327 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1328 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1329 routed addresses are shown.
1330
1331
1332
1333 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1334 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1335 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1336 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1337 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1338 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1339
1340 .ilist
1341 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1342 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1343 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1344 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1345 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1346 of any other conditions.
1347 .next
1348 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1349 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1350 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1351 address.
1352 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1353 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1354 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1355 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1356 .next
1357 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1358 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1359 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1360 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1361 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1362 .next
1363 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1364 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1365 .next
1366 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1367 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1368 .next
1369 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1370 of domains that it defines.
1371 .next
1372 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1373 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1374 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1375 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1376 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1377 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1378 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1379 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1380 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1381 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1382 .next
1383 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1384 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1385 .vindex "&$home$&"
1386 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1387 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1388 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1389 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1390 remaining preconditions.
1391 .next
1392 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1393 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1394 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1395 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1396 could lead to confusion.
1397 .next
1398 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1399 set of addresses that it defines.
1400 .next
1401 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1402 specified files is tested.
1403 .next
1404 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1405 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1406 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1407 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1408 .endlist
1409
1410
1411 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1412 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1413 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1414 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1415 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1416 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1417 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1418
1419
1420
1421 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1422 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1423 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1424
1425 .ilist
1426 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1427 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1428 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1429 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1430 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1431 filtering'&.
1432 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1433 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1434
1435 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1436 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1437 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1438 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1439 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1440 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1441 filter.
1442 .next
1443 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1444 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1445 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1446 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1447 processed entirely independently of each other.
1448 .next
1449 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1450 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1451 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1452 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1453 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1454 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1455 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1456 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1457 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1458 .next
1459 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1460 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1461 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1462 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1463 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1464 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1465 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1466 addresses to the same domain.
1467 .next
1468 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1469 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1470 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1471 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1472 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1473 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1474 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1475 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1476 .next
1477 .cindex "queue runner"
1478 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1479 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1480 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1481 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1482 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1483 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1484 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1485 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1486 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1487 .next
1488 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1489 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1490 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1491 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1492 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1493 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1494 .next
1495 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1496 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1497 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1498 messages to other addresses.
1499 .next
1500 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1501 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1502 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1503 &'deferred'&.
1504 .next
1505 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1506 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1507 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1508 .endlist
1509
1510
1511
1512
1513 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1514 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1515 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1516 .cindex "queue runner"
1517 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1518 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1519 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1520 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1521 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1522 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1523 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1524 passed its retry time.
1525 You can run several queue runners at once.
1526
1527 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1528 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1529 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1530 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1531 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1532 as permanent.
1533
1534
1535
1536 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1537 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1538 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1539 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1540 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1541 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1542 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1543 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1544 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1545 also apply.
1546
1547 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1548 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1549 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1550 deferred,
1551
1552 .cindex "hints database"
1553 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1554 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1555 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1556 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1557 one connection.
1558
1559
1560
1561
1562 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1563 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1564 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1565 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1566 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1567 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1568 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1569 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1570 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1571 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1572 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1573
1574 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1575 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1576 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1577 automatically.
1578
1579 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1580 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1581 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1582 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1583 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1584 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1585 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1586 of the list.
1587
1588
1589
1590 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1591 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1592 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1593 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1594 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1595 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1596 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1597 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1598
1599
1600
1601
1602
1603 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1604 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1605
1606 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1607 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1608
1609 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1610 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1611 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1612 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1613
1614 .table2 140pt
1615 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1616 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1617 documented"
1618 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1619 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1620 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1621 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1622 instructions"
1623 .endtable
1624
1625 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1626 following subdirectories are created:
1627
1628 .table2 140pt
1629 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1630 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1631 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1632 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1633 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1634 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1635 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1636 .endtable
1637
1638 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1639 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1640 that may be useful to some sites.
1641
1642
1643 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1644 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1645 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1646 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1647 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1648 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1649 system.
1650 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1651 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1652 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1653 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1654 overridden if necessary.
1655
1656
1657 .section "PCRE library" "SECTdb"
1658 .cindex "PCRE library"
1659 Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
1660 modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
1661 to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
1662 system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
1663 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1664 headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
1665 and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
1666 PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
1667 from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
1668
1669 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1670 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1671 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1672 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1673 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1674 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1675 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1676
1677 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1678 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1679 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1680 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1681 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1682 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1683 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1684 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1685
1686 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1687 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1688 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1689 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1690 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1691 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1692 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1693 Berkeley DB library.
1694
1695 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1696 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1697 possibilities:
1698
1699 .olist
1700 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1701 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1702 .next
1703 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1704 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1705 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1706 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1707 file name is used unmodified.
1708 .next
1709 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1710 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1711 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1712 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1713 .next
1714 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1715 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1716 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1717 .next
1718 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1719 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1720 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1721 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1722 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1723 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1724 .next
1725 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1726 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1727 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1728 operates on a single file.
1729 .endlist
1730
1731 .cindex "USE_DB"
1732 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1733 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1734 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1735 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1736 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1737 .code
1738 USE_DB=yes
1739 .endd
1740 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1741 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1742
1743 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1744 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1745 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1746 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1747 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1748 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1749
1750 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1751 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1752 in one of these lines:
1753 .code
1754 DBMLIB = -ldb
1755 DBMLIB = -ltdb
1756 .endd
1757 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1758 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1759 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1760 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1761 this example:
1762 .code
1763 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1764 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1765 .endd
1766 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1767 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1768
1769
1770
1771 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1772 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1773 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1774 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1775 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1776 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1777 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1778 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1779 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1780 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1781 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1782 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1783
1784 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1785 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1786 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1787 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1788 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1789 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1790
1791 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1792 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1793 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1794 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1795 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1796 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1797 be logged.
1798
1799 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1800 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1801 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1802 facilities, you need to set
1803 .code
1804 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1805 .endd
1806 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1807 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1808
1809
1810 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1811 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1812 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1813 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1814 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1815 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1816 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1817
1818 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1819 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1820 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1821 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1822 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1823 do this.
1824
1825
1826
1827 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1828 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1829 .cindex "RFC 2047"
1830 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1831 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1832 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1833 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1834 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1835 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1836 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1837
1838 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1839 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1840 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1841 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1842 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1843 .code
1844 HAVE_ICONV=yes
1845 .endd
1846 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1847
1848
1849
1850 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1851 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1852 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1853 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1854 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1855 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1856 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1857 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1858 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1859 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1860 line option).
1861
1862 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1863 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1864 implementing SSL.
1865
1866 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1867 .code
1868 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1869 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1870 .endd
1871 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1872 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1873 .code
1874 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1875 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1876 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1877 .endd
1878 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1879 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1880 .code
1881 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1882 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1883 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1884 .endd
1885 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1886 library and include files. For example:
1887 .code
1888 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
1889 USE_GNUTLS=yes
1890 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1891 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1892 .endd
1893 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1894 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1895 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1896
1897
1898
1899
1900 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1901 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1902 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1903 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1904 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1905 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1906 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1907 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1908 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1909 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1910 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1911 you might have
1912 .code
1913 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1914 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1915 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1916 .endd
1917 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control files is
1918 &"exim"&. For example, the line
1919 .code
1920 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1921 .endd
1922 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1923 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1924 All other connections are denied. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1925 further details.
1926
1927
1928
1929 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1930 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1931 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1932 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1933 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1934 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1935 library files.
1936
1937 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1938 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1939 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1940 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1941 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1942 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1943 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1944 support has not been tested for some time.
1945
1946
1947
1948 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1949 .cindex "build directory"
1950 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1951 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1952 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1953 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1954 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
1955 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
1956 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1957
1958 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
1959 building process fails if it is set.
1960
1961 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
1962 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1963 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1964 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1965 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1966 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
1967 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1968 directory, should this ever be necessary.
1969
1970 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1971 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
1972 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
1973
1974
1975
1976 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
1977 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
1978 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
1979 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
1980 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
1981 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
1982 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
1983 .code
1984 FULLECHO='' make -e
1985 .endd
1986 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
1987 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
1988 given in addition to the short output.
1989
1990
1991
1992 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
1993 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
1994 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
1995 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
1996 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
1997 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
1998 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
1999 order:
2000 .display
2001 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2002 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2003 &_Local/Makefile_&
2004 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2005 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2006 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2007 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2008 .endd
2009 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2010 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2011 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2012 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2013 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2014 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2015 and are often not needed.
2016
2017 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2018 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2019 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2020 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2021 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2022 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2023 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2024 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2025 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2026
2027
2028 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2029 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2030 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2031 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2032 default values are.
2033
2034
2035 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2036 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2037 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2038 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2039 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2040 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2041 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2042 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2043 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2044 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2045 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2046 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2047 containing the lines
2048 .code
2049 CC=cc
2050 CFLAGS=-std1
2051 .endd
2052 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2053 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2054
2055 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2056 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2057 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2058
2059
2060 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2061 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2062 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2063 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2064 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2065 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2066 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2067 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2068 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2069 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2070 .code
2071 LOOKUP_LDAP=yes
2072 LOOKUP_NIS=yes
2073 LOOKUP_NISPLUS=yes
2074 .endd
2075 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2076 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2077 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2078 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2079 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2080 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2081 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2082 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2083 errors.
2084
2085 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2086 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2087 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2088 .code
2089 EXIM_PERL=perl.o
2090 .endd
2091 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2092 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2093
2094 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2095 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2096 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2097 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2098 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2099 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2100 .code
2101 X11=/usr/X11R6
2102 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2103 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2104 .endd
2105 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2106 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2107 .code
2108 X11=/usr/openwin
2109 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2110 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2111 .endd
2112 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2113 definition of all three of these variables into your
2114 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2115
2116 .cindex "EXTRALIBS"
2117 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2118 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2119 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2120 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2121
2122 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2123 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2124 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2125 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2126 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2127 libraries.
2128
2129 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2130 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2131 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2132 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2133 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2134
2135
2136 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2137 .cindex "&_os.h_&"
2138 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2139 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2140 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2141 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2142 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2143 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2144
2145
2146
2147 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2148 .cindex "building Eximon"
2149 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2150 where the files that are involved are
2151 .display
2152 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2153 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2154 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2155 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2156 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2157 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2158 .endd
2159 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2160 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2161 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2162 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2163 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2164 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2165 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2166 .ecindex IIDbuex
2167
2168
2169 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2170 .cindex "installing Exim"
2171 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2172 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2173 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2174 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2175 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2176 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2177 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2178 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2179 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2180 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2181 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2182 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2183
2184 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2185 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2186 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2187 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2188 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2189 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2190 alternative files, no default is installed.
2191
2192 .cindex "system aliases file"
2193 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2194 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2195 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2196 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2197 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2198 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2199 and outputs a comment to the user.
2200
2201 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2202 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2203 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2204 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2205 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2206
2207 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2208 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2209 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2210 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2211 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2212 over SMTP.
2213
2214 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2215 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2216 command such as
2217 .code
2218 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2219 .endd
2220 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2221 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2222 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2223 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2224 but this usage is deprecated.
2225
2226 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2227 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2228 &'convert4r4'&, or the &'pcretest'& test program. You will probably run the
2229 first of these only once (if you are upgrading from Exim 3), and the second
2230 isn't really part of Exim. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2231 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2232 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2233
2234 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2235 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2236 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2237 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2238 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2239 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2240 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2241
2242 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2243 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2244 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2245 command:
2246 .code
2247 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2248 .endd
2249 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2250 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2251 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2252 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2253 command:
2254 .code
2255 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2256 .endd
2257 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2258 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2259
2260 .ilist
2261 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2262 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2263 .next
2264 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2265 installed binary.
2266 .endlist
2267
2268 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2269 .code
2270 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2271 .endd
2272 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2273 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2274 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2275 .code
2276 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2277 .endd
2278
2279
2280
2281 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2282 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2283 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2284 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2285 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2286 &<<SECTavail>>&).
2287
2288 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2289 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2290 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2291
2292
2293
2294 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2295 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2296 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2297 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2298 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2299 necessary.
2300
2301
2302
2303
2304 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2305 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2306 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2307 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2308 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2309 .code
2310 exim -bV
2311 .endd
2312 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2313 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2314 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2315 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2316 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2317 example,
2318 .display
2319 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2320 .endd
2321 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2322 .display
2323 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2324 .endd
2325 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2326 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2327 user agent. For example:
2328 .code
2329 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2330 From: user@your.domain.example
2331 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2332 Subject: Testing Exim
2333
2334 This is a test message.
2335 ^D
2336 .endd
2337 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2338 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2339 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2340
2341 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2342 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2343 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2344 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2345 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2346 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2347 .display
2348 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2349 .endd
2350 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2351 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2352 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2353 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2354 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2355
2356 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2357 .cindex "lock files"
2358 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2359 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2360 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2361 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2362 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2363 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2364 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2365 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2366 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2367 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2368 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2369 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2370
2371 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2372 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2373 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2374 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2375 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2376 incoming SMTP mail.
2377
2378 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2379 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2380 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2381 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2382 production version.
2383
2384
2385 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2386 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2387 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2388 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2389 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2390 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2391 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2392 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2393 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2394 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2395 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2396 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2397 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2398
2399 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2400 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2401 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2402 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2403 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2404 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2405 as follows:
2406 .code
2407 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2408 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2409 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2410 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2411 .endd
2412 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2413 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2414 favourite user agent.
2415
2416 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2417 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2418 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2419 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2420 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2421 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2422
2423
2424
2425 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2426 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2427 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2428 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2429 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2430 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2431 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2432 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2433 configuration file.
2434
2435
2436
2437
2438 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2439 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2440 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2441 .code
2442 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2443 .endd
2444 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2445 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2446 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2447 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2448 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2449 .code
2450 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2451 .endd
2452 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2453
2454 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2455 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2456 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2457
2458
2459
2460
2461 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2462 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2463
2464 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2465 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2466 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2467 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2468 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2469 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2470 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2471 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2472 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2473
2474
2475 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2476 .cindex "&'mailq'&"
2477 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2478 were present before any other options.
2479 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2480 standard output.
2481 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2482 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2483 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2484
2485 .cindex "&'rsmtp'&"
2486 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2487 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2488 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2489 format.
2490
2491 .cindex "&'rmail'&"
2492 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2493 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2494 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2495
2496 .cindex "&'runq'&"
2497 .cindex "queue runner"
2498 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2499 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2500 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2501
2502 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2503 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2504 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2505 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2506 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2507 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2508 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2509 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2510
2511
2512 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2513 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2514 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2515 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2516 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2517 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2518
2519 .ilist
2520 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2521 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2522 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2523 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2524 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2525 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2526
2527 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2528 .cindex "envelope sender"
2529 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2530 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2531 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2532 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2533 users to set envelope senders.
2534
2535 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2536 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2537 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2538 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2539 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2540
2541 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2542 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2543 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2544 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2545 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2546 that are available to trusted users.
2547 .next
2548 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2549 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2550 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2551 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2552 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2553
2554 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2555 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2556 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2557 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2558
2559 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2560 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2561 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2562 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2563
2564 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2565 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2566 false.
2567 .endlist
2568
2569
2570 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2571 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2572 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2573 &<<CHAPconf>>&.
2574
2575
2576
2577
2578 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2579 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2580 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2581 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2582 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2583 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2584 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2585 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2586
2587 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2588 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2589 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2590 . creates a man page for the options.
2591 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2592
2593 .literal xml
2594 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2595 .literal off
2596
2597
2598 .vlist
2599 .vitem &%--%&
2600 .oindex "--"
2601 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2602 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2603 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2604 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2605
2606 .vitem &%--help%&
2607 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2608 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2609 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2610 no arguments.
2611
2612 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2613 .oindex "&%-B%&"
2614 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2615 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2616 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2617 clean; it ignores this option.
2618
2619 .vitem &%-bd%&
2620 .oindex "&%-bd%&"
2621 .cindex "daemon"
2622 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2623 .cindex "queue runner"
2624 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2625 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2626 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2627
2628 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2629 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2630 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2631 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2632
2633 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2634 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2635 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2636 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2637
2638 When a listening daemon
2639 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2640 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2641 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2642 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2643 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2644 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2645 running as root.
2646
2647 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2648 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2649 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2650
2651 The SIGHUP signal
2652 .cindex "SIGHUP"
2653 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2654 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2655 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2656 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2657 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2658 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2659 because these are reread each time they are used.
2660
2661 .vitem &%-bdf%&
2662 .oindex "&%-bdf%&"
2663 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2664 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2665
2666 .vitem &%-be%&
2667 .oindex "&%-be%&"
2668 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2669 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2670 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2671 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2672 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2673 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2674
2675 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2676 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2677 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2678 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2679 test data. A line history is supported.
2680
2681 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2682 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2683 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2684 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2685 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2686 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2687 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2688
2689 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2690 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2691 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2692 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2693
2694 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2695 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
2696 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2697 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2698 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2699 of a file. For example:
2700 .code
2701 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2702 .endd
2703 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2704 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2705 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2706 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2707 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2708 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2709 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2710 &%-be%&).
2711
2712 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2713 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
2714 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2715 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2716 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2717 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2718 system filters are recognized.
2719
2720 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2721 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
2722 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2723 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2724 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2725 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2726 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2727 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2728 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2729 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2730 supplied.
2731
2732 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2733 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2734 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2735 .code
2736 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2737 .endd
2738 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2739 variables that are used by the user filter.
2740
2741 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2742 .code
2743 # Exim filter
2744 # Sieve filter
2745 .endd
2746 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2747 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2748 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2749 redirection lists.
2750
2751 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2752 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2753 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2754 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2755
2756 When testing a filter file,
2757 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2758 .cindex "envelope sender"
2759 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2760 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2761 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2762 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2763 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2764 options).
2765
2766 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2767 .oindex "&%-bfd%&"
2768 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2769 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2770 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2771 &$qualify_domain$&.
2772
2773 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2774 .oindex "&%-bfl%&"
2775 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2776 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2777 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2778 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2779 actually being delivered.
2780
2781 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2782 .oindex "&%-bfp%&"
2783 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2784 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2785 prefix.
2786
2787 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2788 .oindex "&%-bfs%&"
2789 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2790 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2791 suffix.
2792
2793 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2794 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
2795 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2796 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2797 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2798 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2799 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2800 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2801 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2802 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2803 after a full stop. For example:
2804 .code
2805 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2806 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2807 .endd
2808 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2809 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2810 conversion to the canonical form is
2811 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2812
2813 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2814 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2815 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2816 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2817 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2818
2819 &*Warning 1*&:
2820 .cindex "RFC 1413"
2821 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2822 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2823 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2824 connection.
2825
2826 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2827 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2828 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2829
2830 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2831 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2832 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2833 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2834 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2835 session were authenticated.
2836
2837 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2838 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2839 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2840
2841 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2842 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2843 specialized SMTP test program such as
2844 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2845
2846 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2847 .oindex "&%-bhc%&"
2848 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2849 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2850 updating the callout cache database.
2851
2852 .vitem &%-bi%&
2853 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
2854 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2855 .cindex "building alias file"
2856 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2857 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2858 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2859 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2860 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2861 recognized.
2862
2863 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2864 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2865 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2866 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2867 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2868 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2869 &%-bi%& is a no-op.
2870
2871 .vitem &%-bm%&
2872 .oindex "&%-bm%&"
2873 .cindex "local message reception"
2874 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2875 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2876 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2877 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2878 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2879 if no other conflicting option is present.
2880
2881 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2882 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2883 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2884 suppressing this for special cases.
2885
2886 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2887 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2888
2889 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2890 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2891 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2892
2893 The format
2894 .cindex "message" "format"
2895 .cindex "format" "message"
2896 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2897 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2898 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2899 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2900 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2901 .code
2902 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2903 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2904 .endd
2905 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2906 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2907 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2908 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2909 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2910
2911 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2912 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2913 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2914 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2915 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2916
2917 .vitem &%-bnq%&
2918 .oindex "&%-bnq%&"
2919 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2920 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2921 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2922 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2923 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2924 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2925 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2926
2927 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
2928 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2929 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2930 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2931 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2932
2933 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2934 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2935 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2936 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2937
2938
2939 .vitem &%-bP%&
2940 .oindex "&%-bP%&"
2941 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
2942 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
2943 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2944 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2945 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2946 arguments, for example:
2947 .code
2948 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2949 .endd
2950 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
2951 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
2952 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
2953 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
2954 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2955 users, the output is as in this example:
2956 .code
2957 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2958 .endd
2959 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2960 configuration file is output.
2961 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2962 is the name of the file that was actually used.
2963
2964 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2965 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2966 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
2967 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
2968 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
2969 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
2970 written directly into the spool directory.
2971
2972 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
2973 .code
2974 exim -bP +local_domains
2975 .endd
2976 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
2977 local part) and outputs what it finds.
2978
2979 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
2980 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
2981 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
2982 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
2983 that driver are output. For example:
2984 .code
2985 exim -bP transport local_delivery
2986 .endd
2987 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
2988 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
2989 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
2990 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
2991 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
2992 &%authenticators%&.
2993
2994
2995 .vitem &%-bp%&
2996 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
2997 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
2998 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
2999 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3000 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3001 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3002 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3003 to allow any user to see the queue.
3004
3005 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3006 .code
3007 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3008 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3009 <other addresses>
3010 .endd
3011 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3012 .cindex "size" "of message"
3013 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3014 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3015 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3016 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3017 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3018 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3019 before the sender address.
3020
3021 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3022 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3023 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3024
3025 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3026 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3027 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3028 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3029 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3030 complete.
3031
3032
3033 .vitem &%-bpa%&
3034 .oindex "&%-bpa%&"
3035 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3036 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3037 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3038 of just &"D"&.
3039
3040
3041 .vitem &%-bpc%&
3042 .oindex "&%-bpc%&"
3043 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3044 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3045 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3046 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3047
3048
3049 .vitem &%-bpr%&
3050 .oindex "&%-bpr%&"
3051 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3052 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3053 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3054 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3055
3056 .vitem &%-bpra%&
3057 .oindex "&%-bpra%&"
3058 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3059
3060 .vitem &%-bpru%&
3061 .oindex "&%-bpru%&"
3062 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3063
3064
3065 .vitem &%-bpu%&
3066 .oindex "&%-bpu%&"
3067 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3068 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3069 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3070 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3071
3072
3073 .vitem &%-brt%&
3074 .oindex "&%-brt%&"
3075 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3076 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3077 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3078 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3079 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3080 .code
3081 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3082 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3083 .endd
3084 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3085 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3086 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3087 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3088 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3089 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3090 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3091 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3092 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3093 .code
3094 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3095 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3096 .endd
3097
3098 .vitem &%-brw%&
3099 .oindex "&%-brw%&"
3100 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3101 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3102 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3103 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3104 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3105 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3106 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3107
3108 .vitem &%-bS%&
3109 .oindex "&%-bS%&"
3110 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3111 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3112 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3113 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3114 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3115 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3116 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3117 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3118 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3119
3120 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3121 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3122 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3123
3124 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3125 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3126 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3127 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3128
3129 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3130 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3131 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3132
3133 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3134 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3135 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3136 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3137 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3138
3139 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3140 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3141
3142 .vitem &%-bs%&
3143 .oindex "&%-bs%&"
3144 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3145 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3146 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3147 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3148 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3149 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3150 messages to the MTA.
3151
3152 In
3153 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3154 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3155 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3156 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3157 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3158 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3159 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3160
3161 .cindex "inetd"
3162 The
3163 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3164 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3165 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3166 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3167 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3168 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3169 the listening daemon.
3170
3171 .vitem &%-bt%&
3172 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
3173 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3174 .cindex "address" "testing"
3175 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3176 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3177 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3178 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3179 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3180
3181 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3182 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3183
3184 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3185 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3186 security issues.
3187
3188 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3189 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3190 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3191 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3192 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3193 program.
3194
3195 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3196 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3197 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3198 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3199
3200 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3201 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3202 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3203 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3204 always shown.
3205
3206 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3207 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3208 message,
3209 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3210 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3211 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3212 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3213 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3214 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3215 doing such tests.
3216
3217 .vitem &%-bV%&
3218 .oindex "&%-bV%&"
3219 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3220 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3221 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3222 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3223 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3224 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3225
3226 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3227 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3228 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3229 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3230 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3231 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3232 dynamic testing facilities.
3233
3234 .vitem &%-bv%&
3235 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
3236 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3237 .cindex "address" "verification"
3238 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3239 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3240 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3241 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3242 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3243 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3244
3245 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3246 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3247 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3248
3249 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3250 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3251
3252 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3253 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3254 security issues.
3255
3256 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3257 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3258 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3259 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3260 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3261
3262 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3263 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3264 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3265 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3266 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3267 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3268 to succeed.
3269
3270 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3271 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3272 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3273
3274 The
3275 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3276 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3277 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3278 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3279
3280 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3281 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3282 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3283 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3284
3285 .vitem &%-bvs%&
3286 .oindex "&%-bvs%&"
3287 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3288 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3289 might happen.
3290
3291 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3292 .oindex "&%-C%&"
3293 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3294 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3295 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3296 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3297 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3298 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3299 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3300 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3301 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3302
3303 When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3304 list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3305 immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3306 the caller. However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in
3307 &_Local/Makefile_&, root privilege is retained for &%-C%& only if the caller of
3308 Exim is root.
3309
3310 That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3311 option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3312 However, if you are using a &"packaged"& version of Exim (source or binary),
3313 the packagers might have enabled it.
3314
3315 Setting ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY locks out the possibility of testing a
3316 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
3317 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
3318 as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the delivery,
3319 the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception
3320 and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue,
3321 using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3322
3323 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3324 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3325 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3326 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3327 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3328 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3329 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3330
3331 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3332 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3333 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3334 configuration file.
3335
3336 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3337 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3338 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3339 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3340 specified by this option.
3341
3342 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3343 .oindex "&%-D%&"
3344 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3345 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3346 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3347 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3348 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3349 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3350
3351 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3352 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3353 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3354 synonymous:
3355 .code
3356 exim -DABC ...
3357 exim -DABC= ...
3358 .endd
3359 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3360 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3361 example:
3362 .code
3363 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3364 .endd
3365 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3366
3367 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3368 .oindex "&%-d%&"
3369 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3370 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3371 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3372 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3373 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3374 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3375 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3376 return code.
3377
3378 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3379 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3380 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3381 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3382 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3383 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3384 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3385 are:
3386 .display
3387 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3388 &`auth `& authenticators
3389 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3390 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3391 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3392 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3393 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3394 &`filter `& filter handling
3395 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3396 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3397 &`ident `& ident lookup
3398 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3399 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3400 &`load `& system load checks
3401 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3402 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3403 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3404 &`memory `& memory handling
3405 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3406 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3407 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3408 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3409 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3410 &`retry `& retry handling
3411 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3412 &`route `& address routing
3413 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3414 &`tls `& TLS logic
3415 &`transport `& transports
3416 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3417 &`verify `& address verification logic
3418 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3419 .endd
3420 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3421 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3422 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3423 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3424 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3425 turn everything off.
3426
3427 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3428 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3429 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3430 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3431 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3432 rather than stderr.
3433
3434 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3435 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3436 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3437 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3438 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3439 run in parallel.
3440
3441 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3442 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3443 in processing.
3444
3445 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3446 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3447
3448 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3449 .oindex "&%-dd%&"
3450 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3451 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3452 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3453 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3454
3455 .vitem &%-dropcr%&
3456 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3457 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3458 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3459 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3460
3461 .vitem &%-E%&
3462 .oindex "&%-E%&"
3463 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3464 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3465 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3466 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3467 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3468 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3469 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3470 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3471
3472 .vitem &%-e%&&'x'&
3473 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3474 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3475 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3476 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3477 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3478
3479 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3480 .oindex "&%-F%&"
3481 .cindex "sender" "name"
3482 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3483 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3484 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3485 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3486 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3487 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3488
3489 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3490 .oindex "&%-f%&"
3491 .cindex "sender" "address"
3492 .cindex "address" "sender"
3493 .cindex "trusted users"
3494 .cindex "envelope sender"
3495 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3496 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3497 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3498 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3499 users to use it.
3500
3501 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3502 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3503 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3504 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3505 domain.
3506
3507 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3508 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3509 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3510 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3511 examples of shell commands:
3512 .code
3513 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3514 exim -f "" user@domain
3515 .endd
3516 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3517 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3518 &%-bv%& options.
3519
3520 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3521 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3522 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3523 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3524
3525 White
3526 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3527 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3528 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3529 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3530 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3531 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3532
3533 .vitem &%-G%&
3534 .oindex "&%-G%&"
3535 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3536 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3537
3538 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3539 .oindex "&%-h%&"
3540 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3541 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3542 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3543 headers.)
3544
3545 .vitem &%-i%&
3546 .oindex "&%-i%&"
3547 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3548 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3549 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3550 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3551 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3552 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3553
3554 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3555 .oindex "&%-M%&"
3556 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3557 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3558 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3559 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3560 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3561 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3562 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3563
3564 Retry
3565 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3566 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3567 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3568 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3569 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3570 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3571
3572 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3573 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3574 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3575 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3576
3577 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3578 .oindex "&%-Mar%&"
3579 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3580 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3581 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3582 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3583 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3584 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3585 can be used only by an admin user.
3586
3587 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3588 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3589 .oindex "&%-MC%&"
3590 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3591 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3592 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3593 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3594 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3595 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3596 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3597 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3598
3599 .vitem &%-MCA%&
3600 .oindex "&%-MCA%&"
3601 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3602 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3603 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3604
3605 .vitem &%-MCP%&
3606 .oindex "&%-MCP%&"
3607 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3608 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3609 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3610
3611 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3612 .oindex "&%-MCQ%&"
3613 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3614 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3615 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3616 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3617 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3618 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3619
3620 .vitem &%-MCS%&
3621 .oindex "&%-MCS%&"
3622 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3623 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3624 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3625 connection.
3626
3627 .vitem &%-MCT%&
3628 .oindex "&%-MCT%&"
3629 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3630 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3631 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3632
3633 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3634 .oindex "&%-Mc%&"
3635 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3636 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3637 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3638 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3639 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3640 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3641 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3642 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3643 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3644 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3645 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3646 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3647 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3648
3649 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3650 .oindex "&%-Mes%&"
3651 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3652 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3653 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3654 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3655 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3656 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3657 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3658 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3659
3660 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3661 .oindex "&%-Mf%&"
3662 .cindex "freezing messages"
3663 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3664 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3665 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3666 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3667 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3668 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3669 user.
3670
3671 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3672 .oindex "&%-Mg%&"
3673 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3674 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3675 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3676 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3677 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3678 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3679 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3680 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3681 user.
3682
3683 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3684 .oindex "&%-Mmad%&"
3685 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3686 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3687 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3688 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3689 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3690
3691 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3692 .oindex "&%-Mmd%&"
3693 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3694 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3695 .cindex "removing recipients"
3696 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3697 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3698 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3699 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3700 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3701 can be used only by an admin user.
3702
3703 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3704 .oindex "&%-Mrm%&"
3705 .cindex "removing messages"
3706 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3707 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3708 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3709 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3710 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3711 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3712 placed on the queue.
3713
3714 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3715 .oindex "&%-Mset%&
3716 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3717 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3718 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3719 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3720 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3721 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3722 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3723 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3724 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3725
3726 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3727 .oindex "&%-Mt%&"
3728 .cindex "thawing messages"
3729 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3730 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3731 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3732 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3733 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3734 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3735 by an admin user.
3736
3737 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3738 .oindex "&%-Mvb%&"
3739 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3740 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3741 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3742 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3743
3744 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3745 .oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
3746 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3747 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2922 format"
3748 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3749 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3750 only by an admin user.
3751
3752 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3753 .oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
3754 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3755 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3756 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3757 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3758 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3759
3760 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3761 .oindex "&%-Mvl%&"
3762 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3763 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3764 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3765 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3766
3767 .vitem &%-m%&
3768 .oindex "&%-m%&"
3769 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3770 treats it that way too.
3771
3772 .vitem &%-N%&
3773 .oindex "&%-N%&"
3774 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3775 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3776 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3777 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3778 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3779 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3780 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3781 than &"=>"&.
3782
3783 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3784 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3785 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3786 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3787 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3788 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3789 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3790 for that message.
3791
3792 .vitem &%-n%&
3793 .oindex "&%-n%&"
3794 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3795 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3796 by Exim.
3797
3798 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3799 .oindex "&%-O%&"
3800 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3801 Exim.
3802
3803 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3804 .oindex "&%-oA%&"
3805 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3806 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3807 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3808 description above.
3809
3810 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3811 .oindex "&%-oB%&"
3812 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3813 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3814 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3815 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3816 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3817 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3818
3819 .vitem &%-odb%&
3820 .oindex "&%-odb%&"
3821 .cindex "background delivery"
3822 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3823 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3824 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3825 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3826 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3827 processes to finish.
3828
3829 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3830 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3831 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3832 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3833
3834 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3835 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3836 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3837 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3838
3839 .vitem &%-odf%&
3840 .oindex "&%-odf%&"
3841 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3842 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3843 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3844 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3845 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3846 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3847
3848 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3849 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3850 during deliveries.
3851
3852 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3853 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3854
3855 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3856 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3857 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3858 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3859
3860
3861 .vitem &%-odi%&
3862 .oindex "&%-odi%&"
3863 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3864 Sendmail.
3865
3866 .vitem &%-odq%&
3867 .oindex "&%-odq%&"
3868 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3869 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3870 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3871 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3872 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3873 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3874 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3875 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3876 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3877 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3878 forces queueing.
3879
3880 .vitem &%-odqs%&
3881 .oindex "&%-odqs%&"
3882 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3883 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3884 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3885 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3886 configuration file is in effect.
3887
3888 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3889 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3890 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3891 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3892 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3893 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3894 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3895 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
3896 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3897 &%-qq%& option.
3898
3899 .vitem &%-oee%&
3900 .oindex "&%-oee%&"
3901 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3902 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3903 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3904 message.
3905
3906 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
3907 Provided
3908 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3909 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3910 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3911 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3912
3913 .vitem &%-oem%&
3914 .oindex "&%-oem%&"
3915 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3916 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
3917 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3918 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3919 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3920
3921 .vitem &%-oep%&
3922 .oindex "&%-oep%&"
3923 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3924 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3925 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3926 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
3927 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3928
3929 .vitem &%-oeq%&
3930 .oindex "&%-oeq%&"
3931 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3932 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3933 effect as &%-oep%&.
3934
3935 .vitem &%-oew%&
3936 .oindex "&%-oew%&"
3937 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3938 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3939 effect as &%-oem%&.
3940
3941 .vitem &%-oi%&
3942 .oindex "&%-oi%&"
3943 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3944 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
3945 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
3946 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
3947 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
3948 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
3949
3950 .vitem &%-oitrue%&
3951 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
3952 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
3953
3954 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
3955 .oindex "&%-oMa%&"
3956 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
3957 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
3958 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3959 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3960 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
3961 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3962
3963 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
3964 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3965 .code
3966 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3967 .endd
3968 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
3969 followed by a colon and the port number:
3970 .code
3971 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3972 .endd
3973 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
3974 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
3975 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
3976 whichever one is last.
3977
3978 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
3979 .oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
3980 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
3981 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
3982 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
3983 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
3984 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
3985 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
3986
3987 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
3988 .oindex "&%-oMai%&"
3989 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
3990 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
3991 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
3992 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
3993 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
3994 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
3995
3996 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
3997 .oindex "&%-oMas%&"
3998 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
3999 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4000 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4001 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4002 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4003 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4004 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4005 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4006
4007 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4008 .oindex "&%-oMi%&"
4009 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4010 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4011 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4012 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4013 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4014
4015 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4016 .oindex "&%-oMr%&"
4017 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4018 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4019 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4020 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4021 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4022 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4023 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4024 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4025 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4026 be set by &%-oMr%&.
4027
4028 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4029 .oindex "&%-oMs%&"
4030 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4031 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4032 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4033 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4034 uses the name it is given.
4035
4036 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4037 .oindex "&%-oMt%&"
4038 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4039 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4040 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4041 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4042 used, when there is no default.
4043
4044 .vitem &%-om%&
4045 .oindex "&%-om%&"
4046 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4047 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4048 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4049 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4050
4051 .vitem &%-oo%&
4052 .oindex "&%-oo%&"
4053 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4054 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4055 whatever that means.
4056
4057 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4058 .oindex "&%-oP%&"
4059 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4060 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4061 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4062 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4063 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4064 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4065 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4066
4067 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4068 .oindex "&%-or%&"
4069 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4070 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4071 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4072 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4073 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4074
4075 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4076 .oindex "&%-os%&"
4077 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4078 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4079 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4080 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4081 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4082 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4083
4084 .vitem &%-ov%&
4085 .oindex "&%-ov%&"
4086 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4087
4088 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4089 .oindex "&%-oX%&"
4090 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4091 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4092 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4093 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4094 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4095 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4096 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4097 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4098
4099 .vitem &%-pd%&
4100 .oindex "&%-pd%&"
4101 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4102 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4103 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4104 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4105 needed.
4106
4107 .vitem &%-ps%&
4108 .oindex "&%-ps%&"
4109 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4110 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4111 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4112 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4113 started.
4114
4115 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4116 .oindex "&%-p%&"
4117 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4118 .display
4119 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4120 .endd
4121 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4122 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4123 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4124 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4125 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4126
4127 .vitem &%-q%&
4128 .oindex "&%-q%&"
4129 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4130 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4131 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4132 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4133 and &%-S%& options).
4134
4135 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4136 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4137 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4138 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4139 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4140 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4141
4142 If
4143 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4144 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4145 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4146 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4147 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4148 proceeding.
4149
4150 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4151 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4152 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4153 this to be repeated periodically.
4154
4155 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4156 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4157 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4158 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4159
4160 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4161 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4162 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4163
4164 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4165 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4166 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4167 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4168
4169 .vitem &%-qq...%&
4170 .oindex "&%-qq%&"
4171 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4172 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4173 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4174 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4175 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4176 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4177 transports are run.
4178
4179 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4180 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4181 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4182 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4183 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4184 delivered down a single SMTP
4185 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4186 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4187 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4188 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4189 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4190 intermittently.
4191
4192 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4193 .oindex "&%-qi%&"
4194 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4195 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4196 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4197 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4198 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4199
4200 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4201 .oindex "&%-qf%&"
4202 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4203 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4204 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4205 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4206 their retry times are tried.
4207
4208 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4209 .oindex "&%-qff%&"
4210 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4211 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4212 frozen or not.
4213
4214 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4215 .oindex "&%-ql%&"
4216 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4217 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4218 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4219 for later delivery.
4220
4221 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4222 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4223 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4224 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4225 starting message id. For example:
4226 .code
4227 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4228 .endd
4229 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4230 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4231 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4232 .code
4233 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4234 .endd
4235 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4236 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4237 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4238 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4239 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4240 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4241
4242 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4243 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4244 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4245 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4246 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4247 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4248 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4249 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4250 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4251 .code
4252 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4253 .endd
4254 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4255 process every 30 minutes.
4256
4257 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4258 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4259
4260 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4261 .oindex "&%-qR%&"
4262 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4263 compatibility.
4264
4265 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4266 .oindex "&%-qS%&"
4267 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4268
4269 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4270 .oindex "&%-R%&"
4271 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4272 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4273 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4274 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4275 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4276 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4277 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4278
4279 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4280 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4281 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4282 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4283 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4284 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4285
4286 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4287 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4288 .code
4289 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4290 .endd
4291 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4292 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4293 applied to each queue run.
4294
4295 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4296 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4297 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4298 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4299 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4300 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4301 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4302 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4303 address will be skipped.
4304
4305 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4306 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4307 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4308 &'ff'& is present.
4309
4310 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4311 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4312 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4313 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4314 an arbitrary command instead.
4315
4316 .vitem &%-r%&
4317 .oindex "&%-r%&"
4318 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4319
4320 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4321 .oindex "&%-S%&"
4322 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4323 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4324 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4325 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4326 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4327 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4328
4329 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4330 .oindex "&%-Tqt%&"
4331 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4332 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4333 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4334
4335 .vitem &%-t%&
4336 .oindex "&%-t%&"
4337 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4338 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4339 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4340 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4341 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4342 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4343 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4344 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4345 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4346
4347 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4348 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4349 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4350 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4351 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4352 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4353 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4354 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4355 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4356 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4357 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4358
4359 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4360 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4361 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4362 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4363 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4364 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4365
4366 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4367 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4368 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4369 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4370 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4371 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4372 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4373 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4374 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4375
4376 .vitem &%-ti%&
4377 .oindex "&%-ti%&"
4378 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4379 compatibility with Sendmail.
4380
4381 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4382 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4383 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4384 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4385 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4386 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4387 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4388 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4389
4390
4391 .vitem &%-U%&
4392 .oindex "&%-U%&"
4393 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4394 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4395 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4396 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4397 set. Exim ignores this option.
4398
4399 .vitem &%-v%&
4400 .oindex "&%-v%&"
4401 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4402 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4403 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4404 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4405 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4406 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4407 unconditional.
4408
4409 .vitem &%-x%&
4410 .oindex "&%-x%&"
4411 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4412 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4413 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4414 this option.
4415 .endlist
4416
4417 .ecindex IIDclo1
4418 .ecindex IIDclo2
4419
4420
4421 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4422 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4423 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4424 . creates a man page for the options.
4425 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4426
4427 .literal xml
4428 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4429 .literal off
4430
4431
4432
4433
4434
4435 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4436 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4437
4438
4439 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4440 "The runtime configuration file"
4441
4442 .cindex "run time configuration"
4443 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4444 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4445 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4446 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4447 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4448 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4449 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4450 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4451 control.
4452
4453 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4454 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4455 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4456 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4457 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4458 actually alter the string.
4459
4460 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4461 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4462 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4463 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4464 existing file in the list.
4465
4466 .cindex "EXIM_USER"
4467 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4468 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4469 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4470 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4471 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4472 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4473 specified at compile time by the EXIM_USER option, or by the user that is
4474 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4475 configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
4476 group is the one specified at compile time by the EXIM_GROUP option or by the
4477 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4478
4479 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4480 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4481 easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
4482 of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
4483 configuration is not group writeable.
4484
4485 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4486 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4487 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4488 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4489 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4490 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4491 configuration.
4492
4493
4494
4495 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4496 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4497 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4498 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4499 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the
4500 Exim user (or unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value
4501 from CONFIGURE_FILE). &%-C%& is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4502 configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4503 on a configuration file specified by &%-C%&.
4504
4505 The privileged use of &%-C%& by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4506 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. However,
4507 if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4508 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
4509 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
4510 as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4511 use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4512 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
4513 &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
4514
4515 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4516 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4517 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4518 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4519 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4520
4521 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4522 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4523 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4524 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4525 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4526 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4527
4528 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4529 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4530 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4531 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4532 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4533 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4534 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4535
4536 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4537 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4538 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4539
4540
4541
4542 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4543 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4544 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4545 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4546 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4547 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4548 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4549 optional parts are:
4550
4551 .ilist
4552 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4553 &<<CHAPACL>>&).
4554 .next
4555 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4556 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4557 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4558 .next
4559 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4560 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4561 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4562 .next
4563 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4564 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4565 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4566 .next
4567 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4568 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4569 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4570 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4571 &<<CHAPretry>>&.
4572 .next
4573 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4574 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4575 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4576 .next
4577 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4578 want to use this feature, you must set
4579 .code
4580 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4581 .endd
4582 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4583 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4584 .endlist
4585
4586 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4587 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4588 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4589 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4590
4591 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4592 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4593 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4594 and does not introduce a comment.
4595
4596 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4597 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4598 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4599 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4600 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4601
4602 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4603 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4604 change settings as required.
4605
4606 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4607 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4608 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4609 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4610 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4611 described.
4612
4613
4614
4615 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4616 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4617 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4618 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4619 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4620 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4621 using this syntax:
4622 .display
4623 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4624 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4625 .endd
4626 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4627 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4628 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4629 name is required.
4630
4631 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4632 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4633 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4634 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4635
4636 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4637 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4638 for example:
4639 .code
4640 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4641 .include /some/file
4642 .endd
4643 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4644 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4645 inclusion appears.
4646
4647
4648
4649 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4650 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4651 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4652 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4653 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4654 definition, and must be of the form
4655 .display
4656 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4657 .endd
4658 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4659 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4660 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4661 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4662 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4663
4664 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4665 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4666 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4667
4668 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4669 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4670 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4671 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4672 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4673 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4674 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4675 define
4676 .display
4677 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4678 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4679 .endd
4680 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4681 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4682 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4683 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4684 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4685 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4686
4687
4688 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4689 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4690 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4691 &'='&. For example:
4692 .code
4693 MAC = initial value
4694 ...
4695 MAC == updated value
4696 .endd
4697 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4698 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4699 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4700 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4701 .code
4702 MAC = initial value
4703 ...
4704 MAC == MAC and something added
4705 .endd
4706 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4707 from a number of other files.
4708
4709 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4710 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4711 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4712 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4713 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4714 file to be ignored.
4715
4716
4717
4718 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4719 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4720 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4721 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4722 .code
4723 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4724 login=${quote_mysql:$local_part};
4725 .endd
4726 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4727 .code
4728 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4729 .endd
4730 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4731 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4732 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4733
4734
4735 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4736 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4737 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4738 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4739 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4740 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4741 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4742
4743 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4744 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4745 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4746 line. Thus:
4747 .code
4748 .ifdef AAA
4749 message_size_limit = 50M
4750 .else
4751 message_size_limit = 100M
4752 .endif
4753 .endd
4754 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4755 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4756 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4757 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4758
4759 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4760 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4761 in this line"& will always be true.
4762
4763 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4764 to clarify complicated nestings.
4765
4766
4767
4768 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4769 .cindex "common option syntax"
4770 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4771 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4772 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4773 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4774 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4775 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4776 space) and then the value. For example:
4777 .code
4778 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4779 .endd
4780 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4781 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4782 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4783 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4784 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4785 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4786 word &"hide"&. For example:
4787 .code
4788 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4789 .endd
4790 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4791 .code
4792 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4793 .endd
4794 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4795 all instances of the same driver.
4796
4797 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4798 that are found in option settings.
4799
4800
4801 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4802 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4803 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4804 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4805 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4806 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4807 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4808 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4809 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4810 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4811 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4812 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4813 .code
4814 queue_only
4815 queue_only = true
4816 .endd
4817 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4818 .code
4819 no_queue_only
4820 queue_only = false
4821 .endd
4822 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4823
4824
4825
4826
4827 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4828 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4829 .cindex "format" "integer"
4830 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4831 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4832 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4833 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4834 hexadecimal number.
4835
4836 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4837 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4838 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4839 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4840 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4841 used.
4842
4843
4844 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4845 .cindex "integer format"
4846 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4847 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4848 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4849 Such options are always output in octal.
4850
4851
4852 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4853 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4854 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
4855 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4856 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4857
4858
4859
4860 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4861 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4862 .cindex "format" "time interval"
4863 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4864 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4865
4866 .table2 30pt
4867 .irow &%s%& seconds
4868 .irow &%m%& minutes
4869 .irow &%h%& hours
4870 .irow &%d%& days
4871 .irow &%w%& weeks
4872 .endtable
4873
4874 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4875 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4876 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
4877
4878
4879
4880 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
4881 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
4882 .cindex "format" "string"
4883 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
4884 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
4885 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
4886 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
4887 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
4888 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
4889 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
4890 therefore equivalent:
4891 .code
4892 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4893 trusted_users = uucp:\
4894 # This comment line is ignored
4895 mail
4896 .endd
4897 .cindex "string" "quoted"
4898 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
4899 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4900 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4901 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4902
4903 .table2 100pt
4904 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
4905 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
4906 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
4907 .irow &`\t`& "tab"
4908 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
4909 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
4910 character"
4911 .endtable
4912
4913 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4914 character, that character replaces the pair.
4915
4916 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4917 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4918 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4919 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4920 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4921 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4922
4923
4924 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
4925 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
4926 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
4927 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4928 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
4929 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
4930 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
4931 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
4932 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
4933 within a quoted configuration string.
4934
4935
4936 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
4937 .cindex "user name" "format of"
4938 .cindex "format" "user name"
4939 .cindex "groups" "name format"
4940 .cindex "format" "group name"
4941 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4942 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4943 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4944 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
4945
4946
4947 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
4948 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
4949 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
4950 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
4951 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4952 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
4953 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
4954 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
4955 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
4956 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
4957 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
4958
4959 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4960 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
4961 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
4962 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
4963 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4964 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4965 example, the list
4966 .code
4967 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
4968 .endd
4969 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
4970
4971 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
4972 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
4973 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
4974 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
4975
4976 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
4977 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
4978 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
4979 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
4980 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
4981 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
4982 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
4983 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
4984 .code
4985 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
4986 .endd
4987 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
4988 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
4989 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
4990
4991 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
4992 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
4993 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
4994 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
4995 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
4996 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
4997 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
4998 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
4999 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5000 .code
5001 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5002 .endd
5003 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5004 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5005 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5006 the value in quotes. For example:
5007 .code
5008 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5009 .endd
5010 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5011 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5012 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5013 enclosing an empty list item.
5014
5015
5016
5017 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5018 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5019 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5020 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5021 .code
5022 senders = user@domain :
5023 .endd
5024 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5025 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5026 items, the second of which is empty:
5027 .code
5028 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5029 .endd
5030 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5031 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5032 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5033 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5034 .code
5035 senders = :
5036 .endd
5037 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5038 is at the end of the list.
5039
5040
5041
5042
5043 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5044 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5045 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5046 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5047 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5048 a sequence of lines like this:
5049 .display
5050 <&'instance name'&>:
5051 <&'option'&>
5052 ...
5053 <&'option'&>
5054 .endd
5055 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5056 followed by three options settings:
5057 .code
5058 localuser:
5059 driver = accept
5060 check_local_user
5061 transport = local_delivery
5062 .endd
5063 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5064 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5065 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5066 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5067 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5068 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5069
5070 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5071 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5072
5073 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5074 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5075 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5076 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5077 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5078 server.
5079
5080 .cindex "generic options"
5081 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5082 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5083 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5084 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5085 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5086 .cindex "private options"
5087 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5088 they all have default values.
5089
5090 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5091 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5092 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5093
5094 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5095 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5096 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5097 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5098 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5099 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5100 configuration lines:
5101 .code
5102 remote_smtp:
5103 driver = smtp
5104 .endd
5105 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5106 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5107 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5108 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5109 thus:
5110 .code
5111 special_smtp:
5112 driver = smtp
5113 port = 1234
5114 command_timeout = 10s
5115 .endd
5116 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5117 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5118 lines.
5119
5120 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5121 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5122 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5123 option.
5124
5125
5126
5127
5128
5129
5130 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5131 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5132
5133 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5134 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5135 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5136 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5137 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5138 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5139 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5140 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5141 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5142 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5143 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5144
5145
5146
5147 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5148 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5149 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5150 the line
5151 .code
5152 # primary_hostname =
5153 .endd
5154 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5155 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5156 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5157 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5158
5159 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5160 .code
5161 domainlist local_domains = @
5162 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5163 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5164 .endd
5165 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5166 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5167 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5168 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5169
5170 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5171 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5172 on the local host.
5173
5174 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5175 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5176 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5177 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5178 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5179 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5180
5181 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5182 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5183 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5184 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5185 domain is permitted.
5186
5187 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5188 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5189 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5190 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5191 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5192 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5193
5194 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5195 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5196 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5197
5198 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5199 .code
5200 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5201 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5202 .endd
5203 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5204 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5205 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5206 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5207 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5208 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5209 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5210 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5211 contents of a message to be checked.
5212
5213 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5214 .code
5215 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5216 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5217 .endd
5218 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5219 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5220 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5221 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5222
5223 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5224 .code
5225 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5226 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5227 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5228 .endd
5229 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5230 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5231 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5232 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5233 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5234 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5235 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5236
5237 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5238 .code
5239 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5240 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5241 .endd
5242 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5243 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5244 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5245 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5246 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5247 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5248 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5249 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5250 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5251 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5252 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5253 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5254 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5255 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5256 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5257 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5258
5259 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5260 .code
5261 # qualify_domain =
5262 # qualify_recipient =
5263 .endd
5264 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5265 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5266 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5267 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5268 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5269 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5270
5271 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5272 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5273 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5274 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5275 .code
5276 # allow_domain_literals
5277 .endd
5278 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5279 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5280 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5281 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5282 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5283 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5284
5285 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5286 .code
5287 never_users = root
5288 .endd
5289 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5290 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5291 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5292 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5293 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5294 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5295 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5296 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5297
5298 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5299 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5300 line,
5301 .code
5302 host_lookup = *
5303 .endd
5304 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5305 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5306 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5307 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5308 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5309 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5310 unreachable.
5311
5312 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5313 1413 (hence their names):
5314 .code
5315 rfc1413_hosts = *
5316 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5317 .endd
5318 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5319 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5320 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5321 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5322 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5323 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5324 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5325
5326 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5327 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5328 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5329 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5330 .code
5331 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5332 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5333 .endd
5334 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5335 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5336
5337 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5338 .code
5339 # percent_hack_domains =
5340 .endd
5341 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5342 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5343 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5344
5345 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5346 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5347 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5348 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5349 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5350 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5351 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5352 always bounce messages.
5353 .code
5354 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5355 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5356 .endd
5357 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5358 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5359 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5360 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5361 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5362
5363
5364
5365 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5366 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5367 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5368 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5369 It starts with the line
5370 .code
5371 begin acl
5372 .endd
5373 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5374 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5375 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5376
5377 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5378 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5379 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5380 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5381 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5382 result of the ACL processing.
5383 .code
5384 acl_check_rcpt:
5385 .endd
5386 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5387 ACL, and names it.
5388 .code
5389 accept hosts = :
5390 .endd
5391 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5392 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5393 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5394 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5395 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5396 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5397
5398 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5399 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5400 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5401 manner.
5402 .code
5403 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5404 domains = +local_domains
5405 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5406
5407 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5408 domains = !+local_domains
5409 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5410 .endd
5411 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5412 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5413 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5414 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5415 in Internet mail addresses.
5416
5417 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5418 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5419 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5420 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5421 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5422 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5423 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5424 policy of being as safe as possible.
5425
5426 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5427 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5428 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5429 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5430 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5431 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5432
5433 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5434 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5435 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5436 have to modify this rule.
5437
5438 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5439 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5440 common convention of local parts constructed as
5441 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5442 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5443 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5444 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5445 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5446 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5447
5448 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5449 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5450 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5451 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5452 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5453 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5454 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5455 .code
5456 accept local_parts = postmaster
5457 domains = +local_domains
5458 .endd
5459 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5460 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5461 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5462 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5463 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5464
5465 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5466 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5467 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5468 .code
5469 require verify = sender
5470 .endd
5471 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5472 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5473 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5474 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5475 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5476 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5477 discusses the details of address verification.
5478 .code
5479 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5480 control = submission
5481 .endd
5482 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5483 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5484 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5485 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5486 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5487 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5488 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5489 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5490 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5491 .code
5492 accept authenticated = *
5493 control = submission
5494 .endd
5495 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5496 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5497 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5498 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5499 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5500 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5501 .code
5502 require message = relay not permitted
5503 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5504 .endd
5505 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5506 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5507 .code
5508 require verify = recipient
5509 .endd
5510 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5511 fails, the address is rejected.
5512 .code
5513 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5514 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5515 # $dnslist_text
5516 # dnslists = black.list.example
5517 #
5518 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5519 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5520 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5521 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5522 .endd
5523 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5524 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5525 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5526 line.
5527 .code
5528 # require verify = csa
5529 .endd
5530 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5531 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5532 records.
5533 .code
5534 accept
5535 .endd
5536 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5537 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5538 .code
5539 acl_check_data:
5540 .endd
5541 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5542 of this ACL are commented out:
5543 .code
5544 # deny malware = *
5545 # message = This message contains a virus \
5546 # ($malware_name).
5547 .endd
5548 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5549 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5550 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5551 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5552 .code
5553 # warn spam = nobody
5554 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5555 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5556 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5557 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5558 .endd
5559 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5560 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5561 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5562 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5563 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5564 whatever the spam score.
5565 .code
5566 accept
5567 .endd
5568 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5569
5570
5571 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5572 .cindex "default" "routers"
5573 .cindex "routers" "default"
5574 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5575 by the line
5576 .code
5577 begin routers
5578 .endd
5579 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5580 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5581 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5582 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5583 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5584 .code
5585 # domain_literal:
5586 # driver = ipliteral
5587 # domains = !+local_domains
5588 # transport = remote_smtp
5589 .endd
5590 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5591 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5592 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5593 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5594 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5595 .code
5596 dnslookup:
5597 driver = dnslookup
5598 domains = ! +local_domains
5599 transport = remote_smtp
5600 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5601 no_more
5602 .endd
5603 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5604 domains. This is specified by the line
5605 .code
5606 domains = ! +local_domains
5607 .endd
5608 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5609 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5610 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5611 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5612 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5613 passed on to the following routers.
5614
5615 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5616 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5617 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5618 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5619 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5620
5621 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5622 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5623 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5624 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5625 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5626 the address fails and is bounced.
5627
5628 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5629 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5630 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5631 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5632 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5633 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5634 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5635 out.
5636 .code
5637 system_aliases:
5638 driver = redirect
5639 allow_fail
5640 allow_defer
5641 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5642 # user = exim
5643 file_transport = address_file
5644 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5645 .endd
5646 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5647 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5648 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5649 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5650 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5651 the next router.
5652
5653 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5654 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5655 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5656 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5657 .code
5658 userforward:
5659 driver = redirect
5660 check_local_user
5661 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5662 # local_part_suffix_optional
5663 file = $home/.forward
5664 # allow_filter
5665 no_verify
5666 no_expn
5667 check_ancestor
5668 file_transport = address_file
5669 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5670 reply_transport = address_reply
5671 .endd
5672 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5673 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5674 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5675 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5676 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5677 namely:
5678 .code
5679 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5680 # local_part_suffix_optional
5681 .endd
5682 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5683 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5684 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5685 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5686 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5687 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5688 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5689
5690 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5691 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5692 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5693 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5694
5695 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5696 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5697 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5698 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5699 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5700 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5701 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5702
5703 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5704 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5705 There are two reasons for doing this:
5706
5707 .olist
5708 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5709 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5710 unnecessary work.
5711 .next
5712 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5713 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5714 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5715 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5716 this time.
5717 .endlist
5718
5719 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5720 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5721 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5722 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5723
5724 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5725 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5726 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5727 .code
5728 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5729 .endd
5730 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5731 transport.
5732 .code
5733 localuser:
5734 driver = accept
5735 check_local_user
5736 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5737 # local_part_suffix_optional
5738 transport = local_delivery
5739 .endd
5740 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5741 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5742 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5743 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5744 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5745
5746
5747 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5748 .cindex "default" "transports"
5749 .cindex "transports" "default"
5750 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5751 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5752 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5753 .code
5754 begin transports
5755 .endd
5756 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5757 .code
5758 remote_smtp:
5759 driver = smtp
5760 .endd
5761 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5762 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5763 .code
5764 local_delivery:
5765 driver = appendfile
5766 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5767 delivery_date_add
5768 envelope_to_add
5769 return_path_add
5770 # group = mail
5771 # mode = 0660
5772 .endd
5773 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5774 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5775 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5776 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5777 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5778 show how this can be done.
5779
5780 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5781 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5782 similarly-named options above.
5783 .code
5784 address_pipe:
5785 driver = pipe
5786 return_output
5787 .endd
5788 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5789 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5790 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5791 sender.
5792 .code
5793 address_file:
5794 driver = appendfile
5795 delivery_date_add
5796 envelope_to_add
5797 return_path_add
5798 .endd
5799 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5800 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5801 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5802 .code
5803 address_reply:
5804 driver = autoreply
5805 .endd
5806 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5807 filter files.
5808
5809
5810
5811 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5812 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5813 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5814 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5815 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5816 introduced by the line
5817 .code
5818 begin retry
5819 .endd
5820 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5821 errors:
5822 .code
5823 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5824 .endd
5825 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5826 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5827 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5828 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5829
5830 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5831 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5832 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5833
5834
5835 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5836 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5837 .code
5838 begin rewrite
5839 .endd
5840 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5841 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5842
5843
5844
5845 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5846 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5847 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5848 .code
5849 begin authenticators
5850 .endd
5851 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5852 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5853 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5854 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5855 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5856 to support most MUA software.
5857
5858 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5859 .code
5860 #PLAIN:
5861 # driver = plaintext
5862 # server_set_id = $auth2
5863 # server_prompts = :
5864 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5865 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5866 .endd
5867 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5868 .code
5869 #LOGIN:
5870 # driver = plaintext
5871 # server_set_id = $auth1
5872 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5873 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5874 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5875 .endd
5876
5877 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
5878 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
5879 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
5880 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
5881 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
5882 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
5883 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
5884 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
5885
5886 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
5887 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
5888 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
5889 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
5890
5891 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
5892
5893
5894
5895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5896 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5897
5898 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
5899
5900 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
5901 .cindex "PCRE"
5902 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5903 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5904 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5905 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5906 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
5907 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
5908
5909 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5910 are supported by PCRE is included in plain text in the file
5911 &_doc/pcrepattern.txt_& in the Exim distribution, and also in the HTML
5912 tarbundle of Exim documentation. It describes in detail the features of the
5913 regular expressions that PCRE supports, so no further description is included
5914 here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using the default option settings
5915 (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that the PCRE_CASELESS option is
5916 set when the matching is required to be case-insensitive.
5917
5918 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5919 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5920 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5921 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5922 .code
5923 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5924 .endd
5925 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5926 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
5927 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5928 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5929 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5930 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
5931 matched.
5932
5933 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5934 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
5935 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
5936 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
5937 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
5938 match anywhere in the subject string.
5939
5940 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5941 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5942 .code
5943 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5944 .endd
5945 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
5946 You need to use:
5947 .code
5948 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5949 .endd
5950 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
5951 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
5952
5953
5954
5955 .section "Testing regular expressions" "SECID59"
5956 .cindex "testing" "regular expressions"
5957 .cindex "regular expressions" "testing"
5958 .cindex "&'pcretest'&"
5959 A program called &'pcretest'& forms part of the PCRE distribution and is built
5960 with PCRE during the process of building Exim. It is primarily intended for
5961 testing PCRE itself, but it can also be used for experimenting with regular
5962 expressions. After building Exim, the binary can be found in the build
5963 directory (it is not installed anywhere automatically). There is documentation
5964 of various options in &_doc/pcretest.txt_&, but for simple testing, none are
5965 needed. This is the output of a sample run of &'pcretest'&:
5966 .display
5967 &` re> `&&*&`/^([@]+)@.+\.(ac|edu)\.(?!kr)[a-z]{2}$/`&*&
5968 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.ac.uk`&*&
5969 &` 0: x@y.ac.uk`&
5970 &` 1: x`&
5971 &` 2: ac`&
5972 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.ac.kr`&*&
5973 &`No match`&
5974 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.edu.com`&*&
5975 &`No match`&
5976 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.edu.co`&*&
5977 &` 0: x@y.edu.co`&
5978 &` 1: x`&
5979 &` 2: edu`&
5980 .endd
5981 Input typed by the user is shown in bold face. After the &"re>"& prompt, a
5982 regular expression enclosed in delimiters is expected. If this compiles without
5983 error, &"data>"& prompts are given for strings against which the expression is
5984 matched. An empty data line causes a new regular expression to be read. If the
5985 match is successful, the captured substring values (that is, what would be in
5986 the variables &$0$&, &$1$&, &$2$&, etc.) are shown. The above example tests for
5987 an email address whose domain ends with either &"ac"& or &"edu"& followed by a
5988 two-character top-level domain that is not &"kr"&. The local part is captured
5989 in &$1$& and the &"ac"& or &"edu"& in &$2$&.
5990
5991
5992
5993
5994
5995
5996 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5997 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5998
5999 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6000 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6001 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6002 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6003 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6004 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6005
6006 .olist
6007 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6008 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6009 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6010 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6011 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6012 .next
6013 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6014 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6015 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6016 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6017 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6018 .endlist
6019
6020 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6021 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6022 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6023 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6024 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6025 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6026
6027 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6028 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6029 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6030 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6031 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6032 .code
6033 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6034 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6035 .endd
6036 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6037 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6038 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6039 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6040 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6041 .code
6042 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6043 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6044 .endd
6045 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6046 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6047
6048 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6049 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6050 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6051 .code
6052 domain1:
6053 domain2:
6054 .endd
6055 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6056 matches the list item.
6057
6058 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6059 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6060 .code
6061 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6062 .endd
6063 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6064 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6065 causes a second lookup to occur.
6066
6067 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6068 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6069 lookup is permitted.
6070
6071
6072 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6073 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6074 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6075 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6076
6077 .ilist
6078 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6079 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6080 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6081 .next
6082 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6083 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6084 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6085 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6086 .endlist
6087
6088 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6089 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6090 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6091 .code
6092 LOOKUP_DBM=yes
6093 LOOKUP_LSEARCH=yes
6094 .endd
6095 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6096 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6097 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6098
6099
6100
6101
6102 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6103 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6104 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6105 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6106
6107 .ilist
6108 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6109 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6110 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6111 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6112 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6113 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6114 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6115 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6116 be found in several places:
6117 .display
6118 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6119 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6120 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6121 .endd
6122 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6123 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6124 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6125 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6126 .next
6127 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6128 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6129 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6130 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6131 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6132 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6133 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6134
6135 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6136 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6137 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6138 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6139 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6140 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6141 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6142 .next
6143 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6144 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6145 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6146 .cindex "Courier"
6147 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6148 .cindex "dmbnz lookup type"
6149 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6150 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6151 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6152 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6153 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6154 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6155 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6156 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6157 .next
6158 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6159 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6160 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6161 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6162 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6163 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6164 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6165 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6166 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6167 .next
6168 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6169 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6170 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6171 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6172 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6173 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6174 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6175 .code
6176 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6177 192.168.0.0/16 data for 192.168.0.0/16
6178 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6179 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6180 .endd
6181 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6182 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6183 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6184 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6185 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6186
6187 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6188 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6189 lookup types support only literal keys.
6190
6191 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6192 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6193 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6194 .next
6195 .cindex "linear search"
6196 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6197 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6198 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6199 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6200 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6201 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6202 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6203 in the file is used.
6204
6205 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6206 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6207 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6208 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6209 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6210 colon, for example:
6211 .code
6212 baduser: :fail:
6213 .endd
6214 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6215 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6216 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6217 wildcarding of any kind.
6218
6219 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6220 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6221 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6222 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6223 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6224 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6225 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6226 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6227 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6228
6229 .next
6230 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6231 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6232 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6233 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6234 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6235 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6236 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6237 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6238
6239 .next
6240 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6241 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6242 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6243 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6244 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6245 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6246 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6247 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6248 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6249
6250 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6251 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6252 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6253 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6254
6255 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6256 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6257
6258 .olist
6259 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6260 .code
6261 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6262 *fish data for anythingfish
6263 .endd
6264 .next
6265 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6266 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6267 .code
6268 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6269 .endd
6270 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6271 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6272 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6273 .code
6274 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6275 .endd
6276 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6277 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6278 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6279 .code
6280 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6281 .endd
6282
6283 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6284 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6285 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6286 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6287 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6288
6289 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6290 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6291 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6292 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6293 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6294
6295 .next
6296 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6297 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6298 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6299 example:
6300 .code
6301 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6302 .endd
6303 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6304 .endlist olist
6305
6306 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6307 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6308 be followed by optional colons.
6309
6310 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6311 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6312 lookup types support only literal keys.
6313 .endlist ilist
6314
6315
6316 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6317 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6318 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6319 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6320 many of them are given in later sections.
6321
6322 .ilist
6323 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6324 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6325 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6326 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6327 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6328 .next
6329 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6330 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6331 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6332 .next
6333 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6334 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6335 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6336 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6337 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6338 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6339 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6340 .next
6341 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6342 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6343 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6344 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6345 .next
6346 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6347 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6348 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6349 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6350 .next
6351 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6352 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6353 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6354 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6355 .next
6356 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6357 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6358 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6359 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6360 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6361 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6362 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6363 password value. For example:
6364 .code
6365 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6366 .endd
6367 .next
6368 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6369 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6370 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6371 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6372
6373 .next
6374 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6375 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6376 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6377 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6378
6379 .next
6380 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6381 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6382 .next
6383 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6384 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6385 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6386 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6387 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6388 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6389 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6390 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6391 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6392 .code
6393 require condition = \
6394 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6395 .endd
6396 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6397 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6398 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6399 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6400 .endlist
6401
6402
6403
6404 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6405 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6406 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6407 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6408 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6409 options such as a list of local domains.
6410
6411 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6412 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6413 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6414 or may give up altogether.
6415
6416
6417
6418 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6419 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6420 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6421 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6422 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6423 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6424 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6425 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6426
6427 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6428 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6429 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6430
6431 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6432 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6433 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6434
6435 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6436 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6437 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6438 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6439 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6440 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6441 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6442 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6443 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6444 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6445 .code
6446 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6447 .endd
6448 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6449 looks up these keys, in this order:
6450 .code
6451 jane@eyre.example
6452 *@eyre.example
6453 *
6454 .endd
6455 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6456 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6457 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6458 Exim move on to try the next key.
6459
6460
6461
6462 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6463 .cindex "partial matching"
6464 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6465 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6466 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6467 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6468 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6469 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6470 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6471 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6472 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6473 a key in a DBM file is
6474 .code
6475 *.dates.fict.example
6476 .endd
6477 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6478 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6479 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6480 file.
6481
6482 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6483 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6484 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6485
6486 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6487 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6488 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6489 partial matching keys
6490 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6491 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6492 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6493
6494 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6495 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6496 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6497 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6498 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6499 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6500 remains.
6501
6502 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6503 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6504 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6505 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6506 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6507 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6508 .code
6509 2250.dates.fict.example
6510 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6511 *.dates.fict.example
6512 *.fict.example
6513 .endd
6514 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6515 finishes.
6516
6517 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6518 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6519 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6520 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6521 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6522 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6523 .code
6524 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6525 .endd
6526 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6527 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6528 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6529 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6530 .code
6531 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6532 .endd
6533 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6534 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6535
6536 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6537 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6538 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6539
6540 .ilist
6541 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6542 .next
6543 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6544 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6545 .next
6546 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6547 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6548 for &"*"& on its own.
6549 .next
6550 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6551 .endlist
6552
6553
6554 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6555 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6556 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6557 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6558 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6559 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6560 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6561
6562 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6563 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6564 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6565 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6566 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6567
6568
6569
6570
6571 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6572 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6573 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6574 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6575 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6576 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6577 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6578
6579 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6580 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6581 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6582 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6583 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6584 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6585
6586 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6587 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6588 complete.
6589
6590
6591
6592
6593 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6594 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6595 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6596 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6597 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6598 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6599 .code
6600 [name=$local_part]
6601 .endd
6602 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6603 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6604 .code
6605 [name="$local_part"]
6606 .endd
6607 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6608 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6609 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6610 of the following form is provided:
6611 .code
6612 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6613 .endd
6614 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6615 .code
6616 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6617 .endd
6618 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6619 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6620 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6621
6622
6623
6624
6625 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6626 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6627 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6628 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6629 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6630 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6631 an expansion string could contain:
6632 .code
6633 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6634 .endd
6635 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6636 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6637 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6638 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6639
6640 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6641 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6642 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6643 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6644 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6645 .code
6646 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6647 .endd
6648 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6649 altered and nothing is added.
6650
6651 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6652 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6653 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6654 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6655 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6656
6657 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6658 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6659 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6660 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6661 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6662 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6663 .code
6664 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6665 .endd
6666 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6667 white space is ignored.
6668
6669 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6670 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6671 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6672 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6673 the pseudo-type MXH:
6674 .code
6675 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6676 .endd
6677 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6678 returned.
6679
6680 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6681 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6682 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6683 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6684 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6685 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6686 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6687 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6688 .code
6689 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6690 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6691 .endd
6692 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6693 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6694 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6695
6696 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6697 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6698 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6699 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6700 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6701 such a list.
6702
6703 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6704 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6705 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6706 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6707 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6708 result of a successful lookup such as:
6709 .code
6710 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6711 .endd
6712 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6713 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6714 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6715
6716
6717 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6718 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6719 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6720 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6721 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6722 .code
6723 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6724 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6725 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6726 .endd
6727 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6728 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6729 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6730 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6731
6732 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6733 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6734 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6735
6736 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6737 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6738 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6739 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6740 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6741 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6742 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6743 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6744 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6745 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6746 .code
6747 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6748 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6749 .endd
6750 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6751 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6752
6753
6754
6755
6756 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6757 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6758 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6759 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6760 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6761 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6762 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6763 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6764 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6765 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6766 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6767 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6768 .code
6769 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6770 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6771 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6772 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6773 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6774 .endd
6775 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6776 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6777
6778 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6779 the way they handle the results of a query:
6780
6781 .ilist
6782 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6783 gives an error.
6784 .next
6785 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6786 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6787 .next
6788 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6789 from all of them are returned.
6790 .endlist
6791
6792
6793 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6794 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6795 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6796 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6797
6798
6799 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6800 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6801 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6802 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6803 .code
6804 data = ${lookup ldap \
6805 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6806 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6807 .endd
6808 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6809 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6810 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6811 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6812
6813
6814 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6815 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6816 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6817 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6818 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6819 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6820
6821 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6822 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6823 the string:
6824 .code
6825 * => \2A
6826 ( => \28
6827 ) => \29
6828 \ => \5C
6829 .endd
6830 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6831 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6832 .code
6833 ! $ ' - . _ ( ) * +
6834 .endd
6835 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6836 .code
6837 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6838 .endd
6839 yields
6840 .code
6841 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6842 .endd
6843 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6844 .code
6845 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6846 .endd
6847 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6848 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6849 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6850 .code
6851 , + " \ < > ;
6852 .endd
6853 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6854 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6855 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6856 .code
6857 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6858 .endd
6859 yields
6860 .code
6861 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6862 .endd
6863 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6864 .code
6865 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6866 .endd
6867 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6868 authentication below.
6869
6870
6871 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6872 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6873 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6874 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6875 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6876 by starting it with
6877 .code
6878 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6879 .endd
6880 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6881 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6882 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6883 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6884 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6885 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6886 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6887 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6888 failures, and timeouts.
6889
6890 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6891 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6892 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6893 doubled. For example
6894 .code
6895 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6896 .endd
6897 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6898 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6899 the local host) is used.
6900
6901 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6902 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6903 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6904 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6905 not available.
6906
6907 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6908 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6909 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
6910 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6911 .code
6912 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6913 .endd
6914 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6915 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6916 .code
6917 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6918 .endd
6919 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
6920 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6921 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6922 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6923 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
6924 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6925 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6926 backup host.
6927
6928 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
6929 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6930 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
6931
6932 .ilist
6933 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
6934 interface.
6935 .next
6936 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
6937 .endlist
6938
6939
6940 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6941 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
6942
6943
6944
6945 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
6946 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
6947 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6948 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6949 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
6950 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6951 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6952 them. The following names are recognized:
6953 .display
6954 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
6955 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
6956 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
6957 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
6958 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
6959 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
6960 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
6961 .endd
6962 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
6963 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
6964 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
6965 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
6966
6967 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
6968 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6969 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6970 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6971 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6972 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6973 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6974 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
6975 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6976
6977 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6978 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6979
6980
6981 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6982 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
6983 .code
6984 ${lookup ldap
6985 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6986 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6987 {$value}fail}
6988 .endd
6989 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
6990 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
6991 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
6992 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
6993
6994 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
6995 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
6996 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
6997
6998 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
6999 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
7000 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7001 quoting has two advantages:
7002
7003 .ilist
7004 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7005 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7006 .next
7007 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7008 .endlist
7009
7010 For example, a setting such as
7011 .code
7012 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7013 .endd
7014 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7015
7016 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7017 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7018 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7019 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7020 .code
7021 PASS=${quote:$3}
7022 .endd
7023 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7024 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7025 &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
7026
7027
7028
7029 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7030 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7031 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7032 as a sequence of values, for example
7033 .code
7034 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7035 .endd
7036 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7037 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7038 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7039 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7040 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7041 directory.
7042
7043 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7044 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7045 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7046
7047 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7048 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7049 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7050 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7051 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7052 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7053 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7054
7055 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7056 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7057 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7058 .code
7059 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7060 value1.1, value1.2
7061
7062 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7063 value two
7064
7065 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7066 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7067
7068 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7069 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7070 .endd
7071 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7072 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7073 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7074 results of LDAP lookups.
7075
7076
7077
7078
7079 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7080 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7081 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7082 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7083 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7084 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7085 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7086 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7087 .code
7088 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7089 .endd
7090 might return the string
7091 .code
7092 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7093 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7094 .endd
7095 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7096 .code
7097 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7098 .endd
7099 would just return
7100 .code
7101 Martin Guerre
7102 .endd
7103 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7104 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7105 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7106
7107
7108
7109 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7110 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7111 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7112 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7113 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7114 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7115 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7116 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7117 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7118 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7119 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7120 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7121 might be
7122 .code
7123 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7124 {$value}fail}
7125 .endd
7126 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7127 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7128 .code
7129 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7130 {$value}}
7131 .endd
7132 might be
7133 .code
7134 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7135 .endd
7136 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7137 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7138 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7139 .code
7140 Mister X
7141 .endd
7142 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7143 with a newline between the data for each row.
7144
7145
7146 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7147 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7148 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7149 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7150 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7151 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7152 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7153 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7154 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7155 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7156 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7157 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7158 information.
7159 &new("(For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7160 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7161 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)") Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7162 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7163 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7164 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7165 .code
7166 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7167 .endd
7168 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7169 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7170 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7171 .code
7172 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7173 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7174 .endd
7175 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7176 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7177 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7178 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7179 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7180 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7181
7182 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7183 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7184 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7185 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7186 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7187 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7188 characters are not special.
7189
7190 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7191 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7192 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7193 done by starting the query with
7194 .display
7195 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7196 .endd
7197 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7198 .olist
7199 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7200 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7201 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7202 taken from there.
7203 .next
7204 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7205 .endlist
7206 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7207 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7208 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7209
7210 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7211 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7212 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7213 like this:
7214 .code
7215 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7216 slave2/db/name/pw:\
7217 master/db/name/pw
7218 .endd
7219 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7220 .code
7221 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...}
7222 .endd
7223 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7224 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7225 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7226 .code
7227 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...}
7228 .endd
7229
7230
7231 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7232 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7233 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7234 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7235 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7236 .display
7237 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7238 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7239 .endd
7240 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7241 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7242
7243 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7244 the queries.
7245
7246 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7247 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7248
7249 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7250 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7251 is zero because no rows are affected.
7252
7253
7254 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7255 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7256 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7257 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7258 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7259 looks like this:
7260 .code
7261 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7262 .endd
7263 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7264 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7265 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7266
7267 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7268 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7269 affected.
7270
7271 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7272 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7273 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7274 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7275 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7276 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7277 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7278 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7279 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7280 .code
7281 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7282 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7283 .endd
7284 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7285 .code
7286 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7287 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7288 .endd
7289 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7290 quote, which it doubles.
7291
7292 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7293 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7294 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7295 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7296 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7297 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7298 option.
7299 .ecindex IIDfidalo1
7300 .ecindex IIDfidalo2
7301
7302
7303 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7305
7306 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7307 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7308 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7309 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7310 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7311 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7312 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7313 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7314 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7315
7316 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7317 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7318 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7319 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7320
7321
7322
7323 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7324 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7325 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7326 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7327 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7328 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7329 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7330 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7331
7332
7333 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7334 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7335 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7336
7337 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7338 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7339 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7340 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7341 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7342 .code
7343 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7344 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7345 .endd
7346 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7347 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7348 senders based on the receiving domain.
7349
7350
7351
7352
7353 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7354 .cindex "list" "negation"
7355 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7356 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7357 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7358 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7359 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7360 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7361
7362 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7363 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7364 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7365 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7366 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7367 .code
7368 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7369 .endd
7370 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7371 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7372 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7373 .code
7374 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7375 .endd
7376 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7377 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7378 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7379
7380 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7381 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7382 item.
7383
7384
7385
7386 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7387 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7388 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7389 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7390 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7391 file names are not allowed,
7392 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7393 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7394 lines:
7395
7396 .ilist
7397 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7398 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7399 .next
7400 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7401 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7402 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7403 .code
7404 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7405 .endd
7406 .endlist
7407
7408 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7409 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7410 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7411 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7412
7413 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7414 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7415 .code
7416 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7417 .endd
7418 and the file contains the lines
7419 .code
7420 !a.b.c
7421 *.b.c
7422 .endd
7423 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7424 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7425
7426
7427
7428 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7429 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7430 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7431 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7432 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7433 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7434 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7435 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7436
7437 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7438 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7439 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7440 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7441
7442
7443
7444
7445 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7446 .cindex "named lists"
7447 .cindex "list" "named"
7448 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7449 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7450 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7451 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7452 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7453 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7454 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7455 .code
7456 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7457 .endd
7458 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7459 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7460 configured with the line
7461 .code
7462 domains = +local_domains
7463 .endd
7464 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7465 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7466 .code
7467 dnslookup:
7468 driver = dnslookup
7469 domains = ! +local_domains
7470 transport = remote_smtp
7471 no_more
7472 .endd
7473 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7474 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7475 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7476 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7477 .code
7478 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7479 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7480 .endd
7481 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7482 .code
7483 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7484 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7485 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7486 .endd
7487 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7488 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7489 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7490 .code
7491 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7492 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7493 .endd
7494 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7495 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7496 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7497 .code
7498 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7499 .endd
7500 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7501 referenced lists if you can.
7502
7503 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7504 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7505 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7506 .code
7507 domains = +local_domains
7508 .endd
7509 on several of your routers
7510 or in several ACL statements,
7511 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7512 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7513 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7514 the same each time they are referenced.
7515
7516 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7517 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7518 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7519 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7520
7521
7522
7523 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7524 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7525 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7526 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7527 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7528 write
7529 .code
7530 ALIST = host1 : host2
7531 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7532 .endd
7533 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7534 .code
7535 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7536 .endd
7537 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7538 list, and write
7539 .code
7540 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7541 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7542 .endd
7543 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7544 .code
7545 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7546 .endd
7547
7548
7549 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7550 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7551 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7552 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7553 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7554 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7555 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7556 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7557 message. For example:
7558 .code
7559 domainlist special_domains = \
7560 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7561 .endd
7562 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7563 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7564 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7565 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7566 same list each time.
7567
7568 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7569 cache the result anyway. For example:
7570 .code
7571 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7572 .endd
7573 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7574 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7575
7576
7577
7578 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7579 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7580 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7581 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7582 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7583
7584 .ilist
7585 .cindex "primary host name"
7586 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7587 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7588 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7589 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7590 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7591 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7592 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7593 differ only in their names.
7594 .next
7595 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7596 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7597 .cindex "domain literal"
7598 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7599 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7600 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7601 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7602 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7603 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7604 .next
7605 .cindex "@mx_any"
7606 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7607 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7608 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7609 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7610 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7611 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7612 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7613 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7614 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7615 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7616 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7617
7618 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7619 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7620 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7621 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7622 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7623
7624 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7625 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7626 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7627 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7628 on a router). For example:
7629 .code
7630 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7631 .endd
7632 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7633 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7634
7635 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7636 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7637 contain negative items.
7638
7639 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7640 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7641 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7642 .code
7643 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7644 an.other.domain : ...
7645 .endd
7646 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7647 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7648 .code
7649 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7650 an.other.domain ? ...
7651 .endd
7652 .next
7653 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7654 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7655 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7656 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7657 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7658 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7659 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7660 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7661 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7662 &'cipher.key.ex'&.
7663
7664 .next
7665 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7666 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7667 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7668 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7669 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7670 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7671 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7672 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7673 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7674
7675 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7676 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7677 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7678 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7679 expression by expansion, of course).
7680 .next
7681 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7682 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7683 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7684 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7685 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7686 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7687 .code
7688 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7689 .endd
7690 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7691 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7692 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7693 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7694 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7695 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7696 other statements in the same ACL.
7697
7698 .next
7699 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7700 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7701 .code
7702 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7703 .endd
7704 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7705 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7706
7707 .next
7708 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7709 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7710 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7711 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7712 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7713 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7714 expansion variable.
7715 .next
7716 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7717 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7718 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7719 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7720 .code
7721 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7722 where domain = '$domain';
7723 .endd
7724 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7725 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7726 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7727 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7728 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7729 .next
7730 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7731 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7732 between the pattern and the domain.
7733 .endlist
7734
7735 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7736 .code
7737 domainlist funny_domains = \
7738 @ : \
7739 lib.unseen.edu : \
7740 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7741 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7742 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7743 nis;domains.byname : \
7744 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7745 .endd
7746 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7747 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7748 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7749 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7750 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7751 patterns earlier.
7752
7753
7754
7755 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7756 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7757 .cindex "list" "host list"
7758 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7759 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7760 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7761 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7762 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7763 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7764 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7765
7766
7767 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7768 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7769 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7770 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7771 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7772 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7773 not used.
7774
7775 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7776 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7777 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7778
7779
7780
7781 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7782 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7783 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7784 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7785 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7786 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7787 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7788 concerns.)
7789
7790 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7791 inspecting its IP address:
7792
7793 .ilist
7794 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7795 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7796 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7797 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7798 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7799 with the IP address of the subject host.
7800
7801 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7802 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7803 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7804 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7805 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7806
7807 .next
7808 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7809 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7810 domain name, as just described.
7811
7812 .next
7813 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7814 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7815 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7816 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7817 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7818 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7819 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7820 that can never match a client host.
7821
7822 .next
7823 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7824 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7825 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7826 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7827 .code
7828 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7829 accept hosts = @[]
7830 .endd
7831 .next
7832 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7833 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7834 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7835 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7836 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7837 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7838 significant end of the address.
7839
7840 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7841 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7842 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7843 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7844 .code
7845 192.168.23.236/31
7846 .endd
7847 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7848 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7849 matches.
7850
7851 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7852 .code
7853 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7854 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7855 .endd
7856 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7857 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7858 For example:
7859 .code
7860 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7861 .endd
7862 could make use of a file containing
7863 .code
7864 172.16.0.0/12
7865 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7866 .endd
7867 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7868 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7869 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7870 .code
7871 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7872 3ffe:ffff:836f::/48
7873 .endd
7874 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7875 list.
7876 .endlist
7877
7878
7879
7880 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7881 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7882 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7883 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7884 address, the pattern takes this form:
7885 .display
7886 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7887 .endd
7888 For example:
7889 .code
7890 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7891 .endd
7892 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7893 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7894 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7895 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
7896 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7897 returned by the lookup is not used.
7898
7899 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
7900 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
7901 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7902 patterns of this form:
7903 .display
7904 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7905 .endd
7906 For example:
7907 .code
7908 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7909 .endd
7910 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
7911 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7912 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7913 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7914 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
7915
7916 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
7917 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
7918 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
7919 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
7920 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
7921 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
7922 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
7923 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
7924 addresses are always used.
7925
7926 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
7927 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
7928 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
7929 configurations.
7930
7931 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
7932 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
7933 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7934 case the IP address is used on its own.
7935
7936
7937
7938 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
7939 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
7940 .cindex "unknown host name"
7941 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
7942 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7943 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7944 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7945 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
7946 above.)
7947
7948 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7949 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7950 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7951 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7952 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7953 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7954 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7955
7956 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7957 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7958
7959 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7960 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
7961 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7962 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
7963 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
7964 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
7965 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
7966 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
7967 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
7968
7969 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7970 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7971
7972 .cindex "host" "alias for"
7973 .cindex "alias for host"
7974 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7975 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7976
7977 .ilist
7978 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7979 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
7980 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
7981 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7982 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7983 expression.
7984 .next
7985 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
7986 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
7987 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7988 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
7989 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
7990 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
7991 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
7992 example,
7993 .code
7994 ^(a|b)\.c\.d$
7995 .endd
7996 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
7997 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
7998 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
7999 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8000 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8001 .code
8002 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8003 .endd
8004 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8005 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8006 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8007 required.
8008 .endlist
8009
8010
8011
8012
8013 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8014 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8015 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8016 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8017 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8018 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8019
8020 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8021 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8022
8023 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8024 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8025 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8026 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8027 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8028 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8029
8030 .ilist
8031 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8032 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8033 .code
8034 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8035 .endd
8036 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8037 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8038
8039 .next
8040 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8041 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8042 example:
8043 .code
8044 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8045 192.168.4.5
8046 .endd
8047 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8048 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8049 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8050 .endlist
8051
8052 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8053 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8054 list.
8055
8056
8057 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8058 "SECTtemdnserr"
8059 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8060 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8061 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8062 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8063 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8064 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8065 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8066 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8067 host lists such as whitelists.
8068
8069
8070
8071 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8072 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8073 .cindex "unknown host name"
8074 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8075 If a pattern is of the form
8076 .display
8077 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8078 .endd
8079 for example
8080 .code
8081 dbm;/host/accept/list
8082 .endd
8083 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8084 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8085 is not used.
8086
8087 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8088 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8089 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8090 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8091 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8092 lookup, both using the same file.
8093
8094
8095
8096 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8097 If a pattern is of the form
8098 .display
8099 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8100 .endd
8101 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8102 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8103 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8104 .code
8105 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8106 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8107 .endd
8108 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8109 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8110 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8111 operator.
8112
8113 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8114 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8115 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8116
8117 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8118 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8119 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8120 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8121 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8122 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8123
8124
8125
8126 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8127 "SECTmixwilhos"
8128 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8129 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8130 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8131 ACL you could have:
8132 .code
8133 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8134 .endd
8135 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8136 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8137 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8138 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8139 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8140 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8141
8142 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8143 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8144 .code
8145 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8146 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8147 .endd
8148 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8149 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8150
8151
8152
8153
8154
8155 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8156 .cindex "list" "address list"
8157 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8158 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8159 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8160 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8161 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8162 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8163 using this option setting:
8164 .code
8165 senders = :
8166 .endd
8167 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8168 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8169 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8170 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8171
8172 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8173 example:
8174 .code
8175 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8176 .endd
8177 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8178 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8179 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8180 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8181 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8182 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8183 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8184 .code
8185 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8186 *@+hostile_domains:\
8187 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8188 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8189 .endd
8190 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8191 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8192 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8193 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8194 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8195
8196 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8197 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8198 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8199 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8200 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8201 .code
8202 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8203 .endd
8204
8205 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8206 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8207 senders:
8208
8209 .ilist
8210 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8211 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8212 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8213 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8214 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8215 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8216 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8217 .code
8218 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8219 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8220 .endd
8221 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8222 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8223
8224 .next
8225 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8226 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8227 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8228 example:
8229 .code
8230 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8231 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8232 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8233 .endd
8234 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8235 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8236 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8237 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8238
8239 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8240 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8241 panic log.
8242 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8243 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8244 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8245 default. For example, with this lookup:
8246 .code
8247 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8248 .endd
8249 the file could contains lines like this:
8250 .code
8251 user1@domain1.example
8252 *@domain2.example
8253 .endd
8254 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8255 that are tried is:
8256 .code
8257 nimrod@jaeger.example
8258 *@jaeger.example
8259 *
8260 .endd
8261 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8262 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8263
8264 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8265 .code
8266 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8267 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8268 .endd
8269 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8270 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8271 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8272 .endlist
8273
8274
8275 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8276 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8277 always fails.
8278
8279
8280 .ilist
8281 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8282 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8283 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8284 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8285 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8286 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8287 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8288 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8289 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8290
8291 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8292 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8293 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8294 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8295 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8296 with
8297 .code
8298 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8299 .endd
8300 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8301 .code
8302 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8303 .endd
8304 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8305
8306 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8307 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8308 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8309 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8310 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8311 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8312 .code
8313 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8314 spammer3 : spammer4
8315 .endd
8316 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8317 doubling.
8318
8319 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8320 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8321 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8322 might have entries like
8323 .code
8324 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8325 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8326 *: ^\d{8}$
8327 .endd
8328 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8329 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8330 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8331 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8332
8333 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8334 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8335 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8336
8337 .next
8338 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8339 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8340 can only return a single list of local parts.
8341 .endlist
8342
8343 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8344 in these two examples:
8345 .code
8346 senders = +my_list
8347 senders = *@+my_list
8348 .endd
8349 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8350 example it is a named domain list.
8351
8352
8353
8354
8355 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8356 .cindex "case of local parts"
8357 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8358 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8359 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8360 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8361 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8362 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8363 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8364 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8365 default.
8366
8367 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8368 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8369 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8370 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8371 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8372 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8373 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8374 case-independent.
8375
8376 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8377 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8378 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8379 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8380 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8381 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8382 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8383 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8384
8385
8386
8387 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8388 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8389 .cindex "local part" "list"
8390 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8391 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8392 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8393 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8394 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8395 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8396 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8397 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8398
8399 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8400 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8401 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8402 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8403 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8404 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8405 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8406 types.
8407 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8408
8409
8410
8411
8412 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8413 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8414
8415 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8416 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8417 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8418 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8419
8420 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8421 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8422 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8423 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8424 escape character, as described in the following section.
8425
8426
8427
8428 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8429 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8430 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8431 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8432 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8433 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8434 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8435 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8436
8437 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8438 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8439 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8440 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8441 .code
8442 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8443 .endd
8444 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8445 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8446 string.
8447
8448
8449
8450 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8451 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8452 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8453 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8454 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8455 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8456 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8457 encoding.
8458
8459 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8460 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8461 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8462
8463
8464 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8465 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8466 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8467 .oindex "&%-be%&"
8468 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8469 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8470 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8471 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8472 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8473 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8474 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8475 and &%nhash%&.
8476
8477 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8478 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8479 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8480
8481 .oindex "&%-bem%&"
8482 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8483 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8484 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8485 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8486 .code
8487 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8488 .endd
8489 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8490 Exim message identifier. For example:
8491 .code
8492 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8493 .endd
8494 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8495 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8496
8497
8498 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8499 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8500 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8501 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8502 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8503 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8504 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8505 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8506 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8507 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8508 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8509 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8510 being expanded.
8511
8512
8513
8514
8515 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8516 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8517 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8518 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8519 white space is significant.
8520
8521 .vlist
8522 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8523 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8524 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8525 .code
8526 $local_part
8527 ${domain}
8528 .endd
8529 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8530 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8531 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8532 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8533 given, the expansion fails.
8534
8535 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8536 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8537 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8538 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8539 .code
8540 ${lc:$local_part}
8541 .endd
8542 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8543 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8544 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8545 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8546 string easier to understand.
8547
8548 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8549 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8550 expansion item below.
8551
8552 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8553 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8554 .cindex &%dlfunc%&
8555 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8556 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8557 .code
8558 EXPAND_DLFUNC=yes
8559 .endd
8560 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8561 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8562 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8563
8564 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8565 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8566 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8567 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8568 must have the following type:
8569 .code
8570 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8571 .endd
8572 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8573 function should return one of the following values:
8574
8575 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8576 into the expanded string that is being built.
8577
8578 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8579 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8580
8581 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8582 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8583
8584 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8585
8586 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8587 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8588 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8589
8590 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8591 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8592 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8593 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8594 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8595 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8596 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8597 form:
8598 .display
8599 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8600 .endd
8601 .vindex "&$value$&"
8602 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8603 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8604 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8605 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8606 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8607 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8608 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8609 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8610 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8611
8612 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8613 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8614 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8615 yield &"2001"&:
8616 .code
8617 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8618 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8619 .endd
8620 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8621 appear, for example:
8622 .code
8623 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8624 .endd
8625 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8626 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8627
8628
8629 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8630 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8631 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8632 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8633 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8634 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8635 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8636 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8637 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8638 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8639 <&'string3'&> as before.
8640
8641 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8642 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8643 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8644 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8645 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8646 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8647 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8648 provided. For example:
8649 .code
8650 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8651 .endd
8652 yields &"42"&, and
8653 .code
8654 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8655 .endd
8656 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8657 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8658
8659
8660 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8661 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8662 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8663 .vindex "&$item$&"
8664 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8665 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8666 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8667 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8668 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8669 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8670 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8671 .code
8672 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8673 .endd
8674 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8675 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8676
8677
8678 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8679 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8680 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8681 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8682 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8683 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8684
8685 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8686 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8687 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8688 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8689 .code
8690 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8691 .endd
8692 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8693 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8694 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8695 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8696 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8697 .code
8698 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8699 .endd
8700 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8701 letters appear. For example:
8702 .display
8703 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8704 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8705 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8706 .endd
8707
8708 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8709 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8710 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8711 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8712 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8713 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8714 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8715 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8716 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8717 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8718 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8719 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8720 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8721 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8722 .code
8723 $header_reply-to:
8724 .endd
8725 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8726 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8727 lines) may be present.
8728
8729 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8730 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8731
8732 .ilist
8733 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8734 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8735 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8736
8737 .next
8738 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8739 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8740 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8741 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8742 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8743 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8744 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8745 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8746
8747 .next
8748 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8749 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8750 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8751 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8752 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8753 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8754 .endlist ilist
8755
8756 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8757 command of the following form:
8758 .code
8759 headers charset "UTF-8"
8760 .endd
8761 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8762 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8763 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8764 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8765 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8766 ISO-8859-1.
8767
8768 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8769 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8770 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8771 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8772
8773 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8774 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8775 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8776 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8777 router or transport are not accessible.
8778
8779 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8780 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8781 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8782 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8783 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8784 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8785
8786 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8787 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8788 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8789 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8790 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8791 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8792 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8793
8794 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8795 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8796 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8797 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8798 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8799 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8800 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8801 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8802
8803
8804 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8805 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8806 .cindex &%hmac%&
8807 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8808 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8809 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8810 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8811 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8812 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8813 present. For example:
8814 .code
8815 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8816 .endd
8817 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8818 produces:
8819 .code
8820 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8821 .endd
8822 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8823 an Exim configuration:
8824 .code
8825 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8826 .endd
8827 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8828 .code
8829 headers_add = \
8830 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8831 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8832 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8833 .endd
8834 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8835 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8836 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8837 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8838 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8839 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8840
8841
8842 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8843 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8844 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8845 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8846 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8847 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8848 .code
8849 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8850 .endd
8851 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8852 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8853 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8854 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8855 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8856
8857 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8858 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8859 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8860 .code
8861 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8862 .endd
8863 you can use
8864 .code
8865 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8866 .endd
8867
8868 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8869 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8870 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8871 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8872 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8873 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8874 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8875 some of the braces:
8876 .code
8877 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8878 .endd
8879 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8880 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8881 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8882
8883
8884 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8885 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8886 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8887 described in the next item.
8888
8889 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
8890 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8891 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
8892 .cindex "file" "lookups"
8893 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
8894 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8895 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
8896 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
8897 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
8898
8899 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8900 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
8901 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8902 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8903 out by the system administrator.
8904
8905 .vindex "&$value$&"
8906 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8907 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
8908 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8909 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
8910 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8911 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8912 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8913 original lookup fails.
8914
8915 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
8916 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
8917 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
8918 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
8919 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
8920 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
8921 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
8922 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
8923
8924 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
8925 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
8926 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8927 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
8928
8929 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
8930 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
8931 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8932 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8933
8934 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8935 .code
8936 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8937 .endd
8938 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8939 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8940 .code
8941 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8942 {$value}fail}
8943 .endd
8944
8945
8946 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8947 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
8948 .vindex "&$item$&"
8949 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8950 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8951 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
8952 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
8953 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
8954 setting is not included in the output. For example:
8955 .code
8956 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
8957 .endd
8958 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
8959 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
8960 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8961
8962 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8963 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
8964 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
8965 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8966 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
8967 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
8968 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8969 .code
8970 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8971 .endd
8972 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8973 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8974 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8975 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
8976 example,
8977 .code
8978 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8979 .endd
8980 returns the string &"6/33"&.
8981
8982
8983
8984 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
8985 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
8986 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
8987 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
8988 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
8989 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
8990 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
8991 name of the subroutine, is nine.
8992
8993 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
8994 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
8995 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
8996 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
8997 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
8998 not its contents.
8999
9000 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9001 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9002 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9003
9004 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9005 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9006
9007
9008 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9009 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9010 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9011 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9012 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9013 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9014 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9015 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9016
9017 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9018 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9019 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9020 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9021 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9022 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9023 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9024 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9025 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9026 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9027
9028 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9029 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9030 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9031 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9032
9033 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9034 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9035 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9036 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9037 is the expansion of the third argument.
9038
9039 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9040 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9041 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9042
9043 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9044 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9045 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9046 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9047 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9048 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9049 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9050 newlines are left in the string.
9051 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9052 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9053 the string expansion fails.
9054
9055 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9056 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9057
9058
9059
9060 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9061 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9062 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9063 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9064 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9065 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9066 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9067 examples:
9068 .code
9069 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9070 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9071 .endd
9072 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9073 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9074 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9075 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9076 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9077 example:
9078 .code
9079 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9080 .endd
9081 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9082 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9083 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9084 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9085 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9086 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9087 .code
9088 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9089 .endd
9090 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9091 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9092 turns them into spaces:
9093 .code
9094 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9095 .endd
9096 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9097 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9098 addition, the following errors can occur:
9099
9100 .ilist
9101 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9102 .next
9103 Failure to connect the socket;
9104 .next
9105 Failure to write the request string;
9106 .next
9107 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9108 .endlist
9109
9110 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9111 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9112 errors occurs. For example:
9113 .code
9114 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9115 {socket failure}}
9116 .endd
9117 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9118 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9119 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9120 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9121 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9122
9123 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9124 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9125
9126
9127 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9128 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9129 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9130 .vindex "&$value$&"
9131 .vindex "&$item$&"
9132 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9133 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9134 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9135 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9136 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9137 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9138 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9139 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9140 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9141 .code
9142 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9143 .endd
9144 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9145 can be found:
9146 .code
9147 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9148 .endd
9149 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9150 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9151 expansion items.
9152
9153 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9154 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9155 expansion item above.
9156
9157 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9158 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9159 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9160 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9161 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9162 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9163 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9164 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9165
9166 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9167 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9168 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9169 .vindex "&$value$&"
9170 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9171 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9172 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9173 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9174 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9175 &$value$&.
9176
9177 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9178 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9179 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9180 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9181
9182 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
9183 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9184 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9185 .code
9186 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9187 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9188 ...
9189 endif
9190 .endd
9191 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9192 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9193 commands.
9194
9195 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9196 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9197 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9198 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9199
9200 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9201 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9202
9203
9204 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9205 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9206 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9207 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9208 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9209 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9210 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9211 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9212 .code
9213 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9214 .endd
9215 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9216 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9217 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9218 .code
9219 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9220 .endd
9221 yields &"defabc"&, and
9222 .code
9223 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9224 .endd
9225 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9226 the regular expression from string expansion.
9227
9228
9229
9230 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9231 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9232 .cindex "substring extraction"
9233 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9234 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9235 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9236 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9237 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9238 .code
9239 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9240 .endd
9241 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9242 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9243 omitted.
9244
9245 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9246 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9247 length required. For example
9248 .code
9249 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9250 .endd
9251 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9252 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9253 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9254 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9255
9256 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9257 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9258 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9259 .code
9260 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9261 .endd
9262 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9263 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9264 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9265 .code
9266 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9267 .endd
9268 yields an empty string, but
9269 .code
9270 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9271 .endd
9272 yields &"1"&.
9273
9274 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9275 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9276 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9277 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9278 .code
9279 ${substr_-1:abcde}
9280 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9281 .endd
9282 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9283
9284
9285
9286 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9287 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9288 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9289 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9290 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9291 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9292 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9293 replacement list. For example
9294 .code
9295 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9296 .endd
9297 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9298 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9299 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9300 place.
9301 .endlist
9302
9303
9304
9305 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9306 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9307 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9308 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9309 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9310 following operations can be performed:
9311
9312 .vlist
9313 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9314 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9315 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9316 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9317 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9318 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9319
9320
9321 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9322 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9323 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9324 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9325 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9326 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9327 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9328 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9329 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9330
9331 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9332 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9333 character. For example:
9334 .code
9335 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9336 .endd
9337 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9338 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9339 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9340 processing lists.
9341
9342
9343 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9344 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9345 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9346 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9347 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9348 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9349 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9350 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9351 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9352
9353 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9354 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9355 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9356 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9357 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9358 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9359 string.
9360
9361 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9362 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9363 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9364 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9365 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9366
9367
9368 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9369 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9370 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9371 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9372 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9373 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9374 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9375
9376
9377 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9378 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9379 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9380 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9381 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9382 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9383 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9384 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9385 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9386 C programming language):
9387 .table2 70pt 300pt
9388 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9389 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9390 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9391 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9392 .irow "" "and (&&)"
9393 .irow "" "xor (^)"
9394 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9395 .endtable
9396 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9397 space is permitted before or after operators.
9398
9399 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9400 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9401 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9402 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9403 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9404
9405 A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9406 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9407 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9408
9409 .display
9410 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9411 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9412 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9413 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9414 &`${eval:0xc&amp;5} `& yields 4
9415 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9416 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9417 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9418 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9419 &`${eval:~255&amp;0x1234} `& yields 4608
9420 &`${eval:-(~255&amp;0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9421 .endd
9422
9423 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9424 .code
9425 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9426 condition = \
9427 ${if and { \
9428 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9429 { \
9430 < \
9431 {$recipients_count} \
9432 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9433 } \
9434 }{yes}{no}}
9435 .endd
9436 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9437 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9438
9439
9440 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9441 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9442 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9443 example,
9444 .code
9445 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9446 .endd
9447 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9448 and then re-expands what it has found.
9449
9450
9451 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9452 .cindex "Unicode"
9453 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9454 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9455 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9456 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9457 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9458 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9459 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9460 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9461 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9462
9463 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9464 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9465 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9466 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9467 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9468 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9469 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9470
9471
9472 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9473 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9474 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9475 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9476 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9477 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9478 .code
9479 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9480 .endd
9481 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9482 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9483
9484
9485
9486 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9487 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9488 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9489 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9490 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9491 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9492
9493
9494 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9495 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9496 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9497 .cindex "lower casing"
9498 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9499 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9500 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9501 .code
9502 ${lc:$local_part}
9503 .endd
9504
9505 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9506 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9507 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9508 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9509 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9510 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9511 .code
9512 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9513 .endd
9514 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9515 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9516 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9517
9518
9519 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9520 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9521 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9522 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9523 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9524 empty.
9525
9526
9527 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9528 .cindex "masked IP address"
9529 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9530 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9531 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9532 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9533 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9534 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9535 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9536 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9537 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9538 .code
9539 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9540 .endd
9541 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9542 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9543 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9544 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9545 .code
9546 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9547 .endd
9548 returns the string
9549 .code
9550 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9551 .endd
9552 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9553
9554
9555 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9556 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9557 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9558 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9559 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9560 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9561
9562
9563 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9564 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9565 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9566 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9567 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9568 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9569 .code
9570 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9571 .endd
9572 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9573
9574
9575 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9576 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9577 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9578 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9579 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9580 is an empty string or
9581 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9582 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9583 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9584 respectively For example,
9585 .code
9586 ${quote:ab"*"cd}
9587 .endd
9588 becomes
9589 .code
9590 "ab\"*\"cd"
9591 .endd
9592 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9593 variable or a message header.
9594
9595 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9596 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9597 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9598 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9599 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9600 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9601 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9602
9603
9604 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9605 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9606 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9607 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9608 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9609 .code
9610 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9611 .endd
9612 returns
9613 .code
9614 two%20%5C2A%20two
9615 .endd
9616 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9617 yields an unchanged string.
9618
9619
9620 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9621 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9622 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9623 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9624 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9625 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9626 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9627 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9628 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9629 characters
9630 .code
9631 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9632 .endd
9633 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9634 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9635 characters.
9636
9637
9638 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9639 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9640 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9641 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9642 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9643 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9644 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9645 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9646
9647 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9648 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9649 to use this operator as well.
9650
9651
9652
9653 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9654 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9655 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9656 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9657 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9658 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9659 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9660
9661
9662 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9663 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9664 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9665 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9666 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9667 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9668
9669
9670 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9671 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9672 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9673 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9674 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9675 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9676 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9677 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9678 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9679 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9680 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9681 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9682 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9683
9684 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9685 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9686 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9687
9688 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9689 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9690 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9691 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9692 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9693
9694
9695
9696 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9697 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9698 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9699 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9700 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9701 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9702
9703
9704 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9705 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9706 .cindex "substring extraction"
9707 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9708 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9709 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9710 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9711 .code
9712 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9713 .endd
9714 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9715 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9716
9717 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9718 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9719 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9720 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9721 seconds.
9722
9723 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9724 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9725 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9726 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9727 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9728 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9729 &`1w3d4h2m6s`&.
9730
9731 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9732 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9733 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9734 .cindex "upper casing"
9735 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9736 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9737 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9738 .endlist
9739
9740
9741
9742
9743
9744
9745 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9746 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9747 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9748 while expanding strings:
9749
9750 .vlist
9751 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9752 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9753 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9754 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9755 condition.
9756
9757 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9758 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9759 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9760 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9761 are:
9762 .display
9763 &`= `& equal
9764 &`== `& equal
9765 &`> `& greater
9766 &`>= `& greater or equal
9767 &`< `& less
9768 &`<= `& less or equal
9769 .endd
9770 For example:
9771 .code
9772 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9773 .endd
9774 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9775 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9776 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9777 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9778 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9779 zero.
9780
9781 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9782 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9783 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9784 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9785 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9786 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9787 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9788 included in the binary.
9789
9790 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9791 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9792 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9793 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9794 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9795 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9796 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9797 string in LDAP form is:
9798 .code
9799 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9800 .endd
9801 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9802 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9803 .code
9804 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9805 .endd
9806 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9807 supported:
9808
9809 .ilist
9810 .cindex "MD5 hash"
9811 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9812 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9813 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9814 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9815 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9816 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9817 comparison fails.
9818
9819 .next
9820 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9821 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9822 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9823 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9824 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9825 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9826
9827 .next
9828 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
9829 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
9830 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9831 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9832 whatever its length.
9833
9834 .next
9835 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
9836 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
9837 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
9838 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9839 .endlist
9840 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
9841 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9842 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
9843 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9844 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
9845 support &[crypt16()]&.
9846
9847 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
9848 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
9849 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
9850 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
9851 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
9852
9853 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
9854 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
9855 Exim is seen as very low priority.
9856
9857 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
9858 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
9859 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
9860 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
9861 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9862
9863 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
9864 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
9865 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
9866 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9867 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
9868 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
9869 .code
9870 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9871 .endd
9872 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
9873 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9874
9875 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
9876 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9877 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
9878 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9879 exists in the message. For example,
9880 .code
9881 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9882 .endd
9883 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
9884 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
9885
9886 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9887 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9888 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9889 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9890 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
9891 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
9892 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9893 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
9894 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
9895
9896 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
9897 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
9898 .cindex "file" "existence test"
9899 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
9900 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9901 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9902 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
9903 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9904
9905 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
9906 .cindex "delivery" "first"
9907 .cindex "first delivery"
9908 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
9909 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
9910 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9911 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9912
9913
9914 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
9915 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
9916 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
9917 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
9918 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
9919 .vindex "&$item$&"
9920 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
9921 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
9922 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
9923 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
9924 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
9925 .ilist
9926 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
9927 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
9928 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
9929 .next
9930 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
9931 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
9932 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
9933 .endlist
9934 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
9935 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
9936 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
9937 list separator is changed to a comma:
9938 .code
9939 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
9940 .endd
9941 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
9942 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
9943
9944
9945 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9946 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9947 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9948 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9949 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
9950 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
9951 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9952 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
9953 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
9954 case-independent.
9955
9956 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9957 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9958 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9959 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9960 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
9961 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
9962 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9963 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
9964 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
9965 case-independent.
9966
9967 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9968 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9969 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9970 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
9971 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
9972 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
9973 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
9974 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
9975 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
9976 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
9977 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
9978
9979 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
9980 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
9981 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
9982 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
9983 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
9984
9985 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
9986 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
9987 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
9988 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
9989 .code
9990 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
9991 .endd
9992 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
9993
9994 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
9995 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
9996 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
9997 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
9998 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
9999 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10000 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10001 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10002 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10003 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10004 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10005 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10006 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10007 this can be used.
10008
10009
10010 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10011 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10012 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10013 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10014 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10015 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10016 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10017 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10018 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10019 case-independent.
10020
10021 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10022 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10023 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10024 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10025 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10026 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10027 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10028 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10029 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10030 case-independent.
10031
10032
10033 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10034 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10035 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10036 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10037 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10038 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10039 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10040 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10041 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10042 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10043 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10044 For example,
10045 .code
10046 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10047 .endd
10048 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10049 backslashes is also required.
10050
10051 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10052 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10053 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10054 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10055 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10056 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10057
10058 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10059 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10060 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10061 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10062 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10063 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10064 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10065 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10066
10067 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10068 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10069 See &*match_local_part*&.
10070
10071 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10072 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10073 See &*match_local_part*&.
10074
10075 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10076 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10077 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10078 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10079 address or an empty string. The second (after expansion) is a restricted host
10080 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10081 .code
10082 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10083 .endd
10084 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10085
10086 .ilist
10087 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10088 .next
10089 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10090 .next
10091 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10092 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10093 in a single test such as
10094 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10095 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10096 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10097 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10098 .code
10099 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10100 .endd
10101 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10102 .next
10103 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10104 .next
10105 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10106 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10107 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10108 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10109 masks. For example:
10110 .code
10111 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10112 .endd
10113 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10114 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10115 address mask, for example:
10116 .code
10117 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10118 .endd
10119 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10120 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10121 .code
10122 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10123 .endd
10124 .endlist ilist
10125
10126 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10127
10128 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10129 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10130 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10131 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10132 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10133 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10134 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10135 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10136 example is:
10137 .code
10138 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10139 .endd
10140 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10141 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10142 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10143 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10144 .code
10145 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10146 .endd
10147 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10148 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10149 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10150 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10151 caselessly.
10152
10153 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10154 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10155 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10156 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10157
10158 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10159 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10160 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10161 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10162 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10163 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10164 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10165 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10166 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10167 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10168 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10169 .code
10170 SUPPORT_PAM=yes
10171 .endd
10172 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10173 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10174
10175 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10176 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10177 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10178 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10179 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10180 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10181 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10182
10183 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10184 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10185 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10186 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10187 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10188 .code
10189 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10190 .endd
10191 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10192 .code
10193 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10194 .endd
10195 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10196 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10197 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10198 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10199 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10200 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10201 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10202 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10203
10204
10205 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10206 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10207 .cindex "Cyrus"
10208 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10209 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10210 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10211 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10212 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10213 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10214
10215 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10216 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10217 building Exim. For example:
10218 .code
10219 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10220 .endd
10221 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10222 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10223 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10224 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10225
10226 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10227 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10228 configuration, you might have this:
10229 .code
10230 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10231 .endd
10232 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10233 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10234 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10235 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10236 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10237 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10238
10239
10240 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10241 .cindex "Radius"
10242 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10243 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10244 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10245 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10246 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10247 support.
10248
10249 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10250 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10251 this library, you need to set
10252 .code
10253 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10254 .endd
10255 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10256 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10257 .code
10258 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10259 .endd
10260 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10261 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10262 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10263
10264 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10265 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10266 the authentication is successful. For example:
10267 .code
10268 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10269 .endd
10270
10271
10272 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10273 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10274 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10275 .cindex "Cyrus"
10276 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10277 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10278 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10279 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10280 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10281 by a process that is not running as root.
10282
10283 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10284 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10285 building Exim. For example:
10286 .code
10287 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10288 .endd
10289 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10290 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10291 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10292
10293 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10294 two are mandatory. For example:
10295 .code
10296 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10297 .endd
10298 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10299 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10300 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10301 .endlist vlist
10302
10303
10304
10305 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10306 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10307 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10308 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10309 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10310 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10311 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10312
10313
10314 .vlist
10315 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10316 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10317 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10318 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10319 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10320 For example,
10321 .code
10322 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10323 .endd
10324 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10325 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10326 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10327
10328 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10329 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10330 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10331 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10332 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10333 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10334 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10335 parsed but not evaluated.
10336 .endlist
10337 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10338
10339
10340
10341
10342 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10343 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10344 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10345 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10346 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10347
10348 .vlist
10349 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10350 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10351 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10352 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10353 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10354 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10355 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10356 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10357 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10358 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10359 matching condition.
10360
10361 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10362 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10363 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10364 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10365 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10366 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10367 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10368 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10369 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10370 during subsequent delivery.
10371
10372 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10373 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10374 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10375 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10376 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10377 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10378 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10379 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10380 delivery.
10381
10382 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10383 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10384 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10385 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10386 be preserved by coding like this:
10387 .code
10388 warn !verify = sender
10389 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10390 .endd
10391 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10392 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10393 failure.
10394
10395 .vitem &$address_data$&
10396 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10397 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10398 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10399 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10400 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10401 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10402 user filter files.
10403
10404 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10405 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10406 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10407 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10408 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10409 from the child's routing.
10410
10411 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10412 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10413 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10414 address.
10415
10416 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10417 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10418 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10419
10420 .vitem &$address_file$&
10421 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10422 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10423 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10424 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10425 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10426 .code
10427 /home/r2d2/savemail
10428 .endd
10429 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10430 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10431 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10432 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10433 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10434 to the relevant file.
10435
10436 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10437 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10438 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10439 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10440
10441 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10442 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10443 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10444 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10445
10446 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10447 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10448 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10449 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10450 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10451 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10452 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10453 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10454 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10455 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10456 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10457 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10458 command line option.
10459
10460
10461
10462
10463 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10464 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10465 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10466 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10467 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10468 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10469 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10470 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10471 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10472 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10473 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10474
10475 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10476 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10477 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10478 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10479 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10480
10481
10482 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10483 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10484 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10485 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10486 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10487 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10488 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10489 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10490 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10491 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10492 an undefined mechanism.
10493
10494 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10495 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10496 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10497 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10498 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10499 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10500
10501 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10502 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10503 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10504 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10505 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10506 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10507 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
10508
10509 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10510 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10511 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10512 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10513 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10514
10515 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10516 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10517 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10518 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10519 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10520
10521 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10522 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10523 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10524 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10525 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10526 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10527 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10528
10529 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10530 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10531 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10532 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10533 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10534 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10535 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10536
10537 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10538 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10539 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10540
10541 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10542 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10543 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10544 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10545 compilations of the same version of the program.
10546
10547 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10548 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10549 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10550 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10551 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10552
10553 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10554 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10555 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10556 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10557 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10558
10559 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10560 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10561 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10562 &$dnslist_value$&
10563 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10564 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10565 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10566 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10567 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10568 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10569 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10570 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10571 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10572
10573 .vitem &$domain$&
10574 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10575 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10576 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10577 case for &$domain$&.
10578
10579 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10580 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10581 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10582 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10583
10584 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10585 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10586 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10587 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10588 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10589 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10590
10591 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10592 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10593 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10594
10595 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10596
10597 .ilist
10598 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10599 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10600 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10601 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10602 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10603 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10604 the &(smtp)& transport.
10605
10606 .next
10607 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10608 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10609 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10610 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10611
10612 .next
10613 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10614 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10615 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10616 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10617 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10618 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10619
10620 .next
10621 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10622 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10623 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10624 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10625 .endlist
10626
10627
10628 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10629 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10630 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10631 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10632 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10633 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10634 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10635 used.
10636
10637 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10638 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10639 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10640 to nothing.
10641
10642 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10643 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10644 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10645
10646 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10647 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10648 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10649
10650 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10651 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10652 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10653
10654 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10655 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10656 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10657 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10658 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10659
10660 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10661 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10662 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10663 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10664 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10665
10666 .vitem &$home$&
10667 .vindex "&$home$&"
10668 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10669 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10670 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10671 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10672 by a setting on the transport itself.
10673
10674 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10675 of the environment variable HOME.
10676
10677 .vitem &$host$&
10678 .vindex "&$host$&"
10679 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10680 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10681 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10682 to local and remote transports.
10683
10684 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10685 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10686 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10687 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10688 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10689 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10690 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10691 is connected.
10692
10693 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10694 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10695 client is connected.
10696
10697
10698 .vitem &$host_address$&
10699 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10700 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10701 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10702 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10703
10704 .vitem &$host_data$&
10705 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10706 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10707 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10708 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10709 .code
10710 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10711 message = $host_data
10712 .endd
10713 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10714 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10715 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10716 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10717 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10718 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10719 variables is set to &"1"&.
10720
10721 .ilist
10722 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10723 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10724
10725 .next
10726 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10727 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10728 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10729 .endlist ilist
10730
10731 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10732 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10733 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10734 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10735 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10736 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10737 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10738 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10739 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10740 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10741
10742 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10743 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10744 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10745
10746
10747 .vitem &$inode$&
10748 .vindex "&$inode$&"
10749 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10750 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10751 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10752 a unique name for the file.
10753
10754 .vitem &$interface_address$&
10755 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10756 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10757
10758 .vitem &$interface_port$&
10759 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10760 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10761
10762 .vitem &$item$&
10763 .vindex "&$item$&"
10764 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10765 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*man*&, and
10766 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10767 empty.
10768
10769 .vitem &$ldap_dn$&
10770 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10771 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10772 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10773 lookup.
10774
10775 .vitem &$load_average$&
10776 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
10777 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10778 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10779 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10780
10781 .vitem &$local_part$&
10782 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
10783 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10784 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
10785 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
10786 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
10787
10788 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10789 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
10790 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
10791 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
10792 once.
10793
10794 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10795 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10796 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
10797 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
10798 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
10799 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
10800
10801 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
10802 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
10803 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
10804 &$address_pipe$&).
10805
10806 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
10807 local part of the recipient address.
10808
10809 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10810 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
10811 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
10812
10813 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
10814 the addresses
10815 .code
10816 "abc:xyz"@test.example
10817 abc\:xyz@test.example
10818 .endd
10819 the value of &$local_part$& is
10820 .code
10821 abc:xyz
10822 .endd
10823 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
10824 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
10825 have:
10826 .code
10827 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
10828 .endd
10829 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
10830 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
10831 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
10832
10833 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
10834 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
10835 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
10836 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
10837 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
10838 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
10839 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
10840
10841 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
10842 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
10843 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
10844 variable expands to nothing.
10845
10846 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
10847 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10848 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10849 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10850 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10851
10852 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
10853 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10854 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10855 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10856 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10857
10858 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
10859 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
10860 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
10861 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
10862
10863 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
10864 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
10865 See &$local_user_uid$&.
10866
10867 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
10868 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
10869 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
10870 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
10871 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
10872 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
10873 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
10874 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
10875
10876 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
10877 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
10878 This contains the expanded value of the
10879 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
10880 been read.
10881
10882 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
10883 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
10884 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10885 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
10886 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10887 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
10888
10889 .vitem &$log_space$&
10890 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
10891 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
10892 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
10893 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
10894 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
10895 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
10896
10897
10898 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
10899 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
10900 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
10901 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
10902 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
10903 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
10904 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
10905 variable is empty.
10906
10907 .vitem &$malware_name$&
10908 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
10909 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10910 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
10911 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
10912
10913 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
10914 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
10915 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
10916 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
10917 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
10918 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
10919 character(s).
10920
10921 .vitem &$message_age$&
10922 .cindex "message" "age of"
10923 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
10924 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
10925 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
10926 delivery attempt.
10927
10928 .vitem &$message_body$&
10929 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10930 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10931 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10932 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
10933 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
10934 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
10935 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
10936 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
10937 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
10938
10939 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
10940 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
10941 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
10942 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
10943 zeros are always converted into spaces.
10944
10945 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
10946 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10947 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10948 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
10949 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
10950 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
10951 &$message_body$&.
10952
10953 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
10954 .cindex "body of message" "size"
10955 .cindex "message body" "size"
10956 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
10957 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
10958 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
10959 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
10960 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
10961
10962 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
10963 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
10964 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10965 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
10966 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
10967 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
10968 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
10969 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
10970
10971 .vitem &$message_headers$&
10972 .vindex &$message_headers$&
10973 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
10974 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
10975 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
10976 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
10977
10978 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
10979 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
10980 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
10981 contents of header lines is done.
10982
10983 .vitem &$message_id$&
10984 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
10985
10986 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
10987 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
10988 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
10989 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
10990 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
10991 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
10992 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
10993 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
10994 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
10995 from the body is not counted. Here is an example of the use of this variable in
10996 a DATA ACL:
10997 .code
10998 deny message = Too many lines in message header
10999 condition = \
11000 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11001 .endd
11002 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11003 message has not yet been received.
11004
11005 .vitem &$message_size$&
11006 .cindex "size" "of message"
11007 .cindex "message" "size"
11008 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11009 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11010 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11011 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11012 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11013 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11014 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11015 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11016 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11017
11018 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11019 While running an ACL at the time of an SMTP RCPT command, &$message_size$&
11020 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11021 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11022
11023 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11024 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11025 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11026 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11027
11028 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11029 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11030 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11031
11032 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11033 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11034 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11035 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11036 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11037 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11038 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11039 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11040 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11041 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11042
11043 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11044 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11045 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11046
11047 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11048 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11049 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11050 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11051 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11052 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11053 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11054 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11055 the original address.
11056
11057 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11058 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11059 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11060 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11061 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11062
11063 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11064 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11065 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11066
11067 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11068 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11069 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11070 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11071 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11072 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11073 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11074 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11075 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11076
11077 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11078 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11079 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11080 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11081 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11082 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11083 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11084 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11085 user.
11086
11087 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11088 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11089 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11090 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11091
11092 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11093 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11094 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11095 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11096
11097 .vitem &$pid$&
11098 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11099 .vindex "&$pid$&"
11100 This variable contains the current process id.
11101
11102 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11103 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11104 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11105 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11106 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11107 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11108 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11109 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11110 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11111 variable"& error if encountered.
11112
11113 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11114 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11115 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11116 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11117 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11118 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11119 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11120
11121
11122 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11123 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11124 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11125 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11126
11127 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11128 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11129 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11130 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11131
11132 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11133 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11134 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11135 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11136
11137 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11138 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11139 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11140
11141 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11142 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11143 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11144 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11145
11146 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11147 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11148 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11149 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11150 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11151
11152 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11153 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11154 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11155 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11156 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11157 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11158
11159 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11160 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11161 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11162 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11163 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11164
11165 .vitem &$received_count$&
11166 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11167 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11168 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11169 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11170 delivering.
11171
11172 .vitem &$received_for$&
11173 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11174 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11175 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11176 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11177 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11178
11179 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11180 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11181 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11182 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11183 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11184 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11185 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11186 option.
11187
11188 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11189 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11190 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11191 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11192 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11193 time.
11194
11195 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11196 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11197 &(smtp)& transport).
11198
11199 .vitem &$received_port$&
11200 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11201 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11202
11203 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11204 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11205 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11206 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11207 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11208 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11209 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11210 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11211 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11212
11213 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11214 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11215 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11216 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11217 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11218 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11219
11220 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11221 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11222 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11223
11224 .vitem &$received_time$&
11225 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11226 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11227 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11228
11229 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11230 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11231 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11232 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11233 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11234 .display
11235 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11236 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11237 .endd
11238 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11239 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11240 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11241 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11242
11243 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11244 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11245 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11246 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11247
11248 .ilist
11249 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11250 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11251
11252 .next
11253 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11254
11255 .next
11256 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11257 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11258 MAIL).
11259
11260 .next
11261 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11262 .next
11263
11264 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11265 .endlist
11266
11267 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11268 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11269
11270 .vitem &$recipients$&
11271 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11272 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11273 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11274 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11275 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11276 cases:
11277
11278 .olist
11279 In a system filter file.
11280 .next
11281 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11282 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11283 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11284 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11285 .next
11286 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11287 .endlist
11288
11289
11290 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11291 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11292 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11293 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11294 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11295 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11296
11297
11298 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11299 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11300 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11301 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11302
11303
11304 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11305 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11306 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11307 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11308 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11309 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11310 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11311
11312 .vitem &$return_path$&
11313 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11314 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11315 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11316 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11317 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11318 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11319 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11320 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11321 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11322 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11323 envelope sender.
11324
11325 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11326 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11327 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11328
11329 .vitem &$runrc$&
11330 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11331 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11332 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11333 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11334 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11335 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11336 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11337 another.
11338
11339 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11340 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11341 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11342 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11343 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11344 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11345 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11346 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11347
11348 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11349 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11350 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11351 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11352 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11353 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11354
11355 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11356 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11357 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11358 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11359 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11360 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11361 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11362 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11363
11364 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11365 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11366 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11367
11368 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11369 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11370 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11371
11372 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11373 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11374 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11375 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11376 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11377 this:
11378 .display
11379 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11380 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11381 .endd
11382 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11383 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11384 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11385 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11386
11387 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11388 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11389 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11390 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11391 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11392 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11393 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11394 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11395 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11396 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11397 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11398 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11399 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11400
11401 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11402 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11403 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11404 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11405 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11406 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11407
11408 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11409 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11410 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11411 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11412
11413 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11414 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11415 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11416 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11417 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11418 &$authenticated_id$&.
11419
11420 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11421 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11422 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11423 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11424 other means, this variable is empty.
11425
11426 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11427 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11428 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11429 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11430 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11431 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11432 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11433
11434 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11435 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11436 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11437 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11438
11439 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11440 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11441 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11442 is set to &"1"&.
11443
11444 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11445 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11446 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11447 following are true:
11448
11449 .ilist
11450 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11451 .next
11452 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11453 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11454 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11455 .next
11456 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11457 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11458 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11459 .next
11460 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11461 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11462 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11463 .next
11464 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11465 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11466 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11467 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11468 .code
11469 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11470 .endd
11471 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11472 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11473 .endlist
11474
11475
11476 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11477 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11478 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11479 number that was used on the remote host.
11480
11481 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11482 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11483 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11484 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11485 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11486 called Exim.
11487
11488 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11489 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11490 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11491 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11492
11493 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11494 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11495 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11496 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11497 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11498 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11499 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11500 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11501 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11502 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11503 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11504 the parentheses.
11505
11506 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11507 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11508 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11509 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11510 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11511
11512 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11513 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11514 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11515 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11516 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11517
11518 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11519 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11520 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11521 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11522 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11523 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11524 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11525
11526 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11527 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11528 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11529 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11530 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11531
11532 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11533 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11534 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11535 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11536 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11537 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11538
11539 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11540 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11541 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11542 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11543 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11544 .code
11545 MAIL FROM:<>
11546 MAIL FROM: <>
11547 .endd
11548 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11549 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11550 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11551 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11552
11553 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11554 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11555 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11556 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11557 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11558 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11559 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11560
11561 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11562 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11563 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11564 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11565 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11566 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11567 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11568 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11569 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11570 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11571 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11572
11573 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11574 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11575 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11576 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11577 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11578 message is junk mail.
11579
11580 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11581 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11582 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11583 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11584
11585
11586 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11587 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11588 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11589
11590 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11591 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11592 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11593 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11594 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11595 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11596
11597 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11598 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11599 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11600 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11601 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11602 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11603 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11604 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11605 .code
11606 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11607 .endd
11608 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11609
11610
11611 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11612 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11613 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11614 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11615 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11616 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11617
11618 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11619 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11620 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11621 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11622
11623 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11624 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11625 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11626 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11627 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11628 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11629 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11630 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11631
11632 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11633 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11634 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11635 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11636 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11637 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11638
11639 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11640 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11641 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11642 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11643 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11644 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. &new("Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11645 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11646 deliveries.")
11647
11648 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11649 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11650 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11651 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11652
11653 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11654 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11655 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11656
11657 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11658 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11659 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11660 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11661 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11662 values for those that are behind (west).
11663
11664 .vitem &$tod_log$&
11665 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11666 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11667 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11668
11669 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11670 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11671 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11672 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11673 flag.
11674
11675 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11676 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11677 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11678 -0500.
11679
11680 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11681 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11682 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11683 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11684
11685 .vitem &$value$&
11686 .vindex "&$value$&"
11687 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11688 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11689 &*reduce*& expansion.
11690
11691 .vitem &$version_number$&
11692 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11693 The version number of Exim.
11694
11695 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11696 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11697 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11698 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11699
11700 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11701 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11702 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11703 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11704 .endlist
11705 .ecindex IIDstrexp
11706
11707
11708
11709 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11710 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11711
11712 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11713 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11714 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11715 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11716 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11717 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11718 the line
11719 .code
11720 EXIM_PERL = perl.o
11721 .endd
11722 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11723
11724
11725 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11726 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11727 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11728 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11729 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11730 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11731 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11732 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11733 a newly created Perl interpreter.
11734
11735 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11736 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11737 should usually be something like
11738 .code
11739 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11740 .endd
11741 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11742 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11743 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11744 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11745 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11746 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11747 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11748 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11749 two ways:
11750
11751 .ilist
11752 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11753 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11754 a startup when Exim is entered.
11755 .next
11756 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11757 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11758 .endlist
11759
11760 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11761 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11762
11763
11764 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11765 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11766 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11767 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
11768 forms:
11769 .code
11770 ${perl{foo}}
11771 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
11772 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
11773 .endd
11774 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
11775 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
11776 with an error message of the form
11777 .code
11778 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
11779 .endd
11780 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
11781 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
11782 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
11783 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
11784 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
11785 that was passed to &%die%&.
11786
11787
11788 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
11789 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
11790 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
11791 the Perl code
11792 .code
11793 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
11794 .endd
11795 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
11796 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
11797 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
11798
11799 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
11800 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
11801 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
11802 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
11803
11804 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
11805 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
11806 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
11807 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
11808 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
11809 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
11810 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
11811
11812
11813 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
11814 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
11815 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
11816 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
11817 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
11818 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
11819 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
11820 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
11821 avoided, but the output is lost.
11822
11823 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
11824 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
11825 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
11826 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
11827 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
11828 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
11829 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
11830 .code
11831 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
11832 .endd
11833 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
11834 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
11835 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
11836 as the first subroutine argument.
11837 .ecindex IIDperl
11838
11839
11840 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11841 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11842
11843 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
11844 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
11845 "Starting the daemon"
11846 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
11847 .cindex "interface" "listening"
11848 .cindex "network interface"
11849 .cindex "interface" "network"
11850 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
11851 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
11852 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
11853 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
11854 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
11855 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
11856 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
11857 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
11858 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
11859 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
11860 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
11861
11862 .olist
11863 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
11864 and ports to listen on.
11865 .next
11866 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
11867 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
11868 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
11869 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
11870 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
11871 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
11872 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
11873 as an error situation.
11874 .next
11875 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
11876 for the outgoing connection.
11877 .endlist
11878
11879
11880 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
11881 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
11882 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
11883 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
11884 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
11885
11886 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
11887 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
11888 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
11889 chapter describes how they operate.
11890
11891 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
11892 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
11893
11894
11895
11896 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
11897 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
11898 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
11899 following options:
11900
11901 .ilist
11902 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
11903 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
11904 .next
11905 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
11906 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
11907 .endlist
11908
11909 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
11910 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
11911 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
11912 colons. For example:
11913 .code
11914 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
11915 192.168.23.65 ; \
11916 ::1 ; \
11917 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
11918 .endd
11919 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
11920 in &%local_interfaces%&:
11921
11922 .olist
11923 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
11924 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
11925 .code
11926 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
11927 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
11928 .endd
11929 .next
11930 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
11931 with a colon separator, for example:
11932 .code
11933 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
11934 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
11935 .endd
11936 .endlist
11937
11938 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
11939 default setting contains just one port:
11940 .code
11941 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
11942 .endd
11943 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
11944 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
11945 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
11946 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
11947 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
11948
11949
11950
11951 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
11952 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
11953 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
11954 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
11955 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
11956 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11957 .code
11958 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
11959 .endd
11960 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
11961 .code
11962 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
11963 .endd
11964 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
11965
11966
11967
11968 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
11969 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
11970 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
11971 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
11972 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
11973 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
11974 exim.
11975
11976 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
11977 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
11978 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
11979 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
11980 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11981 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
11982 .code
11983 -oX 1225
11984 .endd
11985 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
11986 whereas
11987 .code
11988 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
11989 .endd
11990 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
11991 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
11992 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
11993
11994
11995
11996 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
11997 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
11998 .cindex "smtps protocol"
11999 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12000 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12001 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12002 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12003 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12004 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12005 common use of this option is expected to be
12006 .code
12007 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12008 .endd
12009 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12010 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12011 this way when a daemon is started.
12012
12013 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12014 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12015 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12016 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12017 connections via the daemon.)
12018
12019
12020
12021
12022 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12023 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12024 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12025 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12026 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12027 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12028 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12029 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12030 .code
12031 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12032 .endd
12033 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12034 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12035 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12036 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12037 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12038 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12039 .code
12040 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12041 .endd
12042 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12043 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12044 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12045 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12046 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12047
12048 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12049 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12050 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12051 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12052 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12053 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12054 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12055 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12056 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12057 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12058 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12059 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12060
12061 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12062 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12063 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12064 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12065 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12066
12067
12068
12069 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12070 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12071 .code
12072 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12073 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12074 .endd
12075 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12076 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12077 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12078 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12079
12080 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12081 .code
12082 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12083 .endd
12084 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12085 .code
12086 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12087 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12088 .endd
12089 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12090 IPv4 loopback address only:
12091 .code
12092 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12093 .endd
12094 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12095 .code
12096 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12097 .endd
12098 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12099
12100
12101
12102 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12103 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12104 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12105 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12106 treated as local.
12107
12108 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12109 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12110 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12111 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12112
12113 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12114 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12115 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12116 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12117 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12118 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12119 used for listening. Consider this example:
12120 .code
12121 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12122 192.168.53.235 ; \
12123 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12124
12125 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12126 .endd
12127 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12128 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12129 Exim is routing.
12130
12131 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12132 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12133 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12134 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12135 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12136 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12137 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12138 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12139
12140
12141
12142 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12143 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12144 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12145 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12146 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12147 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12148 details.
12149
12150
12151
12152
12153 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12154 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12155
12156 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12157 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12158 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12159 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12160
12161 .ilist
12162 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12163 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12164 .next
12165 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12166 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12167 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12168 .next
12169 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12170 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12171 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12172 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12173 settings.
12174 .endlist
12175
12176 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12177 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12178 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12179 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12180 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12181 listed in more than one group.
12182
12183 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12184 .table2
12185 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12186 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12187 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12188 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12189 .row &new(&%message_body_newlines%&) "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12190 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12191 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12192 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12193 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12194 .endtable
12195
12196
12197 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12198 .table2
12199 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12200 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12201 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12202 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12203 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12204 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12205 .endtable
12206
12207
12208
12209 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12210 .table2
12211 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12212 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12213 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12214 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12215 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12216 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12217 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12218 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12219 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12220 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12221 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12222 .endtable
12223
12224
12225
12226 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12227 .table2
12228 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12229 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12230 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12231 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12232 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12233 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12234 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12235 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12236 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12237 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12238 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12239 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12240 .endtable
12241
12242
12243
12244 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12245 .table2
12246 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12247 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12248 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12249 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12250 .endtable
12251
12252
12253
12254 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12255 .table2
12256 .row &new(&%ibase_servers%&) "InterBase servers"
12257 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12258 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12259 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12260 .row &new(&%mysql_servers%&) "default MySQL servers"
12261 .row &new(&%oracle_servers%&) "Oracle servers"
12262 .row &new(&%pgsql_servers%&) "default PostgreSQL servers"
12263 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12264 .endtable
12265
12266
12267
12268 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12269 .table2
12270 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12271 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12272 .endtable
12273
12274
12275
12276 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12277 .table2
12278 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12279 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12280 .endtable
12281
12282
12283
12284 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12285 .table2
12286 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12287 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12288 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12289 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12290 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12291 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12292 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12293 .endtable
12294
12295
12296
12297 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12298 .table2
12299 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12300 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12301 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12302 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12303 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12304 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12305 .row &new(&%queue_only_load_latch%&) "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12306 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12307 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12308 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12309 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12310 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12311 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12312 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12313 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12314 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12315 connection"
12316 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12317 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12318 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12319 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12320 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12321 .endtable
12322
12323
12324
12325 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12326 .table2
12327 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12328 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12329 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12330 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12331 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12332 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12333 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12334 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12335 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12336 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12337 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12338 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12339 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12340 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12341 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12342 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12343 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12344 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12345 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12346 words""&"
12347 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12348 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12349 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12350 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12351 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12352 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12353 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12354 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12355 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12356 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12357 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12358 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12359 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12360 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12361 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12362 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12363 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12364 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12365 .endtable
12366
12367
12368
12369 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12370 .table2
12371 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12372 item"
12373 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12374 item"
12375 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12376 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12377 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12378 .endtable
12379
12380
12381
12382 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12383 .table2
12384 .row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12385 .row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12386 .row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12387 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12388 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12389 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12390 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12391 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12392 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12393 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12394 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12395 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12396 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12397 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12398 .endtable
12399
12400
12401
12402 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12403 .table2
12404 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12405 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12406 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12407 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12408 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12409 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12410 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12411 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12412 .endtable
12413
12414
12415
12416 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12417 .table2
12418 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12419 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12420 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12421 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12422 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12423 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12424 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12425 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12426 .endtable
12427
12428
12429
12430
12431 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12432 .table2
12433 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12434 .endtable
12435
12436
12437
12438
12439
12440 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12441 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12442
12443 .table2
12444 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12445 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12446 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12447 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12448 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12449 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12450 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12451 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12452 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12453 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12454 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12455 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12456 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12457 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12458 connection"
12459 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12460 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12461 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12462 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12463 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12464 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12465 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12466 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12467 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12468 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12469 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12470 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12471 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12472 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12473 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12474 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12475 .endtable
12476
12477
12478
12479 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12480 .table2
12481 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12482 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12483 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12484 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12485 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12486 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12487 .endtable
12488
12489
12490
12491 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12492 .table2
12493 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12494 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12495 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12496 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12497 words""&"
12498 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12499 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12500 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12501 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12502 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12503 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12504 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12505 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12506 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12507 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12508 .endtable
12509
12510
12511
12512 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12513 .table2
12514 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12515 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12516 directory"
12517 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12518 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12519 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12520 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12521 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12522 .endtable
12523
12524
12525
12526 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12527 .table2
12528 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12529 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12530 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12531 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12532 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12533 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12534 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12535 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12536 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12537 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12538 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12539 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12540 .row &new(&%queue_only_load_latch%&) "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12541 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12542 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12543 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12544 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12545 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12546 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12547 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12548 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12549 .endtable
12550
12551
12552
12553 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12554 .table2
12555 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12556 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12557 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12558 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12559 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12560 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12561 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12562 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12563 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12564 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12565 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12566 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12567 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12568 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12569 .endtable
12570
12571
12572
12573 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12574 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12575 &dagger;.
12576
12577 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12578 .cindex "8BITMIME"
12579 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12580 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12581 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12582 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12583 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12584 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12585
12586 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12587 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12588 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12589 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12590 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12591 further details.
12592
12593 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12594 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12595 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12596 SMTP messages.
12597
12598 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12599 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12600 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12601 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12602 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12603
12604 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12605 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12606 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12607 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12608 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12609
12610 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12611 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12612 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12613 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12614
12615 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12616 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12617 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12618 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12619 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12620
12621 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12622 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12623 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12624 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12625
12626 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12627 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12628 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12629 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12630
12631 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12632 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12633 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12634 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12635 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12636
12637
12638 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12639 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12640 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12641 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12642
12643 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12644 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12645 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12646 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12647 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12648
12649 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12650 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12651 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12652 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12653 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12654
12655 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12656 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12657 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12658 further details.
12659
12660 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12661 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12662 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12663 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12664
12665 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12666 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12667 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12668 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12669
12670 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12671 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12672 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12673 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12674
12675 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12676 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12677 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12678 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12679
12680 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12681 .cindex "admin user"
12682 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12683 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12684 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12685 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12686 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12687 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12688 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12689
12690 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12691 .cindex "domain literal"
12692 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12693 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12694 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12695 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12696
12697 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12698 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12699 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12700 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12701 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12702 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12703 the local host's IP addresses.
12704
12705
12706 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12707 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12708 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12709 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12710 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12711 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12712 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12713 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12714 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12715
12716 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12717 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12718 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12719 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12720 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12721 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12722 experiment if they wish.
12723
12724 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12725 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12726 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12727 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12728 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12729 suitable setting is:
12730 .code
12731 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12732 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12733 .endd
12734 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12735 .code
12736 dns_check_names_pattern =
12737 .endd
12738 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12739
12740
12741 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12742 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12743 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12744 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12745 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12746 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12747 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12748 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12749 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12750 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12751 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12752
12753 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12754 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12755 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12756 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
12757 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
12758 which Exim advertises AUTH.
12759
12760 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
12761 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
12762 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
12763 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
12764 .code
12765 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
12766 .endd
12767 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12768 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
12769 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
12770 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
12771
12772
12773 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
12774 .cindex "thawing messages"
12775 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
12776 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
12777 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
12778 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
12779 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
12780 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
12781
12782 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
12783 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
12784 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
12785
12786 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
12787 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
12788 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
12789 .code
12790 sophie:/var/run/sophie
12791 .endd
12792 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
12793 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
12794
12795
12796
12797 .option bi_command main string unset
12798 .oindex "&%-bi%&"
12799 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
12800 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
12801 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
12802 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
12803
12804
12805 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
12806 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
12807 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
12808 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
12809 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
12810 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
12811
12812
12813 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
12814 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
12815 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
12816 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
12817
12818 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
12819 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
12820 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
12821 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
12822 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
12823 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
12824 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
12825 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
12826 point at which the error was detected are returned.
12827 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
12828
12829 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
12830 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
12831 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
12832 &%bounce_return_body%&.
12833
12834
12835 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
12836 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
12837 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
12838 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
12839 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
12840 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
12841 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
12842 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
12843 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
12844
12845 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
12846 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
12847 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
12848 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
12849 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
12850 messages.
12851
12852 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
12853 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
12854 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
12855 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
12856 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
12857 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
12858 connection. A typical setting might be:
12859 .code
12860 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12861 .endd
12862 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
12863 .code
12864 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12865 .endd
12866 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
12867 address.
12868
12869 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
12870 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
12871 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
12872 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
12873 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12874 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12875
12876
12877 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
12878 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
12879 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12880 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12881
12882
12883 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
12884 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
12885 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12886 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12887
12888
12889 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
12890 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
12891 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12892 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12893
12894
12895 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
12896 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
12897 callout verification. The default value is
12898 .code
12899 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
12900 .endd
12901 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
12902
12903
12904 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
12905 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12906
12907
12908 .option check_log_space main integer 0
12909 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12910
12911 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
12912 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
12913 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
12914 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
12915 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
12916 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
12917 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
12918 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
12919 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
12920 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
12921
12922
12923 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
12924 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12925
12926
12927 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
12928 .cindex "checking disk space"
12929 .cindex "disk space, checking"
12930 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
12931 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
12932 message is accepted.
12933
12934 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12935 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12936 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12937 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12938 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
12939 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
12940 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
12941 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
12942
12943
12944 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
12945 either value is greater than zero, for example:
12946 .code
12947 check_spool_space = 10M
12948 check_spool_inodes = 100
12949 .endd
12950 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
12951 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
12952 transit.
12953
12954 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
12955 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
12956 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
12957
12958 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
12959 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
12960 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
12961 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
12962 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
12963 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
12964
12965 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
12966 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
12967
12968 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
12969 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
12970 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
12971
12972 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
12973 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
12974 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
12975 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
12976 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
12977 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
12978
12979 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
12980 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
12981 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
12982 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
12983 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
12984 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
12985 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
12986
12987 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
12988 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
12989
12990 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
12991 .cindex "warning of delay"
12992 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
12993 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
12994 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
12995 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
12996 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
12997 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
12998 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
12999 with
13000 .code
13001 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13002 .endd
13003 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13004 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13005 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13006 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13007 .code
13008 delay_warning = 6h
13009 .endd
13010 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13011 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13012 .code
13013 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13014 .endd
13015
13016 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13017 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13018 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13019 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13020 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13021 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13022 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13023 not sent. The default is:
13024 .code
13025 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13026 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13027 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13028 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13029 } {no}{yes}}
13030 .endd
13031 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13032 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13033 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13034 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13035
13036 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13037 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13038 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13039 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13040 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13041 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13042 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13043 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13044
13045 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13046 .cindex "load average"
13047 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13048 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13049 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13050 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13051 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13052
13053
13054 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13055 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13056 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13057 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13058 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13059 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13060 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13061 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13062
13063 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13064 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13065 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13066 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13067 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13068 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13069 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13070 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13071
13072 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13073 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13074 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13075 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13076
13077
13078 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13079 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13080 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13081 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13082 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13083 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13084 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13085
13086
13087 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13088 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13089 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13090 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13091 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13092 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13093 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13094 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13095 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13096 by a setting such as this:
13097 .code
13098 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13099 .endd
13100 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13101 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13102 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13103 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13104 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13105 options are applied after this global option.
13106
13107 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13108 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13109 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13110 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13111 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13112 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13113 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13114 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13115 value of this option. The default pattern is
13116 .code
13117 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13118 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13119 .endd
13120 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13121 they must start and end with a letter or digit. &new(Slashes) are not, in fact,
13122 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13123 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13124 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13125 empty string.
13126
13127 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13128 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13129 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13130
13131 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13132 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13133 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13134 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13135
13136 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13137 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13138 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13139 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13140 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13141 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13142 domain matches this list.
13143
13144 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13145 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13146 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13147
13148
13149 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13150 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13151 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13152 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13153 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13154 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13155 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13156 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13157 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13158 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13159 to set in them.
13160
13161
13162 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13163 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13164
13165
13166 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13167 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13168 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13169 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13170
13171 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13172 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13173 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13174 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13175 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13176 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13177 .code
13178 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13179 .endd
13180 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13181 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13182
13183 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13184 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13185 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13186 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13187 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13188 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13189 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13190 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13191 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13192
13193
13194 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13195 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13196 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13197 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13198 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13199 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13200 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13201 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13202 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13203
13204 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13205 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13206 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13207 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13208 are examined. For example:
13209 .code
13210 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13211 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13212 postmaster@mydomain.example
13213 .endd
13214 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13215 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13216 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13217 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13218 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13219 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13220 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13221
13222
13223 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13224 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13225 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13226 .display
13227 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13228 .endd
13229 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13230 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13231 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13232 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13233 overrides the default.
13234
13235 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13236 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13237 and warning messages. For example:
13238 .code
13239 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13240 .endd
13241 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13242 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13243 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13244 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13245 not used.
13246
13247
13248 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13249 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13250 .cindex "Exim group"
13251 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13252 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13253 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13254 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13255 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13256 security issues.
13257
13258
13259 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13260 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13261 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13262 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13263 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13264 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13265 other place.
13266 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13267 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13268 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13269 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13270
13271
13272 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13273 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13274 .cindex "Exim user"
13275 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13276 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13277 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13278 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13279
13280 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13281 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13282 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13283 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13284
13285
13286 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13287 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13288 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13289 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13290
13291
13292 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13293 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13294
13295 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13296 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13297 .oindex "&%-t%&"
13298 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13299 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13300 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13301 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13302 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13303 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13304 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13305 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13306 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13307 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13308 addresses.
13309
13310
13311 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13312 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13313 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13314 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13315 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13316 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13317 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13318 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13319 retries.
13320
13321 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13322 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13323 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13324 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13325
13326
13327
13328 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13329 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13330 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13331 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13332 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13333 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13334 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13335 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13336 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13337 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13338 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13339 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13340 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13341 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13342 logging that you require.
13343
13344
13345 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13346 .cindex "HP-UX"
13347 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13348 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13349 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13350 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13351 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13352 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13353 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13354 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13355
13356 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13357 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13358 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13359 user's name.
13360
13361 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13362 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13363 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13364 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13365 .code
13366 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13367 gecos_name = $1
13368 .endd
13369
13370 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13371 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13372
13373
13374 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13375 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13376 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13377
13378 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13379 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13380 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13381
13382 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13383 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13384 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13385
13386
13387 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13388 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13389 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13390 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13391 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13392 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13393
13394
13395
13396 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13397 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13398 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13399 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13400 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13401 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13402 sections are rejected.
13403
13404
13405 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13406 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13407 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13408 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13409 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13410 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13411 zero means &"no limit"&.
13412
13413
13414
13415
13416 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13417 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13418 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13419 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13420 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13421 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13422 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13423 if you want to do semantic checking.
13424 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13425 set.
13426
13427
13428 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13429 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13430 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13431 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13432 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13433 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13434 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13435 .code
13436 helo_allow_chars = _
13437 .endd
13438 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13439
13440
13441 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13442 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13443 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13444 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13445 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13446 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13447 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13448 do.
13449
13450
13451 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13452 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13453 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13454 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13455 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13456 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13457 condition &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13458 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13459 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13460 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is
13461 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13462 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13463
13464 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13465 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13466 EHLO command either:
13467
13468 .ilist
13469 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13470 .next
13471 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13472 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13473 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13474 calling host address, or
13475 .next
13476 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13477 available) yields the calling host address.
13478 .endlist
13479
13480 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13481 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13482 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& condition.
13483
13484 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13485 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13486 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13487 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13488 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13489 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13490 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13491 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13492 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13493 error.
13494
13495 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13496 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13497 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13498 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13499 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13500 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13501 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13502 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13503 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13504
13505 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13506 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13507 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13508 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13509 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13510
13511 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13512 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13513 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13514 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13515
13516
13517 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13518 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13519 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13520 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13521 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13522 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13523 default configuration file contains
13524 .code
13525 host_lookup = *
13526 .endd
13527 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13528 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13529
13530 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13531 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13532 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13533
13534 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13535 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13536 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13537 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13538 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and &`verify`& &`=`&
13539 &`reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13540
13541
13542 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13543 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13544 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13545 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13546 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13547 if you want.
13548
13549 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13550 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13551 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13552 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13553
13554
13555
13556 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13557 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13558 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13559 as soon as the connection is made.
13560 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13561 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13562 connections immediately.
13563
13564 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13565 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13566 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13567 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13568 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13569
13570
13571 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13572 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13573 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13574 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13575 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13576 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13577 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13578 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13579 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13580 .code
13581 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13582 .endd
13583 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13584
13585
13586
13587 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13588 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13589 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13590 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13591 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13592 records
13593 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13594 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13595
13596 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13597 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13598 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13599 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13600 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13601 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13602 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13603
13604
13605 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13606 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13607 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13608 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13609 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13610
13611
13612
13613 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13614 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13615 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13616 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13617 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13618 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13619
13620 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13621 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13622 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13623 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13624 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13625 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13626 for frozen messages. For example,
13627 .code
13628 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13629 .endd
13630 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13631 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13632 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13633 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13634 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13635 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13636
13637
13638 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13639 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13640 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13641 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13642 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13643 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13644 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13645 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13646 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13647 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13648
13649
13650 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13651 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13652
13653
13654 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13655 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13656 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13657 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13658 logged.
13659
13660
13661 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13662 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13663 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13664 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13665 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13666 with LDAP support.
13667
13668
13669 .option ldap_version main integer unset
13670 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13671 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13672 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13673 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13674 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13675 has been built with LDAP support.
13676
13677
13678
13679 .option local_from_check main boolean true
13680 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
13681 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
13682 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13683 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
13684 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
13685 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
13686
13687 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
13688 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
13689 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
13690
13691 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
13692 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
13693 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
13694 and the default qualify domain.
13695
13696 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
13697 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
13698 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
13699 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
13700
13701 .cindex "envelope sender"
13702 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
13703 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
13704 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
13705
13706 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
13707 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
13708 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13709
13710
13711
13712
13713 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
13714 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
13715 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
13716 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
13717 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
13718 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
13719 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
13720 example, if
13721 .code
13722 local_from_prefix = *-
13723 .endd
13724 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
13725 .code
13726 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
13727 .endd
13728 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
13729 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
13730 qualify domain.
13731
13732
13733 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
13734 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
13735
13736
13737 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
13738 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
13739 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
13740 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
13741 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
13742 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
13743 &%local_interfaces%& is
13744 .code
13745 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13746 .endd
13747 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
13748 .code
13749 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13750 .endd
13751
13752 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
13753 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
13754 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
13755 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
13756 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
13757 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
13758 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
13759 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
13760
13761
13762
13763 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
13764 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
13765 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13766 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
13767 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
13768 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
13769 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
13770 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13771
13772
13773
13774
13775 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
13776 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
13777 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
13778 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13779 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
13780 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
13781 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
13782 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
13783 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
13784 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
13785 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
13786 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
13787 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
13788 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
13789 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
13790
13791
13792
13793 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
13794 .cindex "log" "file path for"
13795 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
13796 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
13797 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
13798 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
13799 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
13800 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
13801 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
13802 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
13803 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
13804 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
13805 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
13806 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
13807
13808
13809 .option log_selector main string unset
13810 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13811 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
13812 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
13813 minus characters. For example:
13814 .code
13815 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
13816 .endd
13817 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
13818 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
13819
13820
13821 .option log_timezone main boolean false
13822 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
13823 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13824 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13825 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
13826 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
13827 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
13828 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
13829 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
13830 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
13831 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
13832 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
13833 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
13834
13835
13836 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
13837 .cindex "too many open files"
13838 .cindex "open files, too many"
13839 .cindex "file" "too many open"
13840 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
13841 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
13842 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
13843 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
13844 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
13845 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
13846 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
13847 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
13848 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
13849 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
13850 &%lookup_open_max%&.
13851
13852
13853 .option max_username_length main integer 0
13854 .cindex "length of login name"
13855 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
13856 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
13857 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
13858 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
13859 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
13860 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
13861
13862
13863 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
13864 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
13865 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
13866 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13867 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13868 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
13869 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
13870 option is set true, this no longer happens.
13871
13872
13873 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
13874 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
13875 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
13876 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13877 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13878 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
13879 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
13880
13881
13882 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
13883 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
13884 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
13885 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
13886 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
13887 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
13888 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
13889 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
13890 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
13891 empty string, the option is ignored.
13892
13893
13894 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
13895 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
13896 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
13897 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
13898 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
13899 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
13900 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
13901 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
13902 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
13903 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
13904 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
13905 colons will become hyphens.
13906
13907
13908 .option message_logs main boolean true
13909 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
13910 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
13911 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
13912 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
13913 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
13914 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
13915 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
13916 which is not affected by this option.
13917
13918
13919 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
13920 .cindex "message" "size limit"
13921 .cindex "limit" "message size"
13922 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
13923 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
13924 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
13925 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
13926 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
13927 optionally followed by K or M.
13928
13929 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
13930 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
13931 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
13932 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
13933 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
13934
13935 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
13936 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
13937 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
13938 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
13939 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
13940 message that an individual transport can process.
13941
13942
13943 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
13944 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
13945 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
13946 .code
13947 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
13948 .endd
13949 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
13950 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
13951 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
13952 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
13953 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
13954
13955
13956 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
13957 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
13958 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
13959 contains a full description of this facility.
13960
13961
13962
13963 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
13964 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
13965 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
13966 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
13967 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
13968
13969
13970 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
13971 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
13972 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
13973 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
13974 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
13975 safety precaution.
13976
13977 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
13978 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
13979 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
13980 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
13981 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
13982
13983 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
13984 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
13985 example is
13986 .code
13987 never_users = root:daemon:bin
13988 .endd
13989 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
13990 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
13991 transport driver.
13992
13993
13994 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
13995 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
13996 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
13997 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13998 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
13999
14000
14001 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14002 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14003 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14004 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14005 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14006 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14007 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14008 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14009 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14010 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14011 an ACL.
14012
14013 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14014 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14015 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14016 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14017 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14018 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14019 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14020
14021
14022 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14023 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14024 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14025
14026
14027 .option perl_startup main string unset
14028 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14029 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14030
14031
14032 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14033 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14034 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14035 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14036 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14037 PostgreSQL support.
14038
14039
14040 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14041 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14042 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14043 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14044 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14045 to the host name:
14046 .code
14047 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14048 .endd
14049 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14050 spool directory.
14051 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14052 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14053 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14054
14055
14056 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14057 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14058 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14059 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14060 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14061 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14062 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14063 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14064 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14065
14066
14067 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14068 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14069 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14070 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14071 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14072 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14073 volume of mail. Use with care!
14074
14075
14076 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14077 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14078 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14079 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14080 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14081 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14082 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14083 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14084 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14085 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14086
14087 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14088 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14089 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14090 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14091 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14092 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14093
14094
14095 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14096 .cindex "printing characters"
14097 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14098 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14099 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14100 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14101 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14102 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14103 characters.
14104
14105 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14106 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14107 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14108 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14109 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14110 standards.
14111
14112
14113 .option process_log_path main string unset
14114 .cindex "process log path"
14115 .cindex "log" "process log"
14116 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14117 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14118 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14119 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14120 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14121 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14122 different spool directories.
14123
14124
14125 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14126 .oindex "&%-M%&"
14127 .oindex "&%-R%&"
14128 .oindex "&%-q%&"
14129 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14130 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14131 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14132
14133
14134 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14135 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14136 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14137 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14138 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14139 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14140 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14141 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14142 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14143
14144 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14145 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14146 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14147 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14148 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14149 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14150 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14151
14152
14153 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14154 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14155 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14156
14157
14158
14159 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14160 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14161 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14162 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14163 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14164 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14165 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14166 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14167
14168
14169 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14170 .oindex "&%-bp%&"
14171 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14172 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14173 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14174
14175
14176 .option queue_only main boolean false
14177 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14178 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14179 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14180 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14181 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14182 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14183
14184 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14185 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14186 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14187 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14188
14189
14190 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14191 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14192 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14193 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14194 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14195 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14196 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14197 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14198 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14199 .code
14200 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14201 .endd
14202 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14203 &_/some/file_& exists.
14204
14205
14206 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14207 .cindex "load average"
14208 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14209 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14210 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14211 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14212 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14213 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14214 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14215 false.
14216
14217 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14218 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14219 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14220 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14221
14222
14223 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14224 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14225 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14226 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14227 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14228 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14229 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14230 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14231 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14232 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14233 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14234 re-evaluated for each message.
14235
14236
14237 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14238 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14239 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14240 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14241 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14242 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14243
14244
14245 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14246 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14247 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14248 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14249 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14250 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14251 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14252 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14253 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14254 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14255 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14256 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14257 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14258
14259
14260
14261 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14262 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14263 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14264 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14265 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14266 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14267 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14268 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14269 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14270
14271 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14272 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14273 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14274 the daemon's command line.
14275
14276 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14277 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14278 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14279 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14280 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14281 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14282 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14283 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14284 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14285 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14286 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14287 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14288 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14289 &%queue_domains%&.
14290
14291
14292 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14293 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14294 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14295 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14296 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14297 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14298 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14299
14300 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14301 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14302 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14303 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14304 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14305 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14306 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14307 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14308 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14309 header lines. The default setting is:
14310
14311 .code
14312 received_header_text = Received: \
14313 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14314 {${if def:sender_ident \
14315 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14316 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14317 by $primary_hostname \
14318 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14319 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14320 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14321 ${if def:sender_address \
14322 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14323 id $message_exim_id\
14324 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14325 .endd
14326
14327 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14328 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14329 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14330 header lines such as the following:
14331 .code
14332 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14333 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14334 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14335 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14336 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14337 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14338 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14339 .endd
14340 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14341 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14342 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14343 message was accepted.
14344
14345
14346 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14347 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14348 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14349 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14350 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14351 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14352 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14353 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14354
14355
14356 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14357 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14358 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14359 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14360 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14361 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14362 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14363 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14364 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14365 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14366 option was not set.
14367
14368
14369 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14370 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14371 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14372 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14373 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14374 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14375 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14376 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14377 done.
14378
14379 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14380 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14381 RCPT commands in a single message.
14382
14383
14384 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14385 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14386 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14387 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14388 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14389 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14390 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14391
14392
14393 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14394 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14395 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14396 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14397 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14398 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14399 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14400 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14401 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14402 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14403 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14404 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14405 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14406 tagged with its process id.
14407
14408 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14409 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14410 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14411 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14412 is received.
14413
14414 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14415 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14416 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14417 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14418 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14419 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14420 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14421 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14422 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14423 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14424 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14425
14426 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14427 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14428 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14429 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14430
14431
14432 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14433 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14434 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14435 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14436 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14437 .code
14438 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14439 .endd
14440 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14441 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14442
14443
14444 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14445 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14446 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14447 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14448 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14449 past failures.
14450
14451
14452 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14453 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14454 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14455 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14456 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14457 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14458 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14459 the default value.
14460
14461
14462 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14463 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14464 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14465 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14466 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14467 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14468 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14469 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14470 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14471 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14472
14473
14474 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14475 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14476
14477
14478 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14479 .cindex "RFC 1413"
14480 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14481 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14482 in the list.
14483
14484 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14485 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14486 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14487 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14488 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14489
14490
14491 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14492 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14493 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14494 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14495 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14496 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14497 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14498 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14499 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14500 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14501
14502
14503 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14504 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14505 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14506 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14507 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14508 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14509 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14510 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14511 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14512 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14513 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14514
14515
14516
14517 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14518 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14519 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14520 .cindex "inetd"
14521 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14522 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14523 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14524 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14525 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14526 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14527
14528 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14529 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14530 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14531 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14532
14533
14534 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14535 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14536 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14537 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14538 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14539 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14540 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14541 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14542
14543 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14544 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14545 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14546 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14547 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14548 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14549 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14550 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14551
14552
14553 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14554 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14555 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14556 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14557 live with.
14558
14559
14560 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14561 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14562
14563 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14564 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14565 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14566 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14567 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14568 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14569 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14570 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14571 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14572 seen).
14573
14574
14575 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14576 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14577 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14578 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14579 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14580 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14581 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14582 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14583 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14584 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14585 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14586
14587 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14588 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14589 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14590 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14591 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14592 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14593
14594
14595
14596 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14597 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14598 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14599 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14600 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14601 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14602 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14603 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14604 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14605 to all messages received in the same connection.
14606
14607 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14608 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14609 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14610 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14611
14612
14613 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14614 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14615
14616 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14617 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14618 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14619 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14620 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14621 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14622 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14623 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14624 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14625 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14626 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14627 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14628 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14629
14630
14631 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14632 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14633 .cindex "host" "reserved"
14634 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14635 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14636 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14637 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14638 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
14639 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
14640 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
14641 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
14642 individual host.
14643
14644 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
14645 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
14646 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
14647 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
14648
14649
14650 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
14651 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
14652 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
14653 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14654 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
14655 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
14656 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
14657 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
14658 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
14659
14660 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
14661 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
14662 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
14663 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
14664
14665 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
14666 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
14667 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
14668 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
14669 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
14670 For example:
14671 .code
14672 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
14673 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
14674 .endd
14675
14676 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
14677 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
14678 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
14679 &%helo_data%& value.
14680
14681 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
14682 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
14683 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
14684 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
14685 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
14686 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
14687 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
14688 .code
14689 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
14690 $version_number $tod_full
14691 .endd
14692 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
14693 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
14694 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
14695 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
14696 multiline response).
14697
14698
14699 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
14700 .cindex "checking disk space"
14701 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14702 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14703 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
14704 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
14705 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
14706 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
14707 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
14708
14709
14710 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
14711 .cindex "connection backlog"
14712 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
14713 .cindex "backlog of connections"
14714 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
14715 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
14716 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
14717 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
14718 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
14719 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14720 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14721 attacks by SYN flooding.
14722
14723
14724 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
14725 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
14726 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
14727 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14728 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14729 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14730 fewer, but they still exist.
14731
14732 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14733 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14734 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
14735 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
14736 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
14737 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
14738 does detect many instances.
14739
14740 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
14741 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
14742 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
14743 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
14744
14745
14746
14747 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
14748 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
14749 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14750 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
14751 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
14752 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
14753 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
14754 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
14755 example:
14756 .code
14757 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
14758 $sender_host_address
14759 .endd
14760 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
14761 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
14762 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
14763 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
14764 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
14765 the command.
14766
14767
14768 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
14769 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
14770 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
14771 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
14772 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
14773
14774
14775 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
14776 .cindex "load average"
14777 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
14778 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
14779 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
14780 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
14781 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
14782 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
14783
14784
14785
14786 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
14787 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
14788 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
14789 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
14790 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
14791 .code
14792 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
14793 .endd
14794 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
14795 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
14796 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
14797 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
14798 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
14799
14800 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
14801 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
14802 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
14803 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
14804 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
14805 not count towards the limit.
14806
14807
14808
14809 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
14810 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
14811 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
14812 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
14813 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
14814 that subvert web
14815 clients
14816 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
14817 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
14818
14819
14820
14821 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14822 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
14823 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
14824 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
14825 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
14826 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
14827 recipients.
14828
14829 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
14830 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
14831 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
14832 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
14833
14834 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
14835 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
14836 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
14837 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
14838 values:
14839
14840 .ilist
14841 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
14842 .next
14843 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
14844 fractional parts are allowed here.
14845 .next
14846 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
14847 .next
14848 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
14849 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
14850 .endlist
14851
14852 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
14853 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
14854 .code
14855 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
14856 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
14857 .endd
14858 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
14859 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
14860 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
14861 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
14862
14863
14864 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
14865 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14866
14867
14868 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
14869 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14870
14871
14872 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
14873 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
14874 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
14875 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
14876 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
14877 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
14878 the message is abandoned.
14879 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
14880 .code
14881 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
14882 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
14883 .endd
14884 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
14885 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
14886
14887
14888 .oindex "&%-os%&"
14889 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
14890 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
14891 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
14892 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
14893 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
14894
14895
14896 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14897 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
14898 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
14899
14900
14901 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
14902 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
14903 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
14904 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
14905 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
14906 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
14907 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
14908 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
14909 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
14910 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
14911 .code
14912 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
14913 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
14914 .endd
14915
14916 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
14917 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
14918 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
14919 The default value is
14920 .code
14921 127.0.0.1 783
14922 .endd
14923 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
14924
14925
14926
14927 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
14928 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
14929 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
14930 .cindex "directories, multiple"
14931 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
14932 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
14933 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
14934 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
14935 arrival of the message.
14936
14937 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
14938 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
14939 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
14940 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
14941 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
14942
14943 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
14944 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
14945 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
14946 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
14947 automatically deleted.
14948
14949 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
14950 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
14951 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
14952 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
14953 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
14954 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
14955 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
14956 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
14957 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
14958
14959
14960 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
14961 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
14962 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
14963 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
14964 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
14965 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
14966 &$primary_hostname$&.
14967
14968 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
14969 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
14970 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
14971 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
14972 as failures in the configuration file.
14973
14974 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
14975 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
14976
14977 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
14978 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
14979 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
14980 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
14981
14982 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
14983 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
14984 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
14985 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
14986 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
14987 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
14988
14989 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
14990 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
14991 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
14992 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
14993 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
14994 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
14995 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
14996
14997
14998 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
14999 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15000 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15001 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15002 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15003 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15004 domain causes a syntax error.
15005 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15006 syntax checking.
15007
15008
15009 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15010 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15011 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15012 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15013 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15014 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15015 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15016 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15017 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15018 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15019 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15020 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15021
15022
15023 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15024 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15025 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15026 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15027 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15028 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15029 details of Exim's logging.
15030
15031
15032
15033 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15034 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15035 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15036 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15037 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15038
15039
15040
15041 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15042 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15043 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15044 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15045 details of Exim's logging.
15046
15047
15048 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15049 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15050 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15051 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15052 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15053 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15054 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15055 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15056 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15057 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15058 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15059
15060
15061 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15062 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15063 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15064 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15065 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15066 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15067
15068
15069 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15070 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15071 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15072 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15073 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15074
15075 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15076 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15077 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15078 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15079 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15080
15081 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15082 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15083 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15084 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15085 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15086 contains the pipe command.
15087
15088
15089 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15090 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15091 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15092 is used in a system filter.
15093
15094 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15095 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15096 If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
15097 process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
15098 process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15099 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15100 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15101 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15102 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15103
15104 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15105 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15106 transport option overrides. Normally you should set &%system_filter_user%& if
15107 your system filter generates these kinds of delivery.
15108
15109
15110 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15111 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15112 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15113 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15114 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15115 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15116 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15117 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15118 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15119 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15120 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15121 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15122 TCP_NODELAY.
15123
15124
15125 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15126 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15127 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15128 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15129 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15130 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15131 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15132 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15133 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15134 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15135
15136 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15137 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15138 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15139
15140
15141 .option timezone main string unset
15142 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15143 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15144 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15145 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15146 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15147 .code
15148 timezone = UTC
15149 .endd
15150 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15151 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15152 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15153 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15154 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15155 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15156
15157
15158 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15159 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15160 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15161 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15162 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15163 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15164 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15165 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15166
15167
15168 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15169 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15170 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15171 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15172 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15173 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15174 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15175
15176 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15177 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15178 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15179 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15180
15181
15182 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15183 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15184 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15185 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15186 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15187
15188
15189 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15190 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15191 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15192 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15193 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15194 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15195
15196
15197 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15198 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15199 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15200 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15201 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15202
15203
15204
15205 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15206 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15207 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15208 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15209 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15210 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15211 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15212
15213
15214 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15215 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15216 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15217 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15218 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15219 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15220 TLS session.
15221
15222
15223 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15224 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15225 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15226 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15227 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15228 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15229 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15230 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15231 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15232 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15233 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15234
15235
15236 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15237 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15238 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15239 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15240
15241
15242 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15243 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15244 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15245 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15246 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15247 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15248 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15249 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15250 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15251
15252
15253 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15254 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15255 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15256 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15257 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15258 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15259 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15260 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15261
15262 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15263 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15264 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15265 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15266 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15267 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15268 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15269
15270 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15271 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15272 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15273 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15274 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15275 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15276 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15277 certificate"&.
15278
15279 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15280 certificates.
15281
15282
15283 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15284 .cindex "trusted groups"
15285 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15286 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15287 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15288 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15289 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15290 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15291 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15292 are trusted.
15293
15294 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15295 .cindex "trusted users"
15296 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15297 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15298 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15299 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15300 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15301 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15302 Exim user are trusted.
15303
15304 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15305 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15306 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15307 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15308 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15309 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15310 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15311 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15312 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15313 &%-F%& option.
15314
15315 .option unknown_username main string unset
15316 See &%unknown_login%&.
15317
15318 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15319 .cindex "trusted users"
15320 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15321 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15322 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15323 .cindex "envelope sender"
15324 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15325 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15326 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15327 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15328 is used) is ignored.
15329
15330 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15331 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15332 .code
15333 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15334 .endd
15335 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15336 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15337 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15338 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15339 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15340 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15341 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15342 followed by a hyphen
15343 by a setting like this:
15344 .code
15345 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15346 .endd
15347 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15348 restriction, you can use
15349 .code
15350 untrusted_set_sender = *
15351 .endd
15352 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15353 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15354 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15355 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15356 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15357 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15358 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15359 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15360
15361 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15362 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15363 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15364 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15365 sender address.
15366
15367
15368 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15369 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15370 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15371 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15372 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15373 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15374 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15375 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15376 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15377 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15378 .code
15379 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15380 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15381 .endd
15382 The pattern can be seen by running
15383 .code
15384 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15385 .endd
15386 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15387 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15388 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15389 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15390 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15391 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15392
15393
15394 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15395 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15396
15397
15398 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15399 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15400 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15401 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15402 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15403 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15404 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15405 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15406
15407
15408 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15409 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15410 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15411 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15412 .ecindex IIDconfima
15413 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15414
15415
15416
15417
15418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15420
15421 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15422 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15423 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15424 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15425 Those that are preconditions are marked with &Dagger; in the &"use"& field.
15426
15427 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15428 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15429 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15430 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15431 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15432
15433
15434
15435 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15436 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15437 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15438 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15439 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15440 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15441 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15442
15443 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15444 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15445 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15446 routers, and the eventual transport.
15447
15448 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15449 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15450 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15451 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15452 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15453
15454 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15455 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15456 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15457 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15458 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15459
15460 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15461 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15462 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15463 .code
15464 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15465 .endd
15466 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15467 .code
15468 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15469 .endd
15470 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15471 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15472
15473 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15474 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15475 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15476 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15477 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15478 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15479 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15480
15481
15482
15483 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15484 .oindex "&%-bt%&"
15485 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15486 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15487 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15488 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15489 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15490 routing.
15491
15492
15493
15494 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15495 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15496 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15497 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15498 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15499 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15500 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15501 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15502 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15503 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15504 you could put:
15505 .code
15506 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15507 .endd
15508 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15509 and
15510 .code
15511 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15512 .endd
15513 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15514 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15515 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15516 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15517
15518
15519 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15520 .cindex "case of local parts"
15521 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15522 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15523 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15524 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15525 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15526 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15527 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15528 more details.
15529
15530 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15531 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15532 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15533 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15534 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15535 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15536 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15537 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15538 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15539
15540 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15541 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15542 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15543 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15544
15545
15546
15547 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15548 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
15549 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15550 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15551 .vindex "&$home$&"
15552 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15553 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15554 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15555 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15556 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15557 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15558 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15559 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15560 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15561 the router is skipped.
15562
15563 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15564 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15565 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15566 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15567 setting to achieve this. For example:
15568 .code
15569 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15570 .endd
15571 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15572 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15573 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15574
15575
15576
15577 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15578 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15579 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15580 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15581 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15582 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15583 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15584 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15585
15586 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15587 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15588
15589 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15590 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15591 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15592 .code
15593 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15594 .endd
15595 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15596 .code
15597 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15598 .endd
15599 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15600 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15601 be specified using &%condition%&.
15602
15603
15604
15605 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15606 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15607 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15608 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15609 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15610 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15611 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15612 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15613 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15614 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15615 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15616 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15617
15618
15619
15620 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
15621 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15622 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15623 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15624 transport option of the same name.
15625
15626
15627 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
15628 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
15629 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
15630 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15631 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15632 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
15633 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
15634 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
15635
15636
15637
15638 .option driver routers string unset
15639 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15640 to be used.
15641
15642
15643
15644 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
15645 .cindex "envelope sender"
15646 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
15647 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
15648 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
15649 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
15650 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
15651 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
15652 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
15653
15654 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15655 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
15656 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
15657 setting.
15658
15659 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15660 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15661 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15662 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15663
15664 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
15665 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
15666 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15667 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
15668 settings:
15669 .code
15670 errors_to =
15671 errors_to = ""
15672 .endd
15673 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15674 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15675 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15676 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
15677 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
15678
15679 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15680 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15681 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15682 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15683 setting &%return_path%&.
15684
15685 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
15686 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
15687 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
15688
15689
15690
15691 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
15692 .cindex "address" "testing"
15693 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
15694 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
15695 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
15696 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15697 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15698 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
15699 on for the system alias file.
15700 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15701 are evaluated.
15702
15703 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15704 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15705 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
15706
15707
15708
15709 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
15710 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
15711 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
15712 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
15713
15714
15715
15716 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
15717 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15718 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
15719
15720
15721
15722 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
15723 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15724 verifying a sender, verification fails.
15725
15726
15727
15728 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
15729 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
15730 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
15731 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
15732 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
15733 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
15734 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
15735 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
15736 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
15737
15738 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
15739 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
15740 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
15741 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
15742 transport for further details.
15743
15744
15745 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
15746 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
15747 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15748 .cindex "transport" "local"
15749 .cindex "router" "setting group"
15750 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15751 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
15752 process.
15753 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15754 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15755 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
15756 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
15757 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15758
15759
15760
15761 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
15762 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
15763 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
15764 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15765 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15766 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15767 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
15768 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
15769 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
15770 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
15771 &"see"& the added header lines.
15772
15773 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
15774 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
15775 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
15776 failures are treated as configuration errors.
15777
15778 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15779 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15780
15781 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
15782 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
15783 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15784 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
15785 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
15786 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
15787 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
15788 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
15789 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
15790 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
15791
15792
15793
15794 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
15795 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
15796 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
15797 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15798 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15799 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15800 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
15801 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
15802 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
15803 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
15804 &"see"& the original header lines.
15805
15806 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
15807 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
15808 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
15809 errors.
15810
15811 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15812 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15813
15814 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15815 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
15816 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
15817 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
15818
15819
15820 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
15821 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
15822 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
15823 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
15824 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
15825 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
15826 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
15827 like
15828 .code
15829 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
15830 .endd
15831 by setting
15832 .code
15833 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
15834 .endd
15835 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
15836 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
15837 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
15838 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
15839 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
15840 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
15841
15842 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
15843 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
15844 .code
15845 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
15846 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
15847 .endd
15848 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
15849 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
15850
15851 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
15852 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
15853 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
15854 domain that is being routed.
15855
15856 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
15857 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
15858 checked.
15859
15860 .option initgroups routers boolean false
15861 .cindex "additional groups"
15862 .cindex "groups" "additional"
15863 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15864 .cindex "transport" "local"
15865 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
15866 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
15867 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
15868 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
15869 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15870
15871
15872
15873 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
15874 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
15875 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
15876 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
15877 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
15878 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
15879 evaluated.
15880
15881 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
15882 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
15883 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
15884 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
15885 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
15886 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
15887 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
15888 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
15889 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
15890
15891 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15892 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
15893 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
15894 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
15895 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
15896 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
15897 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
15898 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
15899 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
15900 the relevant transport.
15901
15902 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
15903 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
15904 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
15905 callout.
15906
15907 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
15908 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
15909 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
15910 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
15911 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
15912 .code
15913 real_localuser:
15914 driver = accept
15915 local_part_prefix = real-
15916 check_local_user
15917 transport = local_delivery
15918 .endd
15919 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
15920 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
15921 .code
15922 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
15923 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
15924 .endd
15925
15926 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
15927 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
15928 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
15929 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
15930
15931
15932 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
15933 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
15934
15935
15936
15937 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
15938 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
15939 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
15940 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
15941 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
15942 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
15943 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
15944 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
15945 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
15946 &%username-foo%&.
15947
15948
15949 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
15950 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
15951
15952
15953
15954 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
15955 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
15956 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
15957 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
15958 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15959 are evaluated, and
15960 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
15961 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
15962 example:
15963 .code
15964 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
15965 .endd
15966 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
15967 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
15968 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
15969 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
15970 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
15971 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
15972 each virtual domain:
15973 .code
15974 postmaster:
15975 driver = redirect
15976 local_parts = postmaster
15977 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
15978 .endd
15979
15980
15981 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
15982 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
15983 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
15984 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
15985 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
15986 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
15987 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
15988 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
15989 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
15990 redirect addresses.
15991
15992
15993
15994 .option more routers boolean&!! true
15995 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
15996 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
15997 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
15998 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
15999 delivery to be deferred.
16000
16001 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16002 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16003 .oindex "&%self%&"
16004 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16005 means of the setting
16006 .code
16007 self = pass
16008 .endd
16009 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16010 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16011 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16012
16013 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16014 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16015 controls what happens next.
16016
16017
16018 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16019 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16020 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16021 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16022 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16023 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16024 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16025 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16026
16027 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16028 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16029 applies to all of them.
16030
16031
16032
16033 .option pass_router routers string unset
16034 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16035 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16036 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16037 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16038 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16039 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16040 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16041 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16042 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16043 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16044
16045
16046
16047 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16048 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16049 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16050 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16051 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16052 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16053
16054 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16055 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16056 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16057 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16058
16059
16060
16061 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16062 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16063 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16064 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16065 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16066 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16067 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16068
16069 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16070 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16071 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16072 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16073
16074 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16075 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16076 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16077 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16078 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16079
16080 .cindex "NFS"
16081 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16082 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16083 unavailable.
16084
16085 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16086 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16087 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16088 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16089 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16090 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16091 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16092 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16093
16094 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16095 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16096 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16097 operates as follows:
16098
16099 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16100 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16101 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16102 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16103 used. For example:
16104 .code
16105 require_files = mail:/some/file
16106 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16107 .endd
16108 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16109 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16110
16111 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16112 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16113 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16114 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16115
16116 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16117 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16118 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16119 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16120 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16121
16122 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16123 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16124 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16125 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16126 check again in that process.
16127
16128 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16129 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16130 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16131 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16132 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16133 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16134 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16135 .code
16136 require_files = +/some/file
16137 .endd
16138 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16139 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16140 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16141
16142
16143
16144 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16145 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16146 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16147 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16148 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16149 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16150 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16151 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16152 latter kind.
16153
16154 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16155 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16156 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16157 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16158 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16159 same name.
16160
16161 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16162 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16163 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16164
16165
16166
16167 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16168 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16169 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16170 .vindex "&$home$&"
16171 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16172 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16173 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16174 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16175 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16176 cause the router to defer.
16177
16178 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16179 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16180 place.
16181 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16182 are evaluated.)
16183 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16184 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16185
16186 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16187 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16188 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16189 of these values that is set:
16190
16191 .ilist
16192 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16193 .next
16194 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16195 .next
16196 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16197 .next
16198 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16199 .endlist
16200
16201 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16202 router, but not for the transport.
16203
16204
16205
16206 .option self routers string freeze
16207 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16208 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16209 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16210 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16211 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16212 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16213 of remote hosts.
16214 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16215 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16216 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16217 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16218 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16219
16220 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16221 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16222 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16223 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16224 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16225 cases:
16226
16227 .vlist
16228 .vitem &%defer%&
16229 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16230
16231 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16232 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16233 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16234 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16235
16236 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16237 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16238 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16239 rewritten.
16240
16241 .vitem &%pass%&
16242 .oindex "&%more%&"
16243 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16244 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16245 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16246 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16247 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16248 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16249 combination
16250 .code
16251 self = pass
16252 no_more
16253 .endd
16254 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16255 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16256 be passed to the next router.
16257
16258 .vitem &%fail%&
16259 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16260
16261 .vitem &%send%&
16262 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16263 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16264 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16265 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16266 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16267 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16268 .endlist
16269
16270
16271
16272 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16273 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16274 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16275 address matches something on the list.
16276 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16277 are evaluated.
16278
16279 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16280 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16281 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16282 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16283 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16284 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16285 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16286 matters.
16287
16288
16289 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16290 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16291 .cindex "packet radio"
16292 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16293 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16294 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16295 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16296 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16297 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16298 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16299 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16300
16301 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16302 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16303 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16304 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16305 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16306 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16307 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16308 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16309 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16310 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16311 .code
16312 translate_ip_address = \
16313 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16314 {$value}fail}}
16315 .endd
16316 The file would contain lines like
16317 .code
16318 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16319 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16320 .endd
16321 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16322 are doing.
16323
16324
16325
16326 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16327 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16328 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16329 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16330 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16331 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16332 delivery is deferred.
16333
16334 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16335 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16336 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16337
16338
16339
16340 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16341 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16342 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16343 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16344 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16345 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16346 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16347 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16348 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16349 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16350 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16351 environment.
16352
16353
16354
16355
16356 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16357 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16358 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16359 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16360 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16361 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16362 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16363 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16364 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16365 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16366
16367 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16368 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16369 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16370 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16371 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16372
16373 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16374 environment.
16375
16376
16377
16378
16379 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16380 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16381 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16382 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16383 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16384 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16385 delivery to be deferred.
16386
16387 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16388 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16389 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16390 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16391 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16392 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16393
16394 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16395 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16396 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16397 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16398 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16399 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16400 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16401 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16402
16403 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16404 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16405 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16406 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16407 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16408 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16409 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16410 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16411 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16412 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16413
16414 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16415 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16416 subsequent routers.
16417
16418
16419 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16420 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16421 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16422 .cindex "transport" "local"
16423 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16424 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16425 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16426 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16427 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16428 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16429 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16430 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16431 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16432 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16433 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16434 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16435
16436
16437
16438 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16439 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16440 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16441
16442
16443 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16444 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16445 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
16446 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16447 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16448 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16449 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16450 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16451 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16452
16453 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16454 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16455 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16456 user or group.
16457
16458
16459 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16460 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16461 addresses
16462 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16463 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16464 are evaluated.
16465
16466
16467 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16468 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16469 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16470 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16471 are evaluated.
16472 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16473 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16474
16475
16476
16477
16478
16479
16480 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16481 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16482
16483 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16484 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16485 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16486 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16487 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16488 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16489 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16490 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16491 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16492 .code
16493 localusers:
16494 driver = accept
16495 domains = mydomain.example
16496 check_local_user
16497 transport = local_delivery
16498 .endd
16499 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16500 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16501 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16502 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16503
16504
16505
16506
16507
16508
16509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16510 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16511
16512 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16513 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16514 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16515 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16516 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16517 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16518
16519 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16520 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16521 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16522 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16523 records.
16524
16525 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16526 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16527 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16528 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16529 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16530 generic option, the router declines.
16531
16532 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16533 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16534 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16535
16536 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16537 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16538 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16539 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16540 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16541 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16542
16543
16544 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16545 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16546 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16547 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16548 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16549 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16550
16551 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16552 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16553 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16554 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16555 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16556 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16557 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16558 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16559 case routing fails.
16560
16561
16562
16563
16564 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16565 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16566 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16567
16568 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16569 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16570 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16571 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16572 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16573 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16574 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16575
16576
16577 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16578 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16579 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16580 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16581 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16582 required. For example,
16583 .code
16584 check_srv = smtp
16585 .endd
16586 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16587 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16588 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16589 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16590 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16591 normal way.
16592
16593 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16594 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16595 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16596 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16597 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16598 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16599
16600 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16601 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16602 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16603 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16604 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16605 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16606 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16607 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16608
16609 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16610 when there is a DNS lookup error.
16611
16612
16613
16614 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16615 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16616 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16617 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16618 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16619 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16620 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
16621 setting:
16622 .code
16623 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16624 .endd
16625 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16626 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16627 the address record.
16628
16629
16630 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16631 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16632 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16633 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16634
16635
16636
16637
16638 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
16639 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16640 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
16641 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16642 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16643 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16644 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
16645 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
16646 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
16647 &'resolv.conf'&.
16648
16649
16650
16651 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
16652 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
16653 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
16654 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16655 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16656 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
16657 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
16658 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
16659 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
16660 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
16661 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
16662
16663 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16664 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16665 sense.
16666
16667 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16668 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16669 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16670 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16671 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16672 header rewriting.
16673
16674
16675 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
16676 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
16677 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
16678 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16679 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16680 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16681 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16682 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16683
16684 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16685 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
16686 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
16687 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
16688 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16689 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16690 without processing them independently,
16691 provided the following conditions are met:
16692
16693 .ilist
16694 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
16695 &%headers_remove%&.
16696 .next
16697 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
16698 the domain.
16699 .endlist
16700
16701
16702
16703
16704 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
16705 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16706 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16707 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
16708 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
16709 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
16710 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
16711 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
16712 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
16713 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
16714
16715 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16716 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16717 local wildcard.
16718
16719
16720
16721 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16722 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16723 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
16724 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16725
16726
16727
16728
16729 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
16730 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
16731 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
16732 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
16733 if
16734 .code
16735 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
16736 .endd
16737 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
16738 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
16739 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
16740 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
16741 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
16742 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
16743
16744
16745 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
16746 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
16747 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
16748 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
16749 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
16750
16751 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
16752 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
16753 such as that implied by
16754 .code
16755 domains = @mx_any
16756 .endd
16757 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
16758 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
16759 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
16760 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
16761
16762
16763
16764
16765
16766
16767
16768
16769
16770 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16771 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16772
16773 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
16774 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
16775 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
16776 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
16777 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
16778 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
16779 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
16780 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
16781 router handles the address
16782 .code
16783 root@[192.168.1.1]
16784 .endd
16785 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
16786 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
16787 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
16788 .code
16789 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
16790 .endd
16791 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
16792 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
16793
16794 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
16795 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
16796 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
16797 &%self%& option determines what happens.
16798
16799 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
16800 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
16801 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
16802 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
16803
16804
16805
16806 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16807 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16808
16809 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
16810 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
16811 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
16812 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
16813 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
16814 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
16815 must set
16816 .code
16817 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
16818 .endd
16819 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
16820
16821 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
16822 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
16823 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
16824 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
16825 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
16826 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
16827 must not be specified for it.
16828
16829 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
16830 .option hosts iplookup string unset
16831 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
16832 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
16833 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
16834 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
16835 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
16836
16837
16838 .option optional iplookup boolean false
16839 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
16840 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
16841 delivery to the address is deferred.
16842
16843
16844 .option port iplookup integer 0
16845 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
16846 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
16847 call.
16848
16849
16850 .option protocol iplookup string udp
16851 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
16852 protocols is to be used.
16853
16854
16855 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
16856 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
16857 default value is:
16858 .code
16859 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
16860 .endd
16861 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
16862 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
16863
16864
16865 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
16866 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
16867 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
16868 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
16869 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
16870 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
16871 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
16872 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
16873
16874
16875 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
16876 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
16877 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
16878 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
16879 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
16880 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
16881 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
16882 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
16883 following could be used:
16884 .code
16885 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
16886 reroute = $local_part@$1
16887 .endd
16888
16889 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
16890 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
16891 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
16892 call. It does not apply to UDP.
16893
16894
16895
16896
16897 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16899
16900 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
16901 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
16902 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
16903 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
16904 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
16905 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
16906 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
16907 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
16908 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
16909 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
16910
16911 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
16912 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
16913 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
16914 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
16915 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
16916 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
16917 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
16918
16919 .vindex "&$host$&"
16920 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
16921 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
16922 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
16923 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
16924 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
16925 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
16926 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
16927 text string.
16928
16929 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
16930 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
16931 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
16932 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
16933 below, following the list of private options.
16934
16935
16936 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
16937
16938 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
16939 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
16940
16941 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
16942 See &%host_find_failed%&.
16943
16944 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
16945 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
16946 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
16947 of the following values:
16948 .code
16949 decline
16950 defer
16951 fail
16952 freeze
16953 ignore
16954 pass
16955 .endd
16956 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
16957 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
16958 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
16959 &%pass_router%&),
16960 .oindex "&%more%&"
16961 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
16962 router only if &%more%& is true.
16963
16964 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
16965 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
16966 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
16967 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
16968
16969 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
16970 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
16971 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
16972
16973
16974 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
16975 .cindex "randomized host list"
16976 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
16977 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
16978 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
16979 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
16980 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
16981 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
16982 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
16983 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
16984
16985 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
16986 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
16987 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
16988 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
16989 .code
16990 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
16991 .endd
16992 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
16993 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
16994 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
16995 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
16996 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
16997
16998
16999 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17000 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17001 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17002 example:
17003 .code
17004 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17005 .endd
17006 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17007 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17008 deferred.
17009
17010
17011 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17012 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17013 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17014 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17015
17016
17017 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17018 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17019 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17020 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17021 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17022 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17023 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17024 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17025
17026 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17027 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17028 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17029 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17030 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17031 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17032 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17033 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17034
17035
17036
17037
17038 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17039 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17040 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17041 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17042 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17043 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17044 .display
17045 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17046 .endd
17047 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17048 no options:
17049 .code
17050 route_list = \
17051 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17052 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17053 .endd
17054 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17055 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17056 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17057 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17058 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17059 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17060 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17061 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17062 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17063 in a &%route_list%&).
17064
17065 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17066 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17067 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17068 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17069
17070
17071
17072 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17073 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17074 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17075 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17076 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17077 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17078 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17079 like this:
17080 .code
17081 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17082 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17083 .endd
17084 This data can be accessed by setting
17085 .code
17086 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17087 .endd
17088 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17089 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17090 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17091 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17092 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17093
17094
17095
17096
17097 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17098 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17099 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17100 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17101 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17102 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17103 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17104
17105 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17106 variables are set during its expansion:
17107
17108 .ilist
17109 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17110 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17111 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17112 .code
17113 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17114 .endd
17115 .next
17116 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17117 .next
17118 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17119
17120 .next
17121 .vindex "&$value$&"
17122 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17123 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17124 .code
17125 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17126 .endd
17127 .endlist
17128
17129 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17130 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17131
17132
17133
17134 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17135 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17136 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17137 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17138 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17139 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17140
17141 .ilist
17142 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17143 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17144 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17145 .code
17146 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17147 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17148 .endd
17149 .next
17150 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17151 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17152 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17153 number follows. For example:
17154 .code
17155 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17156 .endd
17157 .endlist
17158
17159 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17160 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17161 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17162 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17163 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17164 transport.
17165
17166 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17167 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17168 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17169 records in the DNS. For example:
17170 .code
17171 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17172 .endd
17173 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17174 example:
17175 .code
17176 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17177 .endd
17178 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17179 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17180 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17181 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17182 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17183 happens is controlled by the
17184 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17185 &%self%& option of the router.
17186
17187 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17188 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17189 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17190 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17191 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17192 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17193 defined by MX preferences.
17194
17195 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17196 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17197 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17198
17199 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17200 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17201 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17202 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17203
17204 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17205 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17206 router.
17207
17208 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17209 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17210 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17211
17212 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17213 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17214
17215
17216
17217 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17218 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17219 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17220 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17221 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17222 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17223 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17224
17225 .ilist
17226 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17227 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17228 .next
17229 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17230 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17231 .next
17232 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17233 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17234 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17235 .next
17236 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17237 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17238 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17239 .endlist
17240
17241 For example:
17242 .code
17243 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17244 domain2 host4:host5
17245 .endd
17246 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17247 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17248 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17249 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17250 call.
17251
17252 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17253 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17254 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17255 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17256 function called.
17257
17258
17259
17260 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17261 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17262
17263 .vindex "&$host$&"
17264 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17265 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17266
17267
17268
17269 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17270 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17271 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17272
17273 .ilist
17274 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17275 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17276 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17277 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17278 .code
17279 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17280 .endd
17281 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17282 your first router something like this:
17283 .code
17284 smart_route:
17285 driver = manualroute
17286 domains = !+local_domains
17287 transport = remote_smtp
17288 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17289 .endd
17290 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17291 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17292 they are tried in order
17293 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17294 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17295 .code
17296 smart_route:
17297 driver = manualroute
17298 transport = remote_smtp
17299 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17300 .endd
17301 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17302 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17303 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17304 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17305 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17306 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17307 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17308 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17309
17310 .next
17311 .cindex "mail hub example"
17312 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17313 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17314 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17315 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17316 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17317 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17318 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17319 lookup is easier to manage.
17320
17321 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17322 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17323 example:
17324 .code
17325 hub_route:
17326 driver = manualroute
17327 transport = remote_smtp
17328 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17329 .endd
17330 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17331 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17332 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17333 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17334 domain can be used to find the host:
17335 .code
17336 through_firewall:
17337 driver = manualroute
17338 transport = remote_smtp
17339 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17340 .endd
17341 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17342 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17343 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17344 next router.
17345
17346 .next
17347 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17348 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17349 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17350 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17351 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17352 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17353 .code
17354 save_in_file:
17355 driver = manualroute
17356 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17357 route_list = saved.domain.example
17358 .endd
17359 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17360 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17361 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17362 .code
17363 save_in_file:
17364 driver = manualroute
17365 route_list = \
17366 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17367 *.saved.domain2.example \
17368 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17369 batch_pipe
17370 .endd
17371 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17372 .vindex "&$host$&"
17373 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17374 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17375 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17376 the address if the lookup fails.
17377
17378 .next
17379 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17380 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17381 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17382 one way it can be done:
17383 .code
17384 # Transport
17385 uucp:
17386 driver = pipe
17387 user = nobody
17388 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17389 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17390 return_fail_output = true
17391
17392 # Router
17393 uucphost:
17394 transport = uucp
17395 driver = manualroute
17396 route_data = \
17397 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17398 .endd
17399 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17400 .code
17401 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17402 .endd
17403 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17404 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17405 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17406 .endlist
17407 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17408 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17409
17410
17411
17412
17413
17414
17415
17416
17417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17419
17420 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17421 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17422 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17423 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17424 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17425 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17426 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17427 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17428 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17429 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17430 options:
17431 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17432
17433 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17434 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17435 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17436 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17437 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17438
17439
17440 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17441 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17442 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17443 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17444 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17445 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17446
17447
17448 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17449 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17450 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17451 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17452 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17453 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17454 not set, a value for the gid also.
17455
17456 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17457 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17458 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17459 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17460 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17461 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17462 gid.
17463
17464
17465 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17466 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17467 before running the command.
17468
17469
17470 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17471 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17472 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17473 timeout.
17474
17475
17476 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17477 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17478 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17479 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17480 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17481
17482 .ilist
17483 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17484 below).
17485 .next
17486 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17487 &%no_more%& is set.
17488 .next
17489 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17490 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17491 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17492 included in the SMTP response.
17493 .next
17494 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17495 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17496 included in any SMTP response.
17497 .next
17498 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17499 .next
17500 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17501 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17502 .next
17503 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17504 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17505 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17506 .endlist
17507
17508 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17509 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17510 the page):
17511 .code
17512 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17513 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17514 .endd
17515 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17516 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17517 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17518 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17519
17520 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17521 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17522 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17523 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17524 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17525
17526 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17527 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17528 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17529 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17530 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17531
17532 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17533 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17534 variable. For example, this return line
17535 .code
17536 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17537 .endd
17538 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17539 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17540 .ecindex IIDquerou1
17541 .ecindex IIDquerou2
17542
17543
17544
17545
17546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17548
17549 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17550 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17551 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17552 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17553 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17554 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17555 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17556 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17557 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17558 redirected in several different ways:
17559
17560 .ilist
17561 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17562 independently.
17563 .next
17564 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17565 .next
17566 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17567 .next
17568 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17569 .next
17570 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17571 .next
17572 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17573 .next
17574 It can be discarded.
17575 .endlist
17576
17577 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17578 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17579 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17580 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17581
17582
17583
17584 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17585 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17586 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17587 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17588 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17589 aliases, in a configuration like this:
17590 .code
17591 system_aliases:
17592 driver = redirect
17593 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17594 .endd
17595 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17596 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17597 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17598 cause delivery to be deferred.
17599
17600 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17601 &_.forward_& files, like this:
17602 .code
17603 userforward:
17604 driver = redirect
17605 check_local_user
17606 file = $home/.forward
17607 no_verify
17608 .endd
17609 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17610 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17611 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17612 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17613 comments.
17614
17615
17616
17617 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17618 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17619 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17620 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17621
17622 .ilist
17623 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17624 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
17625 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
17626 practice the router may not be able to operate.
17627 .next
17628 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
17629 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17630 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17631 saves some resources.
17632 .endlist
17633
17634
17635
17636
17637
17638
17639 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
17640 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17641 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17642 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
17643 can be interpreted in two different ways:
17644
17645 .ilist
17646 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17647 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
17648 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17649 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17650 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
17651 document is intended for use by end users.
17652 .next
17653 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17654 described in the next section.
17655 .endlist
17656
17657 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
17658 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17659 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17660 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
17661 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
17662
17663
17664
17665 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
17666 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
17667 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17668 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17669 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17670 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17671 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
17672 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17673 commas or newlines.
17674 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17675 quotes.
17676
17677 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17678 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17679 next newline character is ignored.
17680
17681 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17682 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17683 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
17684 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
17685 removed.
17686
17687 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17688 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17689 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
17690 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
17691 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17692 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17693 setting:
17694 .code
17695 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17696 .endd
17697
17698
17699 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
17700 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
17701 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
17702 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
17703 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17704 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17705 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17706 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17707 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17708 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17709 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17710
17711 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
17712 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17713 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17714 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17715 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
17716 .code
17717 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
17718 .endd
17719 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
17720 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
17721 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
17722 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
17723 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
17724 synonymously.
17725
17726 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
17727 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
17728 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
17729 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
17730 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
17731
17732 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
17733 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
17734 contains:
17735 .code
17736 Sam.Reman: spqr
17737 .endd
17738 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
17739 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
17740 this forward file:
17741 .code
17742 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17743 .endd
17744 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
17745 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
17746 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
17747 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
17748 should really contain
17749 .code
17750 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17751 .endd
17752 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
17753 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
17754 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
17755
17756
17757
17758 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
17759 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
17760 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
17761
17762 .ilist
17763 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
17764 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
17765 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
17766 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
17767 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
17768 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17769 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17770
17771 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
17772 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
17773 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
17774 in double quotes, for example:
17775 .code
17776 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
17777 .endd
17778 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
17779 quote just the command. An item such as
17780 .code
17781 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
17782 .endd
17783 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
17784
17785 .next
17786 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
17787 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
17788 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
17789 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
17790 .code
17791 /home/world/minbari
17792 .endd
17793 is treated as a file name, but
17794 .code
17795 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
17796 .endd
17797 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
17798 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
17799 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
17800 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
17801
17802 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17803 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17804
17805 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
17806 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
17807 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
17808 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
17809
17810 .next
17811 .cindex "included address list"
17812 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
17813 If an item is of the form
17814 .code
17815 :include:<path name>
17816 .endd
17817 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
17818 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
17819 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
17820 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
17821 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
17822 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
17823 .code
17824 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
17825 .endd
17826 It must be given as
17827 .code
17828 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
17829 .endd
17830 .next
17831 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
17832 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
17833 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
17834 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
17835 .cindex "black hole"
17836 .cindex "abandoning mail"
17837 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
17838 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
17839 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
17840
17841 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
17842 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
17843 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
17844 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
17845 &_/dev/null_&.
17846
17847 .next
17848 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
17849 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
17850 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
17851 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
17852 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
17853 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
17854 redirection items of the form
17855 .code
17856 :defer:
17857 :fail:
17858 .endd
17859 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies to the
17860 entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored (&':blackhole:'& is
17861 different). Any text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error
17862 text associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
17863 .code
17864 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
17865 .endd
17866 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
17867 of a
17868 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
17869 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
17870 default.
17871 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
17872 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
17873 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
17874
17875 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
17876 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
17877 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
17878 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
17879 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
17880 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
17881 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
17882 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
17883 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
17884 ignored.
17885
17886 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
17887 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
17888 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
17889 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
17890
17891 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
17892 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
17893 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
17894 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
17895 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
17896
17897 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
17898 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
17899 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
17900 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
17901 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
17902 rules still apply.
17903
17904 .next
17905 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
17906 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
17907 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
17908 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
17909 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
17910 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
17911 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
17912 .endlist
17913
17914
17915 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
17916 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17917 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
17918 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
17919 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
17920 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
17921 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
17922 aliasing scheme of the type
17923 .code
17924 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
17925 localpart1: pipe
17926 localpart2: pipe
17927 .endd
17928 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
17929 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
17930 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
17931 such as
17932 .code
17933 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
17934 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
17935 .endd
17936 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
17937 the pipes are distinct.
17938
17939
17940
17941 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
17942 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
17943 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
17944 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
17945 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
17946 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
17947 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
17948 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
17949 can be used to avoid this.
17950
17951
17952 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
17953 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
17954 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
17955 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
17956 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
17957 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
17958 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
17959
17960
17961
17962 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
17963
17964 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
17965 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
17966
17967
17968 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
17969 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
17970 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
17971
17972
17973 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
17974 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
17975 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
17976 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
17977
17978
17979 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
17980 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
17981 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
17982 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
17983 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
17984 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
17985 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
17986
17987 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
17988 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
17989
17990
17991 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
17992 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
17993 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
17994 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
17995 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
17996
17997
17998
17999 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18000 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18001 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18002 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18003 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18004 let ordinary users do.
18005
18006
18007
18008 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18009 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18010 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18011 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18012 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18013 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18014
18015 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18016 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18017 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18018 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18019 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18020 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18021 .code
18022 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18023 .endd
18024 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18025 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18026 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18027 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18028 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18029 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18030 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18031 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18032
18033
18034 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18035 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18036 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18037 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18038 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18039 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18040 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18041 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18042
18043
18044
18045 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18046 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18047 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18048 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18049 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18050 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18051
18052
18053 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18054 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18055 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18056 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18057 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18058 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18059
18060 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18061 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18062 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18063 .code
18064 data = #Exim filter\n\
18065 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18066 .endd
18067 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18068 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18069 choice into a newline.
18070
18071
18072 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18073 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18074 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18075 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18076 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18077
18078
18079 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18080 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18081 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18082 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18083 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18084 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18085 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18086 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18087
18088 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18089 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18090 runs a check on the containing directory,
18091 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18092 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18093 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18094 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18095 not, the router declines.
18096
18097
18098 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18099 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18100 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18101 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18102 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18103 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18104 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18105
18106
18107 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18108 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18109 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18110 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18111 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18112
18113
18114 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18115 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18116 redirection list.
18117
18118
18119 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18120 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18121 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18122
18123
18124
18125
18126 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18127 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18128 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18129 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18130 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18131 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18132 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18133 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18134 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18135
18136
18137 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18138 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18139 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18140 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18141 functions.
18142
18143 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18144 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18145 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18146 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18147
18148 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18149 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18150 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18151 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18152 &_.forward_& files).
18153
18154
18155 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18156 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18157 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18158
18159
18160 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18161 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18162 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18163 of the embedded Perl support.
18164
18165
18166 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18167 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18168 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18169
18170
18171 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18172 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18173 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18174
18175
18176 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18177 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18178 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18179 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18180 &%one_time%& is set.
18181
18182
18183 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18184 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18185 to make use of &%run%& items.
18186
18187
18188 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18189 If this option is true, items of the form
18190 .code
18191 :include:<path name>
18192 .endd
18193 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18194
18195
18196 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18197 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18198 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18199 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18200 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18201
18202
18203 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18204 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18205 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18206
18207
18208 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18209 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18210 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18211 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18212 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18213
18214
18215
18216
18217 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18218 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18219 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18220 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18221 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18222 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18223 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18224
18225
18226 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18227 .cindex "EACCES"
18228 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18229 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18230 file did not exist.
18231
18232
18233 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18234 .cindex "ENOTDIR"
18235 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18236 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18237 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18238
18239 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18240 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18241 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18242 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18243 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18244 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18245 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18246 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18247
18248
18249
18250 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18251 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18252 redirection list must start with this directory.
18253
18254
18255 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18256 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18257 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18258
18259
18260 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18261 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18262 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18263 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18264 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18265 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18266 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18267 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18268 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18269 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18270 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18271 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18272 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18273 before they subscribed.
18274
18275 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18276 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18277 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18278 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18279 attempt.
18280
18281 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18282 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18283 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18284 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18285
18286 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18287 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18288 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18289
18290 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18291 &%one_time%&.
18292
18293 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18294 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18295 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18296 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18297 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18298 expansion.
18299
18300
18301 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18302 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18303 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18304 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18305 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18306 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18307 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18308 See &%check_owner%& above.
18309
18310
18311 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18312 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18313 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18314 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18315
18316
18317 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18318 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18319 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18320 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18321 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18322 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18323 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18324
18325
18326 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18327 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18328 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18329 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18330 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18331 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18332 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18333 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18334
18335 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18336 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18337 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18338 addresses.
18339
18340 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18341 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18342 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18343 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18344 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18345 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18346 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18347 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18348 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18349 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18350
18351
18352 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18353 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18354 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18355 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18356 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18357 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18358
18359
18360 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18361 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18362 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18363 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18364 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18365 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18366
18367
18368 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18369 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18370 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18371 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18372 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18373
18374
18375 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18376 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18377 :subaddress part of an address.
18378
18379 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18380 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18381 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18382 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18383
18384
18385 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18386 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18387 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18388 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18389 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18390 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18391 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18392
18393
18394
18395 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18396 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18397 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18398 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18399 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18400 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18401 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18402 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18403 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18404 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18405 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18406 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18407 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18408 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18409 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18410 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18411
18412 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18413 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18414 the following routers.
18415
18416 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18417 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18418 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18419 so it is passed to the following routers.
18420
18421 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18422 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18423 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18424 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18425
18426 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18427 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18428 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18429 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18430 .code
18431 userforward:
18432 driver = redirect
18433 allow_filter
18434 check_local_user
18435 file = $home/.forward
18436 file_transport = address_file
18437 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18438 reply_transport = address_reply
18439 no_verify
18440 skip_syntax_errors
18441 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18442 syntax_errors_text = \
18443 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18444 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18445 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18446 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18447 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18448 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18449 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18450 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18451 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18452 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18453 .endd
18454 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18455 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18456 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18457 .code
18458 real_localuser:
18459 driver = accept
18460 check_local_user
18461 local_part_prefix = real-
18462 transport = local_delivery
18463 .endd
18464 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18465 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18466 .code
18467 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18468 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18469 .endd
18470
18471
18472 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18473 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18474
18475
18476 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18477 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18478 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18479 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18480
18481
18482
18483
18484
18485
18486 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18487 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18488
18489 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18490 "Environment for local transports"
18491 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18492 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18493 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18494 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18495 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18496 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18497 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18498
18499 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18500 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18501 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18502 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18503
18504 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18505 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18506 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18507 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18508 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18509
18510
18511
18512 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18513 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18514 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18515 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18516 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18517 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18518 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18519 time.
18520
18521 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18522 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18523 .code
18524 my_transport:
18525 driver = pipe
18526 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18527 .endd
18528 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18529 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18530 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18531 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18532
18533
18534
18535
18536 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18537 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18538 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18539 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18540 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18541 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18542 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18543 group (set by the transport). For example:
18544 .code
18545 # Routers ...
18546 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18547 local_users:
18548 driver = accept
18549 check_local_user
18550 transport = group_delivery
18551
18552 # Transports ...
18553 # This transport overrides the group
18554 group_delivery:
18555 driver = appendfile
18556 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18557 group = mail
18558 .endd
18559 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18560 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18561 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18562 set.
18563
18564 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18565 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18566 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18567 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18568 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18569 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18570
18571 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18572 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18573 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18574 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18575 original gid is also used.
18576
18577 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18578 following that is set is used:
18579
18580 .ilist
18581 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18582 .next
18583 A &%group%& setting of the router;
18584 .next
18585 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18586 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18587 .next
18588 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18589 .next
18590 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18591 the uid is the creator's uid;
18592 .next
18593 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18594 .endlist
18595
18596 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18597 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18598 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18599 The first of the following that is set is used:
18600
18601 .ilist
18602 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18603 .next
18604 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18605 .next
18606 A &%user%& setting of the router;
18607 .next
18608 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18609 .next
18610 The Exim uid.
18611 .endlist
18612
18613 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18614 &%never_users%& list.
18615
18616
18617
18618
18619
18620 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
18621 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18622 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18623 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
18624 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
18625 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18626 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
18627 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
18628 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18629 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18630
18631 .ilist
18632 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18633 .next
18634 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18635 .next
18636 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18637 .next
18638 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18639 .endlist
18640
18641 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18642
18643 .ilist
18644 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
18645 .next
18646 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
18647 .endlist
18648
18649
18650 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18651 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18652 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
18653
18654
18655
18656 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
18657 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18658 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18659 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
18660 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18661 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
18662 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18663 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18664 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18665 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
18666 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
18667 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
18668 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
18669 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
18670
18671
18672
18673
18674
18675
18676
18677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18678 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18679
18680 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
18681 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
18682 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
18683 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
18684 The following generic options apply to all transports:
18685
18686
18687 .option body_only transports boolean false
18688 .cindex "transport" "body only"
18689 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
18690 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
18691 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18692 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
18693 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
18694 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
18695 automatically suppress them.
18696
18697
18698 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
18699 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
18700 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18701 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18702 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18703 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18704
18705
18706 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
18707 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18708 deliveries by the transport or for any
18709 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18710 what you are doing.
18711
18712
18713 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
18714 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18715 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18716 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18717 transport is run.
18718 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18719 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18720 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18721 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
18722 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
18723 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
18724 one.
18725
18726
18727 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
18728 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
18729 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
18730 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
18731 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
18732 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
18733 safely be resent to other recipients.
18734
18735
18736 .option driver transports string unset
18737 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
18738 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
18739
18740
18741 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
18742 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
18743 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
18744 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
18745 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
18746 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
18747 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
18748 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
18749 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
18750 resent to other recipients.
18751
18752
18753 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
18754 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
18755 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
18756 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
18757 &%user%& (see below).
18758
18759
18760 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
18761 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
18762 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
18763 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
18764 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
18765 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
18766 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18767 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18768 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18769
18770
18771
18772 .option headers_only transports boolean false
18773 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
18774 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
18775 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
18776 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
18777 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
18778 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
18779 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
18780
18781
18782 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
18783 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18784 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
18785 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
18786 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
18787 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
18788 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18789 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18790 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18791
18792
18793
18794 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
18795 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
18796 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
18797 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
18798 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
18799 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
18800 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
18801 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
18802 example,
18803 .code
18804 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
18805 x@y w@z
18806 .endd
18807 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
18808 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
18809 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
18810 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
18811 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
18812 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
18813 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
18814 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
18815 change envelope recipients at this time.
18816
18817
18818 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
18819 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
18820 .vindex "&$home$&"
18821 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
18822 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
18823 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
18824 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
18825 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
18826 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
18827 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
18828 deferred.
18829
18830
18831 .option initgroups transports boolean false
18832 .cindex "additional groups"
18833 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18834 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
18835 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
18836 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
18837 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
18838
18839
18840 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
18841 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
18842 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
18843 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
18844 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
18845 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
18846 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
18847 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
18848 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
18849 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
18850 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
18851 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
18852 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
18853 delivered.
18854
18855
18856
18857 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
18858 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
18859 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
18860 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
18861 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
18862 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
18863 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
18864 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
18865 that contains
18866 .code
18867 local_part_prefix = *-
18868 .endd
18869 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
18870 is delivered with
18871 .code
18872 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
18873 .endd
18874 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
18875 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
18876 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
18877 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
18878 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
18879
18880
18881 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
18882 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18883 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
18884 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
18885 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
18886 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
18887 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
18888 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
18889 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
18890
18891 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
18892 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
18893 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
18894 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
18895
18896 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
18897 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
18898 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
18899
18900
18901 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
18902 .cindex "envelope sender"
18903 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
18904 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
18905 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
18906 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
18907 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
18908 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
18909 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
18910 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
18911 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
18912
18913 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
18914 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
18915
18916 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
18917 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
18918 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
18919 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
18920 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
18921 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
18922 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
18923
18924 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
18925 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
18926 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
18927 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
18928 &%errors_to%& in a router.
18929
18930
18931
18932 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
18933 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
18934 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
18935 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
18936 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
18937 have easy access to it.
18938
18939 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
18940 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
18941 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
18942 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
18943 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
18944 recipients.
18945
18946
18947 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
18948 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
18949
18950
18951 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
18952 .cindex "shadow transport"
18953 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
18954 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
18955 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
18956
18957 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
18958 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
18959 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
18960 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
18961 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
18962 cause a log line to be written.
18963
18964 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
18965 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
18966 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
18967 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
18968 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
18969 of the form
18970 .code
18971 ST=<shadow transport name>
18972 .endd
18973 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
18974 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
18975 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
18976 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
18977 headers that some sites insist on.
18978
18979
18980 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
18981 .cindex "transport" "filter"
18982 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
18983 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
18984 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
18985 individual users or via a system filter.
18986
18987 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
18988 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
18989 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
18990 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
18991 command must be specified as an absolute path.
18992
18993 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
18994 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
18995 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
18996 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
18997 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
18998 &(pipe)& transports.
18999
19000 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19001 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19002 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19003 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19004 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19005
19006 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19007 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. A demonstration Perl script is provided in
19008 &_util/transport-filter.pl_&; this makes a few arbitrary modifications just to
19009 show the possibilities. Exim does not check the result, except to test for a
19010 final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over SMTP must end
19011 with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19012
19013 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19014 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19015 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19016 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19017 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19018 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19019
19020 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19021 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19022 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19023 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19024 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19025 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19026 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19027 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19028
19029 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19030 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19031 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19032 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19033 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19034 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19035 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19036 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19037 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19038 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19039
19040 .vindex "&$host$&"
19041 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19042 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19043 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19044 which the message is being sent. For example:
19045 .code
19046 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19047 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19048 .endd
19049
19050 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19051 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19052 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19053 .ilist
19054 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19055 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19056 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19057 example:
19058 .code
19059 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19060 .endd
19061 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19062 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19063 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19064 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19065 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19066 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19067 .next
19068 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19069 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19070 arguments. Consider this example:
19071 .code
19072 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19073 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19074 .endd
19075 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19076 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19077 .code
19078 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19079 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19080 .endd
19081 .endlist
19082
19083 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19084 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19085 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19086 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19087 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19088 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19089 bounced from a transport filter.
19090
19091 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19092 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19093 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19094
19095
19096 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19097 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19098 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19099 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19100 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19101 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19102 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19103 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19104 becomes a temporary error.
19105
19106
19107 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19108 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19109 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19110 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19111 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19112 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19113 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19114 option is not set.
19115
19116 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19117 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19118 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19119
19120 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19121 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19122 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19123 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19124 retry data.
19125 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19126 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19127 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19128
19129
19130
19131
19132
19133
19134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19135 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19136
19137 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19138 "Address batching"
19139 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19140 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19141 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19142 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19143 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19144 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19145 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19146
19147 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19148 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19149 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19150 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19151 local transport, for example:
19152
19153 .ilist
19154 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19155 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19156 recipients saves space.
19157 .next
19158 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19159 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19160 .next
19161 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19162 to a scanner program or
19163 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19164 acceptable.
19165 .endlist
19166
19167 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19168 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19169 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19170
19171 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19172 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19173 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19174 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19175 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19176 to certain conditions:
19177
19178 .ilist
19179 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19180 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19181 batching is possible.
19182 .next
19183 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19184 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19185 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19186 .next
19187 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19188 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19189 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19190 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19191 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19192 from taking place.
19193 .next
19194 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19195 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19196 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19197 be the same.
19198 .endlist
19199
19200 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19201 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19202 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19203 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19204 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19205 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19206 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19207 .code
19208 check_string = "."
19209 escape_string = ".."
19210 .endd
19211 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19212 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19213 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19214
19215 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19216 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19217 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19218 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19219 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19220 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19221
19222 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19223 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19224 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19225 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19226 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19227 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19228 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19229 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19230 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19231
19232
19233
19234
19235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19236 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19237
19238 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19239 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19240 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19241 .cindex "directory creation"
19242 .cindex "creating directories"
19243 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19244 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19245 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19246 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19247 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19248 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19249 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19250 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19251 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19252 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19253
19254 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19255 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19256 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19257 included.
19258
19259 .cindex "quota" "system"
19260 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19261 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19262 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19263
19264 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19265 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19266 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19267 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19268
19269 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19270 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19271 private options.
19272
19273 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19274 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19275 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19276 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19277 option).
19278
19279
19280
19281 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19282 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19283 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19284 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19285 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19286
19287 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19288 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19289 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19290 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19291 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19292 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19293 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19294 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19295 operation. There are two cases:
19296
19297 .ilist
19298 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19299 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19300 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19301 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19302 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19303 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19304 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19305 .next
19306 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19307 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19308 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19309 .endlist
19310
19311
19312 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19313 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19314 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19315 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19316 form:
19317 .code
19318 save folder23
19319 .endd
19320 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19321 .code
19322 require "fileinto";
19323 fileinto "folder23";
19324 .endd
19325 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19326 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19327 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19328 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19329 way of handling this requirement:
19330 .code
19331 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19332 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19333 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19334 {$address_file} \
19335 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19336 }} \
19337 }
19338 .endd
19339 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19340 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19341 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19342
19343 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19344 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19345 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19346 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19347 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19348 path to the transport.
19349
19350 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19351 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19352
19353
19354
19355
19356 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19357 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19358
19359
19360
19361 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19362 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19363 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19364 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19365 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19366 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19367 delivery is deferred.
19368
19369
19370 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19371 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19372 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19373 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19374 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19375 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19376 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19377 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19378
19379
19380 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19381 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19382 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19383 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19384 file.
19385
19386
19387 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19388 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19389
19390
19391 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19392 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19393 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19394 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19395 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19396
19397
19398 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19399 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19400 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19401 process is running.
19402
19403
19404 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19405 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19406 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19407 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19408 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19409 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19410 contains is significant.
19411
19412 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19413 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19414 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19415 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19416 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19417
19418 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19419 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19420 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19421 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19422 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19423 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19424 .code
19425 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19426 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19427 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19428 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19429 .endd
19430 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19431 .cindex "directory creation"
19432 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19433 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19434 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19435
19436 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19437 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19438 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19439 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19440 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19441
19442
19443
19444 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19445 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19446 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19447 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19448 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19449 beneath.
19450
19451 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19452 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19453 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19454 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19455 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19456 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19457 &%file_must_exist%&.
19458
19459
19460 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19461 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19462 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19463 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19464
19465 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19466 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19467 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19468 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19469 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19470
19471
19472 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19473 .cindex "base62"
19474 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19475 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19476 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19477 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19478 .code
19479 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19480 .endd
19481 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19482 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19483 option.
19484
19485
19486 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19487 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19488 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19489
19490
19491 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19492 See &%check_string%& above.
19493
19494
19495 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
19496 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19497 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19498 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19499 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19500 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19501 &%file%&.
19502
19503 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19504 .cindex "locking files"
19505 .cindex "lock files"
19506 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19507 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19508
19509 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19510 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19511 examples:
19512 .code
19513 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19514 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19515 file = $home/inbox
19516 .endd
19517 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19518 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19519 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19520 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19521 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19522 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19523
19524
19525
19526 .option file_format appendfile string unset
19527 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19528 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19529 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19530 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19531 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19532 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19533 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19534 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19535 this added to it:
19536 .code
19537 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19538 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19539 .endd
19540 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19541 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19542 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19543 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19544 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19545 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19546 delivery is deferred.
19547
19548
19549 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19550 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19551 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19552 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19553
19554
19555 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19556 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19557 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19558 .cindex "locking files"
19559 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19560 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19561 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19562 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19563 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19564 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19565 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19566 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19567
19568 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19569 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19570 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19571 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19572
19573 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19574 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19575 retries is
19576 .code
19577 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19578 .endd
19579 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19580 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19581 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19582
19583 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19584 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19585 .code
19586 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19587 .endd
19588
19589 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19590 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19591 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19592 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19593
19594
19595 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19596 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19597 for details of locking.
19598
19599
19600 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19601 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19602 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19603
19604
19605 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19606 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19607 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19608
19609
19610 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19611 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19612 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19613 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19614 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19615
19616
19617 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19618 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19619 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19620 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19621 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19622 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19623 external source that maintains the data.
19624
19625
19626 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
19627 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19628 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19629 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19630 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19631 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19632 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19633 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19634
19635
19636
19637 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
19638 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
19639 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
19640 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
19641 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
19642 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
19643 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19644 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
19645 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
19646 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19647
19648
19649 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
19650 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
19651 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
19652 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
19653 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
19654 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
19655 calculation. The default value is:
19656 .code
19657 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19658 .endd
19659 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
19660 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19661 &_Trash_&
19662 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19663 .code
19664 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19665 .endd
19666 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19667 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
19668 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
19669 directly into that directory.
19670
19671
19672 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
19673 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19674 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19675
19676
19677 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
19678 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19679 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19680
19681
19682 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile boolean false
19683 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
19684 Setting this option true enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
19685 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19686 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
19687 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
19688 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19689
19690 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
19691 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
19692 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
19693 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
19694 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
19695 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
19696 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
19697 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
19698 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
19699 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
19700
19701
19702 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
19703 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
19704 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
19705 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
19706 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
19707 below for further details.
19708
19709
19710 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
19711 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19712 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19713
19714
19715 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
19716 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19717 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19718
19719
19720 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
19721 .cindex "locking files"
19722 .cindex "file" "locking"
19723 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
19724 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
19725 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19726 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
19727 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
19728 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
19729 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
19730
19731 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
19732 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
19733 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
19734 combination:
19735 .code
19736 mbx_format = true
19737 message_prefix =
19738 message_suffix =
19739 .endd
19740 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
19741 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
19742 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
19743 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
19744 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
19745 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
19746 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
19747 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
19748
19749 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
19750 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
19751 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
19752 append messages to it.
19753
19754
19755 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19756 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19757 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
19758 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19759 in which case it is:
19760 .code
19761 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
19762 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
19763 .endd
19764 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19765 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
19766
19767 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19768 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
19769 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19770 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
19771 setting
19772 .code
19773 message_suffix =
19774 .endd
19775 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19776 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
19777
19778 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19779 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
19780 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
19781 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
19782 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
19783 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
19784 value, and this option is ignored.
19785
19786
19787 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
19788 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
19789 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
19790 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
19791 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
19792
19793
19794 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
19795 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
19796 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
19797 on users about incoming mail.
19798
19799
19800 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
19801 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
19802 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
19803 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
19804 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
19805 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
19806 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
19807 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
19808 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
19809
19810 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
19811 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
19812 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
19813
19814 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
19815 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
19816 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
19817 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
19818 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
19819 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
19820
19821 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
19822 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
19823 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
19824 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
19825 be handled.
19826
19827 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
19828
19829 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
19830 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
19831 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
19832 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
19833 system quota failures.
19834
19835 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
19836 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
19837 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
19838 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
19839 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
19840 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
19841 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
19842 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
19843 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
19844 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
19845
19846
19847 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
19848 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
19849 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
19850 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
19851 delivery directory.
19852
19853
19854 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
19855 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
19856 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
19857 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
19858 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
19859 &"no quota"&.
19860
19861
19862 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
19863 See &%quota%& above.
19864
19865
19866 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
19867 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
19868 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
19869 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
19870 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
19871 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
19872 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
19873
19874 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
19875 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
19876 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
19877 the file length to the file name. For example:
19878 .code
19879 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
19880 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
19881 .endd
19882 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
19883 number of lines in the message.
19884
19885 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
19886 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
19887 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
19888
19889
19890
19891 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
19892 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
19893 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
19894 .code
19895 quota_warn_message = "\
19896 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
19897 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
19898 This message is automatically created \
19899 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
19900 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
19901 a warning threshold that is\n\
19902 set by the system administrator.\n"
19903 .endd
19904
19905
19906 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
19907 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
19908 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
19909 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19910 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
19911 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
19912 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
19913 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
19914 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
19915 sign. For example:
19916 .code
19917 quota = 10M
19918 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
19919 .endd
19920 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
19921 percent sign is ignored.
19922
19923 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
19924 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
19925 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
19926 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
19927 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
19928 &'From:'& line, the default is:
19929 .code
19930 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
19931 .endd
19932 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
19933 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
19934 option.
19935
19936 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
19937 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
19938 percentage.
19939
19940
19941 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
19942 .cindex "envelope sender"
19943 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
19944 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
19945 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
19946 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
19947 for details of batch SMTP.
19948
19949
19950 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
19951 .cindex "carriage return"
19952 .cindex "linefeed"
19953 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
19954 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
19955 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
19956 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
19957
19958 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
19959 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
19960 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
19961 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
19962 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
19963 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
19964
19965
19966 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
19967 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
19968 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
19969 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
19970 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
19971 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
19972
19973
19974 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
19975 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
19976 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
19977 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
19978 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
19979
19980 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
19981 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
19982 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
19983 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
19984
19985 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
19986 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
19987 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
19988 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
19989 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
19990 error.
19991
19992 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
19993 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
19994
19995
19996 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
19997 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
19998 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
19999 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20000 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20001 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20002 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20003
20004 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20005 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20006 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20007 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20008 file corruption.
20009
20010 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20011 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20012 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20013
20014
20015 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20016 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20017 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20018 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20019 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20020 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20021 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20022 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20023 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20024
20025 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20026 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20027 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20028 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20029
20030
20031
20032
20033 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20034 .cindex "appending to a file"
20035 .cindex "file" "appending"
20036 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20037
20038 .ilist
20039 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20040 return is given.
20041
20042 .next
20043 .cindex "directory creation"
20044 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20045 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20046 &%directory_mode%& option.
20047
20048 .next
20049 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20050 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20051 transport.
20052
20053 .next
20054 .cindex "file" "locking"
20055 .cindex "locking files"
20056 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20057 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20058 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20059
20060 .olist
20061 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20062 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20063 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20064 .next
20065 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20066 .next
20067 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20068 Unlink the hitching post name.
20069 .next
20070 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20071 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20072 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20073 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20074 .next
20075 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20076 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20077 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20078 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20079 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20080 it before trying again.
20081 .endlist olist
20082
20083 .next
20084 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20085 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20086 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20087
20088 .next
20089 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20090 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20091 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20092 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20093 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20094 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20095 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20096 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20097 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20098 checked.
20099
20100 .next
20101 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20102 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20103 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20104 delivery is deferred.
20105
20106 .next
20107 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20108 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20109 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20110 permissions.
20111
20112 .next
20113 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20114 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20115 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20116
20117 .next
20118 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20119 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20120 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20121
20122 .next
20123 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20124 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20125 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20126 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20127 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20128 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20129 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20130 that prevents link following.
20131
20132 .next
20133 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20134 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20135 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20136 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20137 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20138
20139 .next
20140 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20141
20142 .next
20143 .cindex "file" "locking"
20144 .cindex "locking files"
20145 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20146 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20147 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20148 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20149 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20150 .code
20151 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20152 .endd
20153 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20154 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20155 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20156
20157 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20158 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20159 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20160
20161 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20162 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20163 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20164 delivery is deferred.
20165
20166 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20167 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20168 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20169 immediately. It retries up to
20170 .code
20171 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20172 .endd
20173 times (rounded up).
20174 .endlist
20175
20176 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20177 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20178
20179
20180 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20181 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20182 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20183 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20184 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20185 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20186 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20187 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20188 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20189 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20190
20191 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20192 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20193 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20194 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20195 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20196 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20197 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20198
20199 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20200 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20201 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20202 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20203
20204
20205 .cindex "maildir format"
20206 .cindex "mailstore format"
20207 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20208 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20209 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20210 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20211 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20212
20213 .cindex "directory creation"
20214 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20215 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20216 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20217 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20218 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20219 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20220 deferred.
20221
20222
20223
20224 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20225 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20226 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20227 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20228 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20229 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20230 &_new_& subdirectory.
20231
20232 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20233 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20234 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20235 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20236 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20237 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20238 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20239
20240 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20241 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20242 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20243 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20244 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20245 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20246 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20247 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20248
20249 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20250 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20251 folders. Consider this example:
20252 .code
20253 maildir_format = true
20254 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20255 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20256 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20257 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20258 .endd
20259 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20260 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20261 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20262 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20263 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20264 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20265
20266 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20267 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20268 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20269 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20270 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20271
20272 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20273 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20274 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20275
20276 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20277 .cindex "maildir++"
20278 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20279 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20280 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20281 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20282 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20283 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20284 amount of space used.
20285
20286 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20287 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20288 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20289 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20290 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20291 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20292
20293
20294
20295
20296 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20297 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20298 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20299 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20300 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20301 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20302
20303 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20304 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20305 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20306 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20307 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20308 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20309 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20310 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20311 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20312 colon is inserted.
20313
20314
20315
20316 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20317 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20318 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20319 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20320 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20321 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20322 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20323 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20324 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20325
20326 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20327 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20328 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20329 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20330 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20331 need to know the quota.
20332
20333 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20334 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20335
20336 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20337 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20338 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20339 details.
20340
20341
20342 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20343 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20344 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20345 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20346 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20347 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20348 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20349 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20350
20351 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20352 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20353 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20354 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20355 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20356 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20357
20358 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20359 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20360 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20361 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20362 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20363 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20364
20365 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20366 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20367 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20368 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20369
20370
20371 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20372 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20373 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20374 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20375 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20376 .code
20377 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20378 .endd
20379 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20380 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20381 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20382 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20383 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20384
20385
20386
20387
20388
20389
20390 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20391 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20392
20393 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20394 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20395 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20396 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20397 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20398 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20399 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20400 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20401
20402 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20403 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20404 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20405 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20406 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20407
20408
20409 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20410 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20411 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20412 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20413 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20414
20415 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20416 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20417 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20418 transport is run as a consequence of a
20419 &%mail%&
20420 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20421 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20422 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20423 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20424 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20425 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20426
20427 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20428 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20429 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20430 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20431
20432 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20433 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20434 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20435 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20436 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20437 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20438 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20439
20440 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20441 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20442 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20443 the transport defers.
20444 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20445 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20446
20447 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20448 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20449 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20450 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20451
20452 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20453 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20454 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20455 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20456 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20457 problems. They are just discarded.
20458
20459
20460
20461 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20462 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20463
20464 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20465 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20466 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20467
20468
20469 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20470 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20471 when the message is specified by the transport.
20472
20473
20474 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20475 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20476 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20477 string comes first.
20478
20479
20480 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20481 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20482 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20483
20484
20485 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20486 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20487 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20488
20489
20490 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
20491 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20492 specified by the transport.
20493
20494
20495 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20496 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20497 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20498 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20499
20500
20501 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
20502 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20503 the message is specified by the transport.
20504
20505
20506 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20507 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20508 used.
20509
20510
20511 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20512 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20513 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20514 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20515 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20516
20517
20518
20519 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
20520 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20521 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20522 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20523
20524 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20525 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20526 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20527 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20528 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20529 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20530 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20531 infinity.
20532
20533 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20534 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20535 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20536 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20537 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20538
20539 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20540 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20541 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20542 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20543 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20544 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20545
20546
20547 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20548 See &%once%& above.
20549
20550
20551 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20552 See &%once%& above.
20553 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20554
20555
20556 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20557 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20558 specified by the transport.
20559
20560
20561 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
20562 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20563 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20564 configuration option.
20565
20566
20567 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20568 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20569 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20570 automatic responses. For example:
20571 .code
20572 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20573 .endd
20574 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20575 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20576 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20577 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20578 small.
20579
20580
20581
20582 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
20583 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20584 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20585 the text comes first.
20586
20587
20588 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
20589 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20590 when the message is specified by the transport.
20591 .ecindex IIDauttra1
20592 .ecindex IIDauttra2
20593
20594
20595
20596
20597 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20598 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20599
20600 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20601 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20602 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20603 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20604 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20605 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20606 specified command
20607 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20608 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
20609 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20610 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
20611 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
20612 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20613 .code
20614 TRANSPORT_LMTP=yes
20615 .endd
20616 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
20617 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
20618 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
20619 as follows:
20620
20621 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
20622 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20623
20624
20625 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
20626 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20627 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20628 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20629 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20630
20631
20632 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
20633 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
20634 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
20635 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
20636 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
20637 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
20638 LMTP protocol.
20639
20640 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
20641 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
20642 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
20643 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
20644 in its response to the LHLO command.
20645
20646 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
20647 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
20648 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20649 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20650
20651
20652 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
20653 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
20654 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. &new("Delivery
20655 is deferred, and will be tried again later.") Here is an example of a typical
20656 LMTP transport:
20657 .code
20658 lmtp:
20659 driver = lmtp
20660 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20661 batch_max = 20
20662 user = exim
20663 .endd
20664 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20665 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
20666
20667
20668
20669 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20671
20672 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
20673 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
20674 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
20675 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20676 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
20677 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
20678 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
20679 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
20680 following ways:
20681
20682 .ilist
20683 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20684 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
20685 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
20686 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
20687 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
20688 .next
20689 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20690 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
20691 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
20692 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
20693 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
20694 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
20695 that are routed to the transport.
20696 .next
20697 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20698 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20699 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
20700 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
20701 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
20702 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
20703 the local part that was redirected.
20704 .endlist
20705
20706
20707 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
20708 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
20709 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
20710
20711 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
20712 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
20713 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
20714 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
20715 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
20716 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
20717 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
20718
20719
20720 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
20721 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
20722 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
20723 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
20724 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
20725
20726
20727
20728
20729 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
20730 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
20731 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
20732 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
20733 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
20734 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
20735 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
20736 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
20737 &"local delivery failed"&.
20738
20739 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
20740 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
20741 value is the return code minus 128.
20742
20743 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
20744 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
20745 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
20746 a non-existent command may be the problem.
20747
20748 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
20749 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
20750 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
20751 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
20752 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
20753 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
20754 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
20755 &%temp_errors%&.
20756
20757
20758
20759 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
20760 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
20761 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
20762 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
20763 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
20764 run.
20765
20766 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
20767 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
20768 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
20769 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
20770
20771 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
20772 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
20773 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
20774 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
20775 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
20776 .code
20777 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
20778 .endd
20779 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
20780 arguments. You have to write
20781 .code
20782 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
20783 .endd
20784 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
20785 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
20786 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
20787 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
20788 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
20789 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
20790 example:
20791 .code
20792 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
20793 .endd
20794
20795 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20796 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20797 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20798 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
20799 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
20800 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
20801 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
20802 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
20803 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
20804 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
20805
20806 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
20807 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
20808 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
20809 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
20810 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
20811 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
20812 control what is done with it.
20813
20814 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
20815 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
20816 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
20817 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
20818 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
20819 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
20820 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
20821 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
20822 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
20823 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
20824 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
20825
20826
20827
20828 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
20829 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20830 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
20831 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
20832 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
20833 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
20834 environment.
20835 .display
20836 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
20837 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
20838 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
20839 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
20840 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
20841 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
20842 &`LOGNAME `& see below
20843 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
20844 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
20845 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
20846 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
20847 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
20848 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
20849 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
20850 &`USER `& see below
20851 .endd
20852 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
20853 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
20854 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
20855 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
20856 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
20857 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
20858 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
20859
20860 .cindex "HOST"
20861 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
20862 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
20863 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
20864 the router.
20865
20866 .cindex "HOME"
20867 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
20868 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
20869 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
20870 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
20871
20872
20873 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
20874 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
20875
20876
20877
20878 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
20879 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
20880 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20881 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
20882 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
20883 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
20884 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
20885 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
20886 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
20887 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
20888 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
20889 example, if
20890 .code
20891 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
20892 .endd
20893 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
20894 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
20895 &%use_shell%& is set.
20896
20897
20898 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
20899 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20900
20901
20902 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
20903 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20904 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20905
20906
20907 .option check_string pipe string unset
20908 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
20909 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
20910 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
20911 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
20912 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
20913 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
20914 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
20915 ignored.
20916
20917
20918 .option command pipe string&!! unset
20919 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
20920 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
20921 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
20922 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
20923 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
20924 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
20925
20926
20927 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
20928 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20929 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
20930 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
20931 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
20932 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20933 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
20934
20935
20936 .option escape_string pipe string unset
20937 See &%check_string%& above.
20938
20939
20940 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
20941 .cindex "exec failure"
20942 .cindex "failure of exec"
20943 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
20944 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
20945 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
20946 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
20947 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
20948
20949
20950 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
20951 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
20952 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
20953 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
20954 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
20955 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
20956
20957 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
20958 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
20959
20960 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
20961 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
20962 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
20963 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
20964 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
20965
20966
20967 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
20968 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
20969 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
20970 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
20971 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
20972 Only one of them may be set.
20973
20974
20975
20976 .option log_output pipe boolean false
20977 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
20978 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
20979 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
20980
20981
20982
20983 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
20984 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
20985 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
20986 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
20987 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
20988 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
20989 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
20990 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
20991
20992
20993 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
20994 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
20995 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
20996 .code
20997 message_prefix = \
20998 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
20999 ${tod_bsdinbox}\n
21000 .endd
21001 .cindex "Cyrus"
21002 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21003 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21004 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21005 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21006 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21007 setting
21008 .code
21009 message_prefix =
21010 .endd
21011 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21012 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21013
21014
21015 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21016 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21017 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21018 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21019 .code
21020 message_suffix =
21021 .endd
21022 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21023 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21024
21025
21026 .option path pipe string "see below"
21027 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21028 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21029 .code
21030 /bin:/usr/bin
21031 .endd
21032 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21033 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21034 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21035
21036
21037 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21038 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21039 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21040 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21041 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21042 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21043 accept the message is used.
21044
21045
21046 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21047 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21048 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21049 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21050 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21051 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21052
21053
21054 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21055 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21056 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21057 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21058 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21059 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21060 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21061
21062
21063
21064 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21065 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21066 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21067 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21068 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21069 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21070 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21071 of them may be set.
21072
21073
21074
21075 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21076 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21077 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21078 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21079 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21080 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21081 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21082 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21083 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21084 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21085 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21086 and 73, respectively.
21087
21088
21089 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21090 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21091 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21092 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21093 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21094 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21095 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21096
21097 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21098 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21099 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21100 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21101 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21102 delivery to be deferred.
21103
21104 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21105 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21106
21107
21108 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21109 .cindex "envelope sender"
21110 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21111 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21112 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21113 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21114 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21115
21116 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21117 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21118 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21119 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21120 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21121 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21122 class database.
21123
21124
21125 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21126 .cindex "carriage return"
21127 .cindex "linefeed"
21128 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21129 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21130 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21131 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21132
21133 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21134 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21135 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21136 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21137 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21138
21139
21140 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21141 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21142 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21143 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21144 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21145 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21146 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21147 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21148 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21149 its &%-c%& option.
21150
21151
21152
21153 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21154 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21155 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21156 .cindex "external local delivery"
21157 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21158 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21159 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21160 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21161 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21162 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21163 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21164 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21165 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21166 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21167 .code
21168 # transport
21169 procmail_pipe:
21170 driver = pipe
21171 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21172 return_path_add
21173 delivery_date_add
21174 envelope_to_add
21175 check_string = "From "
21176 escape_string = ">From "
21177 user = $local_part
21178 group = mail
21179
21180 # router
21181 procmail:
21182 driver = accept
21183 check_local_user
21184 transport = procmail_pipe
21185 .endd
21186 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21187 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21188 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21189 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21190 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21191 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21192
21193 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21194 .code
21195 IFS=" "
21196 .endd
21197 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21198 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21199
21200 .cindex "Cyrus"
21201 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21202 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21203 .code
21204 # transport
21205 local_delivery_cyrus:
21206 driver = pipe
21207 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21208 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21209 user = cyrus
21210 group = mail
21211 return_output
21212 log_output
21213 message_prefix =
21214 message_suffix =
21215
21216 # router
21217 local_user_cyrus:
21218 driver = accept
21219 check_local_user
21220 local_part_suffix = .*
21221 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21222 .endd
21223 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21224 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21225 sender.
21226 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21227 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21228
21229
21230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21232
21233 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21234 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21235 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21236 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21237 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21238 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21239 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21240 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21241
21242
21243 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21244 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21245 two ways:
21246
21247 .ilist
21248 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21249 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21250 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21251 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21252 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21253 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21254 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21255 .next
21256 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21257 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21258 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21259 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21260 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21261 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21262 process.
21263 .endlist
21264
21265
21266 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21267 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21268 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21269
21270
21271
21272 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21273 .vindex "&$host$&"
21274 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21275 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21276 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21277 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21278 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21279 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21280 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21281 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21282
21283
21284 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21285 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21286 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21287 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21288 and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21289 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21290 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21291 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21292 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21293 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21294 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21295
21296
21297 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21298 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21299 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21300
21301
21302 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21303 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21304 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21305 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21306 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21307 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21308 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21309 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21310
21311 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21312 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21313 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21314 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21315 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21316 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21317 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21318 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21319 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21320
21321
21322 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21323 .cindex "Cyrus"
21324 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21325 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21326 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21327 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21328 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21329 ignored.
21330
21331 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21332 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21333 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21334 particular connection.
21335
21336 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21337 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21338 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21339 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21340
21341 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21342 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21343 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21344 .code
21345 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21346 .endd
21347 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21348 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21349
21350 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21351 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21352 value.
21353
21354
21355 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21356 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21357 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21358 authenticated as a client.
21359
21360
21361 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21362 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21363 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21364 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21365
21366
21367 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21368 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21369 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21370 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21371 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21372 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21373 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21374
21375
21376 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21377 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21378 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21379 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21380 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21381 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21382 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21383 option.
21384
21385
21386 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21387 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21388 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21389 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21390
21391
21392 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21393 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21394 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21395 cutoff times.
21396
21397 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21398 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21399 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21400 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21401 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21402 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21403
21404 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21405 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21406 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21407 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21408 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21409 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21410 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21411 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21412 to them.
21413
21414
21415 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21416 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21417 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21418 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21419 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21420
21421
21422 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21423 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21424 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21425 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21426 details.
21427
21428
21429
21430 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21431 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21432 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21433 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21434 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21435 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21436 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21437 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21438
21439 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21440 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21441 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21442 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21443 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21444 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21445
21446 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21447 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21448 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21449 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21450 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21451
21452 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21453 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21454 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21455 copy of the message is sent.
21456
21457 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21458 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21459 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21460 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21461 fails"& facility.
21462
21463
21464 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21465 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21466 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21467 zero.
21468
21469 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21470 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21471 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21472 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21473 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21474 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21475
21476 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
21477 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21478 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21479
21480 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
21481 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21482 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21483
21484 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
21485 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21486 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21487
21488 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21489 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21490 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21491 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21492 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21493 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21494 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21495 option is:
21496 .code
21497 $primary_hostname
21498 .endd
21499 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21500 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21501 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21502 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21503 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21504 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21505 interface address, you could use this:
21506 .code
21507 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21508 {$primary_hostname}}
21509 .endd
21510 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21511 callouts.
21512
21513 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21514 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21515 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21516 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21517 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21518 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21519
21520 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21521 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21522 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21523 &%hosts_override%& is set.
21524
21525 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21526 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21527 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21528 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21529 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21530 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21531 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21532
21533 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21534 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21535 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21536 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21537 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21538 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21539 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21540 address are used.
21541
21542 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21543 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21544
21545
21546 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21547 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21548 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21549 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21550 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21551 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21552 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21553 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21554 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21555 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21556
21557
21558 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21559 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21560 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21561 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21562
21563
21564 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21565 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21566 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21567 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21568
21569
21570 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21571 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21572 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21573 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21574 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21575 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21576 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21577 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21578
21579
21580 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
21581 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21582 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
21583 why it exists.
21584
21585
21586
21587 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21588 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
21589 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21590 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
21591 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21592 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21593 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
21594 explanation of when this might be needed.
21595
21596
21597 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
21598 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
21599 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21600 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
21601 &%fallback_hosts%&.
21602
21603
21604 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
21605 .cindex "randomized host list"
21606 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21607 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
21608 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21609 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21610 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21611 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21612 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21613 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21614
21615 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21616 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21617 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21618 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21619 .code
21620 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21621 .endd
21622 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21623 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21624 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
21625
21626 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21627 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
21628 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21629 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21630 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21631 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21632 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21633 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
21634 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21635
21636
21637 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21638 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
21639 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21640 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21641 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21642 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21643
21644 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21645 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
21646 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21647 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21648 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21649 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
21650 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21651
21652 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
21653 .cindex "bind IP address"
21654 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
21655 .vindex "&$host$&"
21656 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21657 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21658 call. &new("The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
21659 &`eth0`&.") Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
21660 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
21661 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
21662 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
21663 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
21664 unknown.
21665
21666 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
21667 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
21668 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
21669 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
21670 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21671 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
21672 .code
21673 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
21674 .endd
21675 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
21676 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
21677 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
21678 interface to use if the host has more than one.
21679
21680
21681 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
21682 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
21683 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
21684 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
21685 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
21686 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
21687 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
21688 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
21689 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
21690 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
21691 unreachable hosts.
21692
21693
21694 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
21695 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21696 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
21697 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
21698 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
21699
21700 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
21701 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
21702 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
21703 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
21704 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
21705 permits this.
21706
21707
21708 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
21709 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21710 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
21711 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
21712 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
21713 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
21714 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
21715 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
21716
21717
21718 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
21719 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
21720 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
21721 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
21722 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
21723 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
21724 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
21725 variable that contains an outgoing port.
21726
21727 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
21728 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
21729 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
21730 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
21731 is deferred.
21732
21733
21734
21735 .option protocol smtp string smtp
21736 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
21737 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
21738 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
21739 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
21740 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
21741 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
21742
21743
21744 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
21745 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
21746 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
21747 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
21748 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
21749 addresses is not affected.
21750
21751 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
21752 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
21753 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
21754 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
21755 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
21756 hosts.
21757
21758
21759 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
21760 .cindex "serializing connections"
21761 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
21762 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
21763 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
21764 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
21765 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
21766 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
21767 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
21768
21769 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
21770 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
21771 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
21772 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
21773 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21774 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21775
21776 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
21777 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21778 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21779 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21780 are used for ETRN serialization.
21781
21782
21783 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
21784 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21785 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
21786 .cindex "size" "of message"
21787 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21788 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21789 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
21790 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
21791 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
21792 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
21793 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
21794 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
21795
21796 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
21797 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
21798
21799
21800 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
21801 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
21802 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
21803 .vindex "&$host$&"
21804 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21805 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21806 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
21807 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
21808 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
21809 details of TLS.
21810
21811 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
21812 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
21813 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
21814 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
21815 client.
21816
21817
21818 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
21819 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
21820 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
21821 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
21822 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
21823
21824
21825 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
21826 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
21827 .vindex "&$host$&"
21828 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21829 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21830 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
21831 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
21832 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21833 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
21834 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
21835 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21836
21837
21838 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
21839 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
21840 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
21841 .vindex "&$host$&"
21842 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21843 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
21844 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
21845 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
21846 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21847 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
21848 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
21849 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
21850 ciphers is a preference order.
21851
21852
21853
21854 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
21855 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
21856 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
21857 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
21858 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
21859 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
21860 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
21861 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
21862 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21863 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21864 in clear.
21865
21866
21867 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
21868 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
21869 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
21870 .vindex "&$host$&"
21871 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21872 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
21873 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
21874 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
21875 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
21876 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
21877 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
21878 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21879 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21880
21881
21882
21883
21884 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
21885 "SECTvalhosmax"
21886 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21887 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
21888 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
21889 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
21890 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
21891
21892
21893 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
21894 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
21895 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
21896 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
21897 retrying.
21898
21899 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
21900 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
21901 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
21902
21903 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
21904 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
21905 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
21906 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
21907 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
21908
21909 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
21910 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
21911 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
21912 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
21913 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
21914 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
21915 see below for an exception).
21916
21917 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
21918 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
21919 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
21920 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
21921 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
21922
21923 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
21924 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
21925 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
21926 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
21927 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
21928 reached their retry times.
21929
21930 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
21931 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
21932 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
21933 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
21934 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
21935 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
21936 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
21937 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
21938 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
21939 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
21940 reached.
21941
21942 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
21943 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
21944 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
21945 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
21946 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
21947 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
21948
21949 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
21950 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
21951 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
21952 possible IP addresses have been tried.
21953 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
21954 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
21955
21956
21957
21958
21959
21960 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21961 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21962
21963 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
21964 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
21965 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
21966 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
21967 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
21968 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
21969
21970 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
21971 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
21972 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
21973 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
21974 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
21975 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
21976 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
21977
21978 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
21979 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
21980 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
21981 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
21982
21983
21984 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
21985 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
21986 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
21987 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
21988
21989 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
21990 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
21991 facility; you do not have to use it.
21992
21993 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
21994 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
21995 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
21996 address to which it applies.
21997
21998 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
21999 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22000 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22001 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22002 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22003 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22004 rules.
22005
22006 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22007 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22008 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22009 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22010
22011
22012 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22013 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22014 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22015 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22016 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22017 discouraged.
22018
22019 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22020 illustrated by these examples:
22021
22022 .ilist
22023 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22024 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22025 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22026 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22027 .next
22028 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22029 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22030 .endlist
22031
22032
22033
22034 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22035 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22036 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22037 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22038 message's processing.
22039
22040 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22041 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22042 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22043 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22044 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22045 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22046 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22047 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22048 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22049
22050 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22051 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22052 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22053 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22054 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22055 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22056 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22057 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22058 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22059 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22060
22061 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22062 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22063 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22064 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22065 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22066 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22067
22068 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22069 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22070 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22071
22072 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22073 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22074 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22075 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22076 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22077 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22078 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22079 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22080 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22081
22082 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22083 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22084 transport time.
22085
22086
22087
22088
22089 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22090 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22091 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22092 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22093 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22094 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22095 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22096 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22097 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22098 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22099 .code
22100 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22101 .endd
22102 might produce the output
22103 .code
22104 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22105 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22106 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22107 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22108 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22109 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22110 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22111 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22112 .endd
22113 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22114 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22115 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22116 set for a particular transport.
22117
22118
22119 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22120 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22121 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22122 rules in the form
22123 .display
22124 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22125 .endd
22126 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22127 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22128 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22129 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22130
22131 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22132 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22133 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22134 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22135 ignored.
22136
22137 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22138 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22139 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22140
22141 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22142 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22143 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22144 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22145 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22146 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22147 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22148
22149 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22150 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22151 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22152 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22153 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22154 .code
22155 *@* ${lookup ...
22156 .endd
22157 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22158 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22159
22160
22161 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22162 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22163 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22164 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22165 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22166 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22167 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22168 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22169 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22170
22171 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22172 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22173 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22174
22175 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22176 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22177 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22178 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22179 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22180 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22181 of pattern they are set as follows:
22182
22183 .ilist
22184 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22185 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22186 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22187 pattern
22188 .code
22189 *queen@*.fict.example
22190 .endd
22191 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22192 .code
22193 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22194 $1 = hearts-
22195 $2 = wonderland
22196 .endd
22197 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22198 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22199
22200 .next
22201 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22202 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22203 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22204 rewriting rule of the form
22205 .display
22206 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22207 .endd
22208 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22209 .code
22210 $1 = foo
22211 $2 = bar
22212 $3 = baz.example
22213 .endd
22214 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22215 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22216 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22217 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22218 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22219 .endlist
22220
22221
22222 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22223 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22224 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22225 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22226 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22227 .code
22228 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22229 .endd
22230 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22231 &'From:'& headers.
22232
22233 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22234 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22235 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22236 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22237 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22238 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22239 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22240 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22241 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22242 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22243 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22244 entry written to the panic log.
22245
22246
22247
22248 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22249 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22250
22251 .ilist
22252 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22253 c, f, h, r, s, t.
22254 .next
22255 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22256 .next
22257 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22258 .endlist
22259
22260 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22261 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22262
22263
22264
22265 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22266 "SECID154"
22267 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22268 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22269 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22270 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22271 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22272 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22273 .display
22274 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22275 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22276 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22277 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22278 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22279 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22280 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22281 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22282 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22283 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22284 .endd
22285 .new
22286 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
22287 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
22288 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
22289 .wen
22290
22291 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22292 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22293
22294
22295 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22296 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22297 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22298 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22299 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22300 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22301 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22302 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22303 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22304
22305 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22306 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22307 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22308 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22309 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22310 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22311 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22312 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22313
22314
22315 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22316 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22317 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22318 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22319
22320 .ilist
22321 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22322 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22323 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22324 .next
22325 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22326 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22327 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22328 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22329 .next
22330 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22331 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22332 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22333 .next
22334 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22335 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22336 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22337 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22338 .code
22339 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22340 .endd
22341 into
22342 .code
22343 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22344 .endd
22345 .cindex "RFC 2047"
22346 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22347 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22348 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22349 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22350 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22351 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22352 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22353 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22354
22355 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22356 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22357 .endlist
22358
22359
22360 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22361 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22362 .code
22363 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22364 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22365 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22366 .endd
22367 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22368 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22369 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22370 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22371 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22372 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22373 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22374 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22375
22376 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22377 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22378 .code
22379 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22380 .endd
22381 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22382 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22383
22384 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22385 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22386 messages that originate outside the local host:
22387 .code
22388 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22389 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22390 .endd
22391 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22392 space.
22393
22394 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22395 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22396 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22397 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22398 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22399 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22400 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22401 components. For example, the rule
22402 .code
22403 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22404 .endd
22405 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22406 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22407 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22408 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22409 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22410 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22411 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22412 .ecindex IIDaddrew
22413
22414
22415
22416
22417
22418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22420
22421 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22422 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22423 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22424 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22425 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22426 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22427 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22428 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22429 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22430 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22431 address, domain and error.
22432
22433 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22434 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22435 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22436 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22437 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22438 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22439 log selector is set, the message
22440 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22441 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22442 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22443 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22444
22445 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22446 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22447 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22448 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22449 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22450 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22451 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22452 domain are maintained independently.
22453
22454 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22455 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22456 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22457 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22458 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22459 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22460 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22461 the local address is reached.
22462
22463 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22464 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22465 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22466 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22467 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22468
22469 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22470 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22471 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22472 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22473 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22474 messages that it should now be retaining.
22475
22476
22477
22478 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22479 .cindex "retry" "rules"
22480 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22481 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22482 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22483 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22484 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22485 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22486 message's sender, respectively.
22487
22488
22489 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22490 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22491 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22492 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22493 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22494 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22495 example,
22496 .code
22497 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22498 .endd
22499 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22500 whereas
22501 .code
22502 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22503 .endd
22504 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22505 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22506 part.
22507
22508 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22509 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22510 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22511 expressions work in address lists.
22512 .display
22513 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22514 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22515 .endd
22516
22517
22518 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22519 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22520 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22521 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22522 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22523 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22524 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22525 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22526 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22527
22528 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22529 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22530 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22531 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22532 local transports).
22533
22534 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22535 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22536 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22537 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22538 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22539 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22540 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22541 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22542 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22543 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22544 commands.
22545
22546
22547
22548 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22549 "SECID160"
22550 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22551 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22552 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22553 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22554 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22555 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22556 .code
22557 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22558 MX 6 p.q.r.example
22559 MX 7 m.n.o.example
22560 .endd
22561 and the retry rules are
22562 .code
22563 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22564 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22565 .endd
22566 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22567 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22568 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
22569 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
22570 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
22571 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
22572
22573 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
22574 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22575 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22576 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
22577
22578 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
22579 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
22580 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
22581 .code
22582 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
22583 .endd
22584 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
22585 textual form of the IP address.
22586
22587 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
22588 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
22589 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22590 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22591
22592 .vlist
22593 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
22594 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
22595 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
22596
22597 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
22598 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
22599 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
22600
22601 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
22602 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
22603
22604 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
22605 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
22606 .endlist
22607
22608 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
22609 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
22610 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
22611 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
22612 retry rule of this form:
22613 .code
22614 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22615 .endd
22616 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
22617 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
22618
22619 .vlist
22620 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
22621 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
22622 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
22623 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
22624
22625 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
22626 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22627
22628 .vitem &%refused_A%&
22629 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22630
22631 .vitem &%refused%&
22632 A connection was refused.
22633
22634 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
22635 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22636
22637 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
22638 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22639
22640 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
22641 A connection attempt timed out.
22642
22643 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
22644 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22645 obtained from an MX record.
22646
22647 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
22648 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22649 obtained from an MX record.
22650
22651 .vitem &%timeout%&
22652 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22653
22654 .vitem &%tls_required%&
22655 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
22656 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
22657 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
22658
22659 .vitem &%quota%&
22660 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22661 transport.
22662
22663 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
22664 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
22665 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
22666 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22667 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
22668 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
22669 for four days.
22670 .endlist
22671
22672 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
22673 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
22674 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
22675 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
22676 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
22677 heuristic rules:
22678
22679 .ilist
22680 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
22681 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
22682 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
22683 .next
22684 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
22685 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
22686 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
22687 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
22688 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
22689 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
22690 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
22691 .next
22692 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
22693 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
22694 .endlist
22695
22696 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
22697 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
22698 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
22699 error).
22700
22701
22702
22703 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
22704 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
22705 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
22706 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
22707 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
22708 form:
22709 .display
22710 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
22711 .endd
22712 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
22713 .code
22714 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
22715 .endd
22716 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
22717 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
22718 For example:
22719 .code
22720 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
22721 .endd
22722 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
22723 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
22724 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
22725 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
22726 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
22727
22728 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
22729 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
22730 .code
22731 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
22732 .endd
22733 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
22734 list is never matched.
22735
22736
22737
22738
22739
22740 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
22741 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
22742 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
22743 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
22744 .display
22745 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
22746 .endd
22747 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
22748 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
22749 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
22750 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
22751 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
22752
22753 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
22754 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
22755 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
22756 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
22757 The available algorithms are:
22758
22759 .ilist
22760 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
22761 the interval.
22762 .next
22763 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
22764 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
22765 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
22766 .next
22767 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
22768 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
22769 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
22770 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
22771 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
22772 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
22773 queue processing times.
22774 .endlist
22775
22776 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
22777 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
22778 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
22779 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
22780 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
22781 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
22782 interval is found. The main configuration variable
22783 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
22784 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
22785 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
22786 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
22787 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
22788
22789 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
22790 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
22791 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
22792 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
22793 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
22794 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
22795 time.
22796
22797 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
22798 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
22799 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
22800 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
22801 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
22802 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
22803 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
22804 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
22805 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
22806 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
22807 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
22808 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
22809
22810 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
22811 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
22812 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
22813 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
22814 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
22815 deliveries that have been deferred.
22816
22817
22818 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
22819 Here are some example retry rules:
22820 .code
22821 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
22822 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
22823 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
22824 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22825 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
22826 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
22827 .endd
22828 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
22829 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
22830 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
22831 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
22832 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
22833 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
22834 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
22835 days.
22836
22837 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
22838 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
22839 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
22840 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
22841 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
22842
22843 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
22844 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
22845 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
22846 were not obtained from an MX record.
22847
22848 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
22849 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
22850 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
22851 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
22852 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
22853
22854
22855
22856 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
22857 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
22858 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
22859 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
22860 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
22861 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
22862 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
22863 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
22864 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
22865 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
22866 failing for the first time.
22867
22868 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
22869 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
22870 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
22871 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
22872
22873 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
22874 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
22875 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
22876
22877
22878
22879
22880 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
22881 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
22882 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
22883 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
22884 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
22885 default retry rule:
22886 .code
22887 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
22888 .endd
22889 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
22890 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
22891 failure for the recipient address that counts.
22892
22893 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
22894 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
22895 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
22896 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
22897 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
22898
22899 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
22900 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
22901 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
22902
22903 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
22904 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
22905 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
22906 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
22907 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
22908 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
22909 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
22910 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
22911
22912 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
22913 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
22914 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
22915 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
22916 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
22917 notice.
22918
22919 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22920 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
22921 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22922 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
22923 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
22924 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
22925 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
22926 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
22927 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
22928 true.
22929
22930 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
22931 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
22932 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
22933 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
22934 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
22935 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
22936 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
22937 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
22938 reached.
22939
22940 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
22941 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
22942 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
22943 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
22944 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
22945 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
22946 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
22947 time out the address.
22948
22949 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
22950 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
22951 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
22952 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
22953 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
22954 considered immediately.
22955 .ecindex IIDretconf1
22956 .ecindex IIDregconf2
22957
22958
22959
22960
22961
22962
22963 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22964 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22965
22966 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
22967 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
22968 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
22969 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
22970 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
22971 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
22972 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
22973 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
22974 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
22975 other.
22976
22977 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
22978 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
22979
22980 .ilist
22981 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
22982 the client's EHLO command.
22983 .next
22984 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
22985 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
22986 .next
22987 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
22988 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
22989 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
22990 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
22991 with the AUTH command.
22992 .next
22993 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
22994 .next
22995 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
22996 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
22997 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
22998 connection.
22999 .next
23000 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23001 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23002 unauthenticated connection.
23003 .endlist
23004
23005 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23006 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23007 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23008 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23009 .display
23010 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23011 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23012 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23013 &`Escape character is &#x0027;^]&#x0027;.`&
23014 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23015 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23016 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23017 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23018 &`250-PIPELINING`&
23019 &`250-AUTH PLAIN`&
23020 &`250 HELP`&
23021 .endd
23022 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23023 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23024 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23025 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23026 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23027 included by setting
23028 .code
23029 AUTH_CRAM_MD5=yes
23030 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23031 AUTH_PLAINTEXT=yes
23032 AUTH_SPA=yes
23033 .endd
23034 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23035 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23036 the Cyrus SASL authentication library. The third can be configured to support
23037 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23038 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The fourth authenticator
23039 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23040
23041 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23042 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23043 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23044 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23045 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23046 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23047 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23048
23049 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23050 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23051 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23052 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23053 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23054 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23055 .code
23056 cram:
23057 driver = cram_md5
23058 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23059 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23060 client_name = ph10
23061 client_secret = secret2
23062 .endd
23063 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23064 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23065
23066 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23067 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23068 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23069 in Exim.
23070
23071
23072
23073 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23074 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23075 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23076
23077 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23078 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23079 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23080 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23081 encrypted by a setting such as:
23082 .code
23083 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23084 .endd
23085 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23086 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23087 cipher used for the delivery.)
23088
23089
23090 .option driver authenticators string unset
23091 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23092 authenticators is to be used.
23093
23094
23095 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23096 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23097 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23098 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23099 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23100 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23101
23102
23103 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23104 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23105 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23106 mechanism is not advertised.
23107 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23108 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23109 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23110
23111
23112 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23113 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23114 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23115 for details.
23116
23117 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23118 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23119 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23120 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23121 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23122 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23123 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23124 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23125 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23126 the error text.
23127
23128
23129 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23130 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23131 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23132 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23133 out the values of variables.
23134 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23135 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23136
23137
23138 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23139 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23140 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23141 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23142 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23143 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23144 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23145 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23146 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23147
23148
23149 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23150 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23151 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23152 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23153 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23154 remembered for later use.
23155 How it is used is described in the following section.
23156
23157
23158
23159
23160
23161 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23162 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23163 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23164 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23165 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23166 message:
23167
23168 .ilist
23169 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23170 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23171 .next
23172 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23173 .next
23174 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23175 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23176 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23177 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23178 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23179 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23180 given for the MAIL command.
23181 .next
23182 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23183 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23184 authenticated.
23185 .next
23186 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23187 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23188 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23189 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23190 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23191 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23192 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23193 message.
23194 .endlist
23195
23196
23197 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23198 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23199 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23200 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23201
23202 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23203 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23204 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23205 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23206 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23207 ACL is run.
23208
23209
23210
23211 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23212 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23213 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23214 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23215 conditions:
23216
23217 .ilist
23218 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23219 .next
23220 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23221 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23222 .endlist
23223
23224 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23225 the mechanisms are advertised.
23226
23227 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23228 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23229 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23230 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23231 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23232 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23233 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23234 .code
23235 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23236 .endd
23237 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23238
23239 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23240 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23241 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23242 such as:
23243 .code
23244 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23245 .endd
23246 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23247 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23248 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23249
23250 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23251 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23252 command. This is the case if
23253
23254 .ilist
23255 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23256 .next
23257 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23258 .next
23259 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23260 server authenticators.
23261 .endlist
23262
23263
23264 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23265 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23266 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23267
23268 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23269 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23270 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23271 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23272 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23273 rejected with a 504 error.
23274
23275 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23276 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23277 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23278 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23279 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23280 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23281 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23282 no successful authentication.
23283
23284
23285
23286
23287 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23288 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23289 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23290 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23291 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23292 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23293 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23294 script:
23295 .code
23296 use MIME::Base64;
23297 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23298 .endd
23299 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23300 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23301 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23302 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23303 command line to run this script on such data might be
23304 .code
23305 encode '\0user\0password'
23306 .endd
23307 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23308 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23309 whose code value is zero.
23310
23311 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23312 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23313 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23314 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23315
23316 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23317 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23318 example, a command such as
23319 .code
23320 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23321 .endd
23322 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23323
23324 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23325 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23326 .code
23327 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23328 .endd
23329 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23330 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23331 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23332 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23333
23334
23335
23336 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23337 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23338 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23339 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23340 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23341 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23342
23343 .ilist
23344 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23345 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23346 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23347 of the authenticator.
23348 .next
23349 .vindex "&$host$&"
23350 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23351 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23352 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23353 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23354 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23355 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23356 delivery to be deferred.
23357 .next
23358 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23359 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23360 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23361 usual way.
23362 .next
23363 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23364 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23365 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23366 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23367 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23368 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23369 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23370 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23371 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23372 .endlist
23373
23374 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23375 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23376 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23377 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23378 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23379 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23380 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23381 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23382 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23383 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23384 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23385 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23386 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23387
23388
23389
23390
23391
23392
23393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23394 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23395
23396 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23397 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23398 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23399 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23400 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23401 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23402 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23403 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23404 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23405 connections as you do for login accounts.
23406
23407 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23408 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23409 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23410
23411 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23412 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23413 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23414
23415 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23416 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23417 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23418 given.
23419
23420 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23421 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23422 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23423 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23424 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23425 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23426 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23427
23428 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23429 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23430 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23431 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23432 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23433 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23434 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23435
23436 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23437 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23438 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23439 string expansions that also use them for other things.
23440
23441 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23442 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23443 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23444
23445 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23446 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23447 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23448 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23449 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23450 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23451 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23452 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23453 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23454 string as the error text.
23455
23456 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23457 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23458 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23459
23460
23461
23462 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23463 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23464 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23465 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23466 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23467 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23468 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23469 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23470
23471 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23472 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23473 configured as follows:
23474 .code
23475 fixed_plain:
23476 driver = plaintext
23477 public_name = PLAIN
23478 server_prompts = :
23479 server_condition = \
23480 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23481 server_set_id = $auth2
23482 .endd
23483 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23484 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23485 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23486 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23487
23488 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23489 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23490 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23491 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23492 .code
23493 250-AUTH PLAIN
23494 .endd
23495 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23496 .code
23497 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23498 .endd
23499 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23500 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23501 .code
23502 AUTH PLAIN
23503 .endd
23504 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23505 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23506
23507 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23508 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23509 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23510 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23511 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23512
23513 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23514 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23515 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23516
23517 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23518 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23519 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23520 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23521 This is an incorrect example:
23522 .code
23523 server_condition = \
23524 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
23525 .endd
23526 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
23527 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
23528 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23529 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23530 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23531 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23532 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23533 .code
23534 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23535 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
23536 .endd
23537 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23538 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
23539 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
23540 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
23541 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
23542
23543
23544 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
23545 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
23546 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
23547 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23548 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23549 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23550 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23551 .code
23552 fixed_login:
23553 driver = plaintext
23554 public_name = LOGIN
23555 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23556 server_condition = \
23557 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
23558 server_set_id = $auth1
23559 .endd
23560 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23561 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23562 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23563 strings are used to obtain two data items.
23564
23565 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23566 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
23567 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
23568 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
23569 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23570 .code
23571 login:
23572 driver = plaintext
23573 public_name = LOGIN
23574 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23575 server_condition = ${if ldapauth \
23576 {user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23577 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
23578 ldap://ldap.example.org/}}
23579 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
23580 .endd
23581 Note the use of the &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator to correctly quote the DN for
23582 authentication. However, the basic &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the
23583 LDAP quoting operators, is the correct one to use for the password, because
23584 quoting is needed only to make the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the
23585 LDAP level, the password is an uninterpreted string.
23586
23587
23588
23589 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
23590 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23591 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23592 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
23593 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
23594 &<<SECTexpcond>>&.
23595
23596
23597
23598
23599 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
23600 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
23601 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
23602
23603 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
23604 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
23605 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
23606 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
23607 usual.
23608
23609 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
23610 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23611 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23612 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23613 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
23614 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
23615 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
23616 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
23617 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
23618 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
23619 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
23620 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
23621
23622 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23623 splitting takes priority and happens first.
23624
23625 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23626 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23627 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23628 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23629 the string.
23630
23631 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23632 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23633 .code
23634 fixed_plain:
23635 driver = plaintext
23636 public_name = PLAIN
23637 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23638 .endd
23639 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23640 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23641 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23642 .code
23643 fixed_login:
23644 driver = plaintext
23645 public_name = LOGIN
23646 client_send = : username : mysecret
23647 .endd
23648 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23649 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23650 prompts.
23651 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
23652 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
23653
23654
23655
23656
23657 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23658 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23659
23660 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
23661 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23662 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
23663 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
23664 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
23665 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
23666 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
23667 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
23668 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
23669 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
23670 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
23671 available in plain text at either end.
23672
23673
23674 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
23675 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
23676 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
23677 authenticator as a server:
23678
23679 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23680 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23681 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
23682 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
23683 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
23684 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
23685 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
23686 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
23687 returned to the client.
23688
23689 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
23690 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
23691 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
23692 numeric variables for other things.
23693
23694 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
23695 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
23696 user name, authentication fails.
23697 .code
23698 fixed_cram:
23699 driver = cram_md5
23700 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23701 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
23702 server_set_id = $auth1
23703 .endd
23704 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23705 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
23706 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
23707 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
23708 .code
23709 lookup_cram:
23710 driver = cram_md5
23711 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23712 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
23713 {$value}fail}
23714 server_set_id = $auth1
23715 .endd
23716 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
23717 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
23718
23719
23720 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
23721 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
23722 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
23723
23724
23725
23726 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
23727 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
23728 computing the response to the server's challenge.
23729
23730
23731 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23732 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
23733 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
23734
23735
23736 .vindex "&$host$&"
23737 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23738 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
23739 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
23740 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
23741 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
23742 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
23743 send the message to the current server.
23744
23745 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
23746 strings, is:
23747 .code
23748 fixed_cram:
23749 driver = cram_md5
23750 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23751 client_name = ph10
23752 client_secret = secret
23753 .endd
23754 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
23755 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
23756
23757
23758
23759 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23760 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23761
23762 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
23763 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
23764 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
23765 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
23766 .cindex "Kerberos"
23767 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
23768 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
23769
23770 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
23771 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
23772 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
23773 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
23774 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
23775
23776 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
23777 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
23778 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
23779 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
23780
23781 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
23782 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
23783 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
23784 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
23785 depending on the driver you are using.
23786
23787 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
23788 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
23789 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
23790 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
23791 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
23792 implementation. For example, for Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
23793 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
23794 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
23795 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
23796
23797
23798 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
23799 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
23800 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
23801 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
23802 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
23803 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
23804 things.
23805
23806
23807 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
23808 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
23809 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
23810 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
23811
23812
23813 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
23814 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
23815 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
23816 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
23817 example:
23818 .code
23819 sasl:
23820 driver = cyrus_sasl
23821 public_name = X-ANYTHING
23822 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
23823 server_set_id = $auth1
23824 .endd
23825
23826 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string unset
23827 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
23828
23829
23830 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
23831 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
23832
23833
23834 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
23835 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
23836 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
23837 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
23838 .code
23839 sasl_cram_md5:
23840 driver = cyrus_sasl
23841 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23842 server_set_id = $auth1
23843
23844 sasl_plain:
23845 driver = cyrus_sasl
23846 public_name = PLAIN
23847 server_set_id = $auth1
23848 .endd
23849 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
23850 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
23851 but it is present in many binary distributions.
23852 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
23853 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
23854
23855
23856
23857
23858 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23860 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
23861 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
23862 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
23863 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
23864 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
23865 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
23866 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
23867 authenticator only. There is only one option:
23868
23869 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
23870
23871 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
23872 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
23873 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
23874 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
23875 .code
23876 dovecot_plain:
23877 driver = dovecot
23878 public_name = PLAIN
23879 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23880 server_set_id = $auth1
23881
23882 dovecot_ntlm:
23883 driver = dovecot
23884 public_name = NTLM
23885 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23886 server_set_id = $auth1
23887 .endd
23888 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
23889 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
23890 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
23891 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
23892 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
23893 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
23894 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
23895 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
23896
23897
23898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23899 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23900
23901 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
23902 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
23903 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
23904 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
23905 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
23906 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
23907 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
23908 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
23909 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
23910 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
23911 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
23912 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
23913 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
23914 follows:
23915
23916 .ilist
23917 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
23918 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
23919 .next
23920 The server sends back a challenge.
23921 .next
23922 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
23923 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
23924 .endlist
23925
23926 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
23927
23928
23929
23930 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
23931 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
23932 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
23933
23934 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
23935 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
23936 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
23937 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
23938 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
23939 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
23940 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
23941 for other things. For example:
23942 .code
23943 spa:
23944 driver = spa
23945 public_name = NTLM
23946 server_password = \
23947 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
23948 .endd
23949 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
23950 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
23951
23952
23953
23954
23955
23956 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
23957 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
23958 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
23959
23960
23961
23962 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
23963 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
23964
23965
23966 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
23967 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
23968
23969
23970 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
23971 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
23972 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
23973 &'msn.com'&:
23974 .code
23975 msn:
23976 driver = spa
23977 public_name = MSN
23978 client_username = msn/msn_username
23979 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
23980 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
23981 .endd
23982 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
23983 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
23984
23985
23986
23987
23988
23989 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23990 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23991
23992 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
23993 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
23994 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
23995 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
23996 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
23997 .cindex "OpenSSL"
23998 .cindex "GnuTLS"
23999 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24000 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24001 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24002 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24003 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24004 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24005 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24006 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24007 certificates are used.
24008
24009 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24010 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24011 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24012 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24013 between them is encrypted.
24014
24015 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24016 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24017 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24018 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24019 encryption state.
24020
24021 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24022 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24023 in order to get TLS to work.
24024
24025
24026
24027 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24028 "SECID284"
24029 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24030 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24031 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24032 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24033 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24034 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24035 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24036 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24037 allocated for this purpose.
24038
24039 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24040 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24041 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24042 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24043 .code
24044 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24045 .endd
24046 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24047 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24048 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24049 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24050 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24051 defined elsewhere.
24052
24053 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24054 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24055
24056
24057
24058
24059
24060
24061 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24062 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24063 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24064 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24065 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24066 .code
24067 USE_GNUTLS=yes
24068 .endd
24069 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24070 .code
24071 SUPPORT_TLS=yes
24072 .endd
24073 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24074 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24075
24076 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24077
24078 .ilist
24079 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24080 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24081 .next
24082 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24083 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24084 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24085 .next
24086 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24087 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24088 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24089 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24090 .next
24091 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24092 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24093 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24094 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24095 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24096 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24097 option).
24098 .next
24099 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24100 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24101 .endlist
24102
24103
24104 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24105 GnuTLS uses RSA and D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24106 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24107 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24108 &_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24109 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the RSA and D-H
24110 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24111 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24112 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24113 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24114 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24115
24116 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24117 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24118 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24119 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24120 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24121 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24122 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24123 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24124
24125 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24126 in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24127 externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24128
24129 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24130 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24131 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24132 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24133 .code
24134 # rm -f new-params
24135 # touch new-params
24136 # chown exim:exim new-params
24137 # chmod 0400 new-params
24138 # certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24139 # echo "" >>new-params
24140 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24141 # mv new-params gnutls-params
24142 .endd
24143 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24144 stalling is removed.
24145
24146
24147 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24148 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24149 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24150 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24151 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24152 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24153 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24154 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24155 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24156
24157 .ilist
24158 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24159 .next
24160 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24161 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24162 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24163 SSL v3 algorithms.
24164 .next
24165 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24166 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24167 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24168 algorithms.
24169 .endlist
24170
24171 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24172 &`-`& or &`+`&.
24173 .ilist
24174 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24175 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24176 stated.
24177 .next
24178 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24179 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24180 .next
24181 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24182 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24183 .endlist
24184
24185 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24186 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24187 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24188 not be moved to the end of the list.
24189 .endlist
24190
24191
24192
24193 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24194 "SECTreqciphgnu"
24195 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24196 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24197 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24198 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24199 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24200 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24201 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24202 exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24203 Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24204 function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24205 names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24206 methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24207 cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24208 passed to its control function.
24209
24210 For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24211 to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24212 option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24213 list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24214 contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24215 the same as if just AES were given.
24216
24217 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24218 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24219 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24220 There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24221 &%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24222 restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24223 These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24224
24225 All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24226 behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24227 how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24228 expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24229 can be changed in the usual way.
24230
24231 Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24232 first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24233 default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24234 specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24235 exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24236
24237 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24238 entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24239 exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24240 items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24241 .code
24242 tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24243 .endd
24244 allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24245 .code
24246 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24247 .endd
24248 allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24249
24250 For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24251 (both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24252 the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24253 AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24254
24255 For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24256 includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24257 DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24258
24259 For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24260 MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24261
24262 For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1 and SSL3.
24263 The default list contains TLS1, SSL3.
24264
24265 In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24266 advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24267 client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24268 order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24269 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24270 above.
24271
24272
24273
24274 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24275 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24276 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24277 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24278 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24279 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24280 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24281 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24282
24283 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24284 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24285 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24286 with the error
24287 .code
24288 554 Security failure
24289 .endd
24290 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24291 rejected with a 554 error code.
24292
24293 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
24294 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
24295 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24296 without some further configuration at the server end.
24297
24298 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24299 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24300 .code
24301 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24302 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24303 .endd
24304 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
24305 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
24306 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
24307 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
24308 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
24309 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
24310 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
24311 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
24312 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
24313 the server's certificate.
24314
24315 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24316 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24317 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
24318
24319 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
24320 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
24321 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
24322 transport.
24323
24324 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
24325 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
24326 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
24327 .code
24328 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24329 .endd
24330 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24331 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24332 suites that the server supports. See the command
24333 .code
24334 openssl dhparam
24335 .endd
24336 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
24337 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24338
24339 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24340 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24341 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24342 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24343 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24344
24345 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24346 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24347 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24348 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24349 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
24350 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24351 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
24352 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
24353 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
24354 &new("(For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
24355 &<<SECID185>>&.)")
24356
24357 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
24358 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
24359 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
24360 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
24361 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
24362 documentation for more details.
24363
24364
24365 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
24366 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
24367 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
24368 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24369 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
24370 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
24371 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24372 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24373 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24374 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24375 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24376 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
24377
24378 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24379 directory is used
24380 (OpenSSL only),
24381 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24382 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
24383 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24384 .code
24385 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24386 .endd
24387 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
24388
24389 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
24390 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24391 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24392 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
24393 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24394 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
24395 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24396 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24397 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24398 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24399
24400 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24401 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24402 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24403 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
24404
24405 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24406 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24407 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24408 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
24409 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
24410 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
24411
24412
24413 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
24414 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
24415 .cindex "revocation list"
24416 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
24417 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24418 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24419 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
24420 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
24421 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
24422 CRL in PEM format.
24423
24424
24425 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
24426 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24427 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24428 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24429 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
24430 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24431 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24432 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24433 within the &(smtp)& transport.
24434
24435 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
24436 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24437 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24438 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
24439 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24440
24441 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24442 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24443 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24444 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24445 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24446 usual way.
24447
24448 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
24449 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24450 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24451 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24452 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
24453 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24454 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
24455 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24456 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24457 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24458 unencrypted.
24459
24460 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
24461 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
24462 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24463 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client. &*Note*&:
24464 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
24465 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
24466 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
24467 client.
24468
24469 If &%tls_verify_certificates%& is set, it must name a file or,
24470 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24471 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24472 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24473 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
24474
24475 If
24476 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
24477 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24478 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
24479 alternative hosts, if any.
24480
24481 .vindex "&$host$&"
24482 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24483 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
24484 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
24485 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24486 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24487
24488 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24489 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24490 Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
24491 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
24492 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
24493 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
24494 outgoing connection.
24495
24496
24497
24498 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
24499 "SECTmulmessam"
24500 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
24501 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24502 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24503 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24504 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24505 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24506 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24507 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24508 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24509 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24510 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24511
24512 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24513 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24514 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24515 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24516 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24517 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24518 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24519 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24520 and delay other deliveries to that host.
24521
24522 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24523 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24524 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24525 information is recorded.
24526
24527 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
24528 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24529 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24530
24531
24532
24533
24534 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
24535 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
24536 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24537 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24538 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24539 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24540 to Apache, currently at
24541 .display
24542 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
24543 .endd
24544 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
24545 links to further files.
24546 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
24547 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24548 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24549 .display
24550 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
24551 .endd
24552
24553
24554 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
24555 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
24556 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24557 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24558 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24559 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24560 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24561 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24562 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24563 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24564 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24565 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24566 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24567
24568
24569 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
24570 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
24571 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
24572 with OpenSSL, like this:
24573 .code
24574 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24575 -days 9999 -nodes
24576 .endd
24577 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24578 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
24579 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
24580 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24581 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24582 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24583 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24584
24585 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24586 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24587 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24588
24589 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24590 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
24591 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24592 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
24593 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24594 signed with that self-signed certificate.
24595
24596 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24597 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
24598 Open-source PKI book, available online at
24599 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
24600 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
24601 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
24602
24603
24604
24605 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24606 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24607
24608 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
24609 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
24610 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
24611 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
24612 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
24613 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24614 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
24615 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24616 one very small ACL:
24617 .code
24618 begin acl
24619 small_acl:
24620 accept hosts = one.host.only
24621 .endd
24622 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24623 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24624
24625 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24626 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24627 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
24628 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24629 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24630 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24631 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24632 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
24633
24634
24635 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
24636 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
24637 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24638 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
24639 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
24640
24641
24642
24643 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
24644 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
24645 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24646 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24647 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
24648 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24649 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
24650 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
24651 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24652 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24653 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
24654 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24655 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
24656 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
24657 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
24658 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24659 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24660 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
24661
24662 .table2 140pt
24663 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
24664 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
24665 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
24666 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
24667 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
24668 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
24669 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
24670 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
24671 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
24672 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
24673 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
24674 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
24675 .irow &new(&%acl_smtp_notquit%&) "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
24676 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
24677 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
24678 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
24679 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
24680 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
24681 .endtable
24682
24683 For example, if you set
24684 .code
24685 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
24686 .endd
24687 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
24688 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
24689 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
24690 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
24691 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
24692 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
24693 testing as possible at RCPT time.
24694
24695
24696 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
24697 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24698 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
24699 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
24700 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
24701 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
24702 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
24703 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
24704 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
24705 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
24706 in any of these ACLs.
24707
24708 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
24709 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
24710 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
24711 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
24712 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
24713 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
24714 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
24715 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
24716 .code
24717 control = suppress_local_fixups
24718 .endd
24719 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
24720 run, it is too late.
24721
24722 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24723 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24724
24725 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
24726 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
24727 temporary error for these kinds of message.
24728
24729
24730 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
24731 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24732 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
24733 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
24734 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
24735 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
24736 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
24737 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
24738 &%smtp_banner%& option.
24739
24740
24741 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
24742 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24743 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24744 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
24745 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
24746 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
24747 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
24748 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
24749 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
24750
24751 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
24752 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
24753 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
24754 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
24755 an EHLO response.
24756
24757
24758 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
24759 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24760 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
24761 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
24762 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
24763 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
24764 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
24765 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
24766 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
24767 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
24768
24769 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
24770 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
24771 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
24772 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
24773 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
24774 associated with the DATA command.
24775
24776 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
24777 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
24778 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
24779 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
24780 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
24781 your resources.
24782
24783
24784 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
24785 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24786 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24787
24788
24789 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
24790 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24791 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
24792 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
24793 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
24794 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
24795
24796 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
24797 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
24798 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
24799 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
24800
24801 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
24802 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
24803
24804 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
24805 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
24806 response to QUIT.
24807
24808 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
24809 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
24810 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
24811 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
24812 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
24813
24814
24815
24816 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
24817 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%smtp_notquit_acl%&, is run in most cases when
24818 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
24819 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
24820 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
24821 situation even worse.
24822
24823 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
24824 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
24825 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
24826 and &%warn%&.
24827
24828 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
24829 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
24830 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
24831 connection. The possible values are:
24832 .table2
24833 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
24834 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
24835 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
24836 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
24837 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
24838 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
24839 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
24840 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
24841 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
24842 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
24843 .endtable
24844 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
24845 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
24846 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
24847 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
24848 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
24849 used.
24850
24851
24852 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
24853 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
24854 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
24855 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
24856 .code
24857 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
24858 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
24859 .endd
24860 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
24861 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
24862 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
24863 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
24864 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
24865
24866 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
24867 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
24868 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
24869
24870 .ilist
24871 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
24872 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
24873 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
24874 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
24875 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
24876 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
24877 .code
24878 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
24879 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
24880 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
24881 .endd
24882 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
24883 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
24884 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
24885 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
24886 .next
24887 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
24888 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
24889 matches the string.
24890 .next
24891 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
24892 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
24893 want to have something like
24894 .code
24895 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
24896 .endd
24897 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
24898 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
24899 .endlist
24900
24901
24902
24903
24904 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
24905 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
24906 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
24907 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
24908 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
24909 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
24910 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
24911 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
24912 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
24913
24914 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
24915 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
24916 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
24917
24918
24919 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
24920 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
24921 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
24922 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
24923
24924 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
24925 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
24926 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
24927 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
24928 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
24929 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
24930 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
24931
24932
24933 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
24934 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
24935 recipients; it may create new recipients.
24936
24937
24938
24939 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
24940 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
24941 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
24942 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
24943 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
24944 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
24945
24946 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
24947 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
24948 used to accept or reject anything.
24949
24950 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
24951 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
24952 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
24953 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
24954
24955 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
24956 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
24957 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
24958 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
24959 configuration file.
24960
24961
24962
24963
24964 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
24965 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
24966 .vindex &$domain$&
24967 .vindex &$local_part$&
24968 .vindex &$sender_address$&
24969 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
24970 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
24971 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
24972 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
24973 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
24974 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
24975 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
24976 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
24977
24978 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
24979 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
24980 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
24981 how it is used.
24982
24983 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24984 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
24985 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
24986 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
24987 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
24988 received).
24989
24990 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
24991 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
24992 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
24993 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
24994 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
24995 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
24996 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
24997 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
24998
24999
25000
25001
25002
25003 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
25004 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
25005 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
25006 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25007 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
25008 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
25009 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25010 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
25011 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
25012 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
25013 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
25014 unencrypted connections.
25015 .code
25016 acl_check_auth:
25017 accept encrypted = *
25018 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25019 {CRAM-MD5}}
25020 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25021 .endd
25022 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25023 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25024 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25025 option to do this.)
25026
25027
25028
25029 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25030 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25031 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25032 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25033 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25034 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25035 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25036
25037 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25038 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25039 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25040 example:
25041 .code
25042 deny dnslists = list1.example
25043 dnslists = list2.example
25044 .endd
25045 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25046 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25047 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25048 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25049 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25050
25051
25052 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25053 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25054
25055 .ilist
25056 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25057 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25058 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25059 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25060 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25061 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25062 check a RCPT command:
25063 .code
25064 accept domains = +local_domains
25065 endpass
25066 verify = recipient
25067 .endd
25068 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25069 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25070 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25071 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25072 &%endpass%&.
25073
25074 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25075 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25076 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25077 configuration.
25078
25079 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25080 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25081 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25082 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25083 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25084 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25085 .display
25086 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25087 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25088 .endd
25089 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25090 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25091 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25092
25093 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25094 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25095 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25096 of &%endpass%&.
25097
25098
25099 .next
25100 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25101 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25102 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25103 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25104 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25105 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25106 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25107
25108
25109 .next
25110 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25111 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25112 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25113 example,
25114 .code
25115 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25116 .endd
25117 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25118
25119
25120 .next
25121 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25122 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25123 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25124 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25125 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25126 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25127 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25128 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25129 do not appear in the log line when the &%log_recipients%& log selector is set.
25130
25131 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25132 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25133 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25134
25135
25136 .next
25137 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25138 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25139 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25140 .code
25141 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25142 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25143 .endd
25144 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25145 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25146
25147 .next
25148 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25149 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25150 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25151 example, when checking a RCPT command,
25152 .code
25153 require message = Sender did not verify
25154 verify = sender
25155 .endd
25156 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25157 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25158 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25159 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25160
25161 .next
25162 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25163 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25164 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25165 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25166 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25167 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25168 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25169
25170 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25171 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25172 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25173 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25174 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25175
25176 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25177 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25178 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25179 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25180 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25181 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25182 onwards.
25183
25184
25185 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25186 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25187 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25188 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25189 .code
25190 warn !verify = sender
25191 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25192 .endd
25193 .endlist
25194
25195 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25196
25197 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25198 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25199 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25200 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25201 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25202
25203
25204
25205 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25206 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25207 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25208 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25209 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25210 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25211 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25212 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25213 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25214 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25215 .ilist
25216 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25217 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25218 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25219 on the same SMTP connection.
25220 .next
25221 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25222 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25223 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25224 .endlist
25225
25226 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25227 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25228 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25229 .code
25230 accept hosts = whatever
25231 set acl_m4 = some value
25232 accept authenticated = *
25233 set acl_c_auth = yes
25234 .endd
25235 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25236 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25237 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25238
25239 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25240 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25241 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25242 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25243 error is generated.
25244
25245 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25246 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25247
25248
25249 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25250 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25251 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25252 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25253 .code
25254 deny domains = *.dom.example
25255 !verify = recipient
25256 .endd
25257 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25258 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25259 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25260 two statements are equivalent:
25261 .code
25262 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25263 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25264 .endd
25265 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25266 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25267
25268 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25269 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25270 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25271 .code
25272 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25273 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25274 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25275 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25276 .endd
25277 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25278 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25279 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
25280 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
25281 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25282 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25283 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
25284
25285 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25286 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25287 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25288 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
25289 message is handled.
25290
25291 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25292 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25293 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25294 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
25295 .code
25296 require message = Can't verify sender
25297 verify = sender
25298 message = Can't verify recipient
25299 verify = recipient
25300 message = This message cannot be used
25301 .endd
25302 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25303 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
25304 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25305 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25306 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
25307 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25308
25309 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
25310 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25311 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
25312 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25313 .code
25314 deny hosts = ...
25315 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25316 message = Invalid sender from client host
25317 .endd
25318 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25319 by which time Exim has set up the message.
25320
25321
25322
25323 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
25324 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
25325 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25326
25327 .vlist
25328 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25329 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
25330 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
25331 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25332
25333 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25334 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
25335 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
25336 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
25337 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
25338 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
25339 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
25340 write rather ugly lines like this:
25341 .display
25342 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
25343 .endd
25344 Instead, all you need is
25345 .display
25346 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
25347 .endd
25348
25349 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25350 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25351 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25352 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25353 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25354 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25355 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25356 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25357
25358 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25359 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
25360 in several different ways. For example:
25361
25362 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
25363 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
25364 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
25365 . ==== way.
25366
25367 .ilist
25368 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
25369 .code
25370 accept ...some conditions
25371 control = queue_only
25372 .endd
25373 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
25374 other words, when the conditions are all true.
25375
25376 .next
25377 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
25378 .code
25379 accept ...some conditions...
25380 control = queue_only
25381 ...some more conditions...
25382 .endd
25383 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25384 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25385 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
25386 to be relevant.
25387
25388 .next
25389 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
25390 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25391 example:
25392 .code
25393 warn ...some conditions...
25394 control = freeze
25395 accept ...
25396 .endd
25397 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
25398 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
25399 log entry.
25400
25401 .next
25402 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25403 &%require%& verb. For example:
25404 .code
25405 require control = no_multiline_responses
25406 .endd
25407 .endlist
25408
25409 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
25410 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
25411 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
25412 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
25413 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
25414 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
25415 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
25416 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
25417 flushed before the delay is imposed.
25418
25419 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
25420 example:
25421 .code
25422 deny ...some conditions...
25423 delay = 30s
25424 .endd
25425 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25426 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
25427 .code
25428 deny delay = 30s
25429 ...some conditions...
25430 .endd
25431 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
25432 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
25433 .code
25434 warn ...some conditions...
25435 delay = 2m
25436 control = freeze
25437 accept ...
25438 .endd
25439
25440 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
25441 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
25442 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
25443 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
25444 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
25445 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
25446 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
25447
25448
25449 .vitem &*endpass*&
25450 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
25451 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
25452 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
25453 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
25454 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
25455 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
25456 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
25457
25458
25459 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25460 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
25461 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25462 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
25463 .code
25464 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25465 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25466 .endd
25467 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
25468 example:
25469 .display
25470 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
25471 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
25472 .endd
25473 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
25474 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
25475 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
25476 message.
25477
25478 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
25479 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
25480 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
25481 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
25482 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
25483 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
25484 ignored.
25485
25486 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25487 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
25488 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
25489 error message.
25490
25491 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
25492 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
25493 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
25494 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
25495 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
25496 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
25497
25498 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25499 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
25500 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25501 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25502 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
25503 logging rejections.
25504
25505
25506 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
25507 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
25508 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
25509 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
25510 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
25511 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
25512 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
25513 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
25514 .display
25515 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
25516 &` log_reject_target =`&
25517 .endd
25518 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
25519 permanent and temporary rejections.
25520
25521
25522 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25523 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
25524 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
25525 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25526 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
25527 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
25528 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
25529 ACLs. For example:
25530 .display
25531 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
25532 &` control = freeze`&
25533 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
25534 .endd
25535 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25536 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25537 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25538 example:
25539 .code
25540 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25541 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25542 .endd
25543
25544
25545 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25546 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25547 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
25548 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
25549 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
25550 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
25551 &%accept%& for details.)
25552
25553 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
25554 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
25555 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
25556 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
25557 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
25558 .code
25559 require message = Host not recognized
25560 hosts = 10.0.0.0/8
25561 .endd
25562 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
25563 processed.)
25564
25565 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
25566 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
25567 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
25568 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
25569 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
25570 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
25571 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
25572 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
25573 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
25574 EHLO options.
25575
25576 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
25577 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
25578 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
25579 .code
25580 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
25581 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
25582 .endd
25583 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
25584 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
25585 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
25586 2&'xx'&.
25587
25588 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
25589 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
25590
25591 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
25592 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
25593 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
25594 response.
25595
25596 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25597 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25598 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25599 However, the original message is available in the variable
25600 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25601 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
25602 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25603 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
25604
25605 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
25606 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
25607 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
25608 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
25609 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
25610 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25611 effect.
25612
25613
25614 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
25615 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
25616 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25617 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
25618 .endlist
25619
25620
25621
25622
25623
25624 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
25625 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25626 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
25627
25628 .vlist
25629 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
25630 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
25631 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
25632 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
25633 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
25634 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
25635 not work without it. For example:
25636 .code
25637 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
25638 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
25639 .endd
25640 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
25641 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
25642 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
25643 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
25644 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
25645
25646
25647 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
25648 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
25649 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
25650 .cindex "case of local parts"
25651 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25652 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
25653 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
25654 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
25655 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
25656 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
25657 is encountered.
25658
25659 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
25660 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
25661 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
25662 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
25663 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
25664
25665 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
25666 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
25667 spam score:
25668 .code
25669 warn control = caseful_local_part
25670 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
25671 $acl_m4 + \
25672 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
25673 }
25674 control = caselower_local_part
25675 .endd
25676 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
25677 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
25678
25679 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
25680 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
25681 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
25682 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
25683 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
25684 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
25685 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
25686 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
25687
25688 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25689 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
25690 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
25691 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
25692 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
25693 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
25694 work with.
25695
25696
25697 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
25698 .cindex "fake defer"
25699 .cindex "defer, fake"
25700 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
25701 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
25702 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
25703 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
25704 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
25705
25706 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
25707 .cindex "fake rejection"
25708 .cindex "rejection, fake"
25709 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
25710 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
25711 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
25712 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
25713 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25714 the same SMTP connection.
25715
25716 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
25717 message is supplied, the following is used:
25718 .code
25719 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
25720 550-kept for evaluation.
25721 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
25722 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
25723 .endd
25724 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
25725
25726 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
25727 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
25728 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25729 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25730 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
25731 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
25732 SMTP connection.
25733
25734 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
25735 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
25736 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
25737 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
25738
25739 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
25740 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
25741 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
25742 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25743 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
25744 disables such output flushing.
25745
25746 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
25747 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
25748 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
25749 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25750 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
25751 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
25752
25753 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
25754 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
25755 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
25756 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
25757 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
25758 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
25759 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25760 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
25761 to be useful in production.
25762
25763 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
25764 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
25765 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
25766 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
25767 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
25768
25769 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
25770 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
25771 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
25772 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
25773 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
25774 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
25775
25776 .ilist
25777 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
25778 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
25779 verification failed"&) is sent.
25780 .next
25781 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
25782 line is output.
25783 .endlist
25784
25785 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
25786 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
25787
25788 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
25789 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
25790 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
25791 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
25792 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
25793 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
25794 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
25795
25796 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
25797 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
25798 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
25799 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25800 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25801 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
25802 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
25803 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
25804 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
25805 same SMTP connection.
25806
25807 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
25808 .cindex "message" "submission"
25809 .cindex "submission mode"
25810 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
25811 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
25812 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
25813 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
25814 necessary. For example, it add a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
25815 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
25816 late (the message has already been created).
25817
25818 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
25819 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
25820 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
25821 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
25822 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
25823
25824 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
25825 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
25826 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
25827 complement of &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
25828 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
25829
25830 .ilist
25831 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
25832 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
25833 .next
25834 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
25835 .next
25836 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
25837 .endlist ilist
25838
25839 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
25840 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
25841 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
25842 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
25843 data is read.
25844
25845 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
25846 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
25847 .endlist vlist
25848
25849
25850 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
25851 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
25852
25853 .ilist
25854 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
25855 .next
25856 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`&
25857 &`suppress_local_fixups`&.
25858 .next
25859 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
25860 .next
25861 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&.
25862 .endlist
25863
25864
25865
25866 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
25867 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
25868 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
25869 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25870 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
25871 to an incoming message, as in this example:
25872 .code
25873 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
25874 dialup.mail-abuse.org
25875 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
25876 .endd
25877 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
25878 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
25879 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
25880 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
25881 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
25882 RCPT ACL).
25883
25884 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
25885 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
25886 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
25887 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
25888
25889 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
25890 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
25891 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
25892 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
25893 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
25894 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
25895 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
25896 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
25897 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
25898 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
25899 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
25900
25901 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
25902 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
25903 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
25904 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
25905 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
25906 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
25907 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
25908 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
25909 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
25910
25911 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
25912 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
25913 .display
25914 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25915 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
25916
25917 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
25918 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25919 .endd
25920 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
25921 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
25922 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
25923 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
25924 honoured.
25925
25926 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25927 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
25928 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
25929 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
25930 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
25931 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
25932 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
25933 specifications.
25934
25935 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
25936 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
25937 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
25938 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
25939 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
25940
25941 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
25942 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
25943 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
25944 to be a header name first.) For example:
25945 .code
25946 warn add_header = \
25947 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
25948 .endd
25949 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
25950 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
25951 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
25952 up in reverse order.
25953
25954 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
25955 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
25956 system filter or in a router or transport.
25957
25958
25959
25960
25961 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
25962 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
25963 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
25964 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
25965 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
25966 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
25967
25968 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
25969 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
25970 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
25971 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
25972 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
25973 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
25974 The conditions are as follows:
25975
25976
25977 .vlist
25978 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
25979 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
25980 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
25981 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
25982 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
25983 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
25984 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
25985 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
25986 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
25987 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
25988 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
25989
25990 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
25991 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
25992 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
25993 conditions are tested.
25994
25995 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
25996 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
25997 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
25998 for different local users or different local domains.
25999
26000 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26001 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
26002 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
26003 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
26004 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
26005 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
26006 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
26007 .code
26008 authenticated = *
26009 .endd
26010
26011 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
26012 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
26013 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
26014 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26015 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26016 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26017 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26018 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26019 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26020 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26021 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26022 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26023 negative.
26024
26025 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26026 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26027 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26028 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26029 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26030 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26031 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26032 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26033
26034 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26035 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26036 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26037 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26038 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26039
26040 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26041 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26042 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26043 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26044 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26045 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26046 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26047 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26048 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26049 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26050
26051 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26052 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26053 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26054 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26055 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26056 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26057 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26058 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26059 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26060 &%domains%& test.
26061
26062 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26063 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26064
26065
26066 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26067 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26068 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26069 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26070 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26071 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26072 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26073 .code
26074 encrypted = *
26075 .endd
26076
26077
26078 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26079 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26080 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26081 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26082 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26083 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26084 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26085 .code
26086 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26087 .endd
26088 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26089 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26090 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26091
26092 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26093 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26094 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26095 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26096 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26097 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26098
26099 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26100 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26101 .code
26102 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26103 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26104 .endd
26105 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26106 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26107 statement can then check the IP address.
26108
26109 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
26110 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26111 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26112 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26113 .code
26114 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26115 message = $host_data
26116 .endd
26117 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26118
26119 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26120 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26121 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26122 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26123 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26124 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26125 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26126 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26127 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26128 the next &%local_parts%& test.
26129
26130 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26131 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26132 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26133 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26134 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26135 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26136 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26137
26138 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26139 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26140 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26141 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26142 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26143 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26144 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26145 &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26146
26147 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26148 .cindex "rate limiting"
26149 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26150 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26151
26152 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26153 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26154 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26155 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26156 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26157 recipient address against a list of recipients.
26158
26159 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26160 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26161 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26162 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26163 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26164 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26165 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26166
26167 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26168 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26169 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26170 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26171 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26172 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26173 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26174 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26175 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26176 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26177 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26178 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26179 influence the sender checking.
26180
26181 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26182 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26183
26184 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26185 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26186 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26187 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26188 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26189 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26190 .code
26191 senders = :
26192 .endd
26193 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26194 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26195
26196 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26197 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26198 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26199 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26200 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26201 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26202
26203 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26204 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26205 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26206 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26207 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26208 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26209 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26210 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26211 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26212 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26213
26214 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26215 .cindex "CSA verification"
26216 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26217 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26218 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26219
26220 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26221 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26222 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26223 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26224 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26225 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26226 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26227 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26228 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26229 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26230 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26231 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26232 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26233 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26234 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26235
26236 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26237 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26238 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26239 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26240 .code
26241 deny senders = :
26242 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26243 !verify = header_sender
26244 .endd
26245
26246 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26247 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26248 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26249 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
26250 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
26251 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26252 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26253 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
26254 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
26255 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
26256 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
26257 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26258 appropriate.
26259
26260 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
26261 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
26262 .code
26263 To: @
26264 .endd
26265 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
26266 common as they used to be.
26267
26268 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
26269 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26270 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
26271 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
26272 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
26273 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
26274 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
26275 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
26276 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
26277 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
26278 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
26279 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
26280 independently of this condition.
26281
26282 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
26283 option), this condition is always true.
26284
26285
26286 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
26287 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
26288 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
26289 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
26290 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
26291 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
26292 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
26293 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
26294 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
26295
26296 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
26297 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
26298
26299
26300 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
26301 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26302 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
26303 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
26304 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
26305 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26306 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
26307 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
26308 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
26309 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
26310 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
26311 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
26312 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
26313 value for the child address.
26314
26315 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
26316 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26317 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
26318 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
26319 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
26320 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
26321 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
26322 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
26323 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
26324 original IP address.
26325
26326 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
26327 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
26328
26329 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
26330 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26331 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
26332 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
26333 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
26334 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
26335 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
26336 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
26337 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
26338
26339 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26340 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
26341 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
26342 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
26343 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
26344 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
26345 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
26346
26347 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
26348 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
26349 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
26350
26351 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
26352 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26353 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
26354 verified as a sender.
26355 .endlist
26356
26357
26358
26359 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
26360 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26361 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26362 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26363 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
26364 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
26365 address in one or more DNS domains. For example, if the calling host's IP
26366 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
26367 .code
26368 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
26369 dialups.mail-abuse.org
26370 .endd
26371 the following records are looked up:
26372 .code
26373 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26374 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
26375 .endd
26376 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
26377 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
26378 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
26379 use two separate conditions:
26380 .code
26381 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26382 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26383 .endd
26384 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
26385 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
26386 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
26387 processed.
26388
26389 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
26390 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
26391 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
26392 following special items in the list:
26393 .display
26394 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
26395 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
26396 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
26397 .endd
26398 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
26399 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
26400 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
26401 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
26402 .code
26403 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
26404 .endd
26405 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
26406 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
26407 .code
26408 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26409 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
26410 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26411 .endd
26412 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
26413 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
26414 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
26415 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
26416
26417
26418
26419 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
26420 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
26421 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
26422 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
26423 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
26424 .code
26425 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
26426 .endd
26427 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
26428 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
26429 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
26430 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
26431
26432
26433
26434
26435 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
26436 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
26437 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
26438 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
26439 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
26440 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
26441 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
26442 .code
26443 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
26444 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26445 .endd
26446 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
26447 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
26448 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
26449 up by this example is
26450 .code
26451 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
26452 .endd
26453 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
26454 addresses. For example:
26455 .code
26456 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26457 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26458 .endd
26459 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
26460 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
26461
26462
26463
26464
26465 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
26466 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
26467 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
26468 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
26469 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
26470 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
26471 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
26472 either to double the separators like this:
26473 .code
26474 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
26475 .endd
26476 or to change the separator character, like this:
26477 .code
26478 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
26479 .endd
26480 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
26481 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
26482 occurs. Consider this condition:
26483 .code
26484 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
26485 .endd
26486 The DNS lookups that occur are:
26487 .code
26488 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
26489 a.domain.black.list.tld
26490 .endd
26491 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
26492 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
26493 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
26494 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
26495 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
26496 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
26497 error for a previous item.
26498
26499 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
26500 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
26501 .code
26502 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
26503 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
26504 .endd
26505 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
26506 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
26507 .code
26508 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
26509 $sender_address_domain \
26510 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
26511 see $dnslist_text.
26512 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
26513 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
26514 $sender_address_domain} }} }
26515 .endd
26516 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
26517 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
26518 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
26519 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
26520 .code
26521 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
26522 .endd
26523 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
26524 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
26525
26526 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
26527 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
26528
26529
26530
26531
26532 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
26533 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
26534 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26535 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26536 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26537 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26538 .display
26539 127.1.0.1 RBL
26540 127.1.0.2 DUL
26541 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26542 127.1.0.4 RSS
26543 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26544 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26545 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26546 .endd
26547 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
26548 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
26549 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
26550
26551
26552 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
26553 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
26554 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
26555 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
26556 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
26557 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
26558 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
26559 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
26560 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
26561 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
26562 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
26563 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
26564 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
26565 cases, for example:
26566 .code
26567 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
26568 .endd
26569 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
26570 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
26571 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
26572 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
26573 .code
26574 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
26575 .endd
26576 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
26577 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
26578
26579 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
26580 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
26581 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
26582 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
26583 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
26584 information.
26585
26586 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
26587 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
26588 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
26589 .code
26590 deny hosts = !+local_networks
26591 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26592 at $dnslist_domain
26593 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26594 .endd
26595
26596
26597
26598 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
26599 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
26600 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
26601 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26602 For example,
26603 .code
26604 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26605 .endd
26606 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26607 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
26608 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
26609 describes how multiple records are handled.
26610
26611 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26612 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
26613 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
26614 .code
26615 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26616 .endd
26617 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26618 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26619 first. For example:
26620 .code
26621 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
26622 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
26623 .endd
26624
26625 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
26626 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
26627 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
26628 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
26629 tested. For example:
26630 .code
26631 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
26632 .endd
26633 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
26634 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
26635 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
26636 .code
26637 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26638 .endd
26639 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
26640 an odd number.
26641
26642
26643
26644 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
26645 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
26646 condition. Whereas
26647 .code
26648 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26649 .endd
26650 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26651 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
26652 .code
26653 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26654 .endd
26655 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26656 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
26657 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
26658 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
26659
26660 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
26661 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
26662
26663 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
26664 previous example is precisely equivalent to
26665 .code
26666 deny dnslists = a.b.c
26667 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26668 .endd
26669 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
26670 Consider this example:
26671 .code
26672 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26673 list.dsbl.org : \
26674 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
26675 relays.ordb.org
26676 .endd
26677 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
26678 .code
26679 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26680 list.dsbl.org
26681 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
26682 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
26683 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
26684 .endd
26685 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
26686
26687
26688
26689
26690 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
26691 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
26692 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
26693 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
26694 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
26695 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
26696 .code
26697 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
26698 .endd
26699 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
26700 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
26701 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
26702 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
26703 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
26704 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
26705
26706 .ilist
26707 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
26708 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
26709 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26710 .next
26711 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
26712 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
26713 changed to:
26714 .code
26715 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
26716 .endd
26717 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26718 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
26719 .code
26720 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
26721 .endd
26722 for the condition to be true.
26723 .endlist
26724
26725 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
26726 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
26727 .ilist
26728 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
26729 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
26730 .code
26731 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
26732 .endd
26733 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26734 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26735 .next
26736 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
26737 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
26738 .code
26739 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
26740 .endd
26741 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26742 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
26743 .code
26744 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26745 .endd
26746 for the condition to be false.
26747 .endlist
26748 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
26749 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
26750
26751
26752
26753
26754 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
26755 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
26756 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
26757 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
26758 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
26759 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
26760 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
26761 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
26762 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
26763 lists.
26764
26765 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
26766 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
26767 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
26768 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
26769 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
26770 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
26771 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
26772 .code
26773 reject message = \
26774 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
26775 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
26776 dnslists = \
26777 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
26778 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26779 .endd
26780 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
26781 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
26782 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
26783 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
26784 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
26785 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
26786
26787 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
26788 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
26789 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
26790 .code
26791 reject dnslists = \
26792 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
26793 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
26794 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
26795 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26796 .endd
26797 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
26798 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
26799 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
26800
26801
26802
26803 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
26804 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
26805 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
26806 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
26807 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
26808 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
26809 .code
26810 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
26811 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26812 .endd
26813 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
26814 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
26815 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
26816 .code
26817 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
26818 .endd
26819 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
26820 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
26821
26822 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
26823 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
26824 .code
26825 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
26826 dnslists = some.list.example
26827 .endd
26828
26829 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
26830 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
26831 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
26832 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
26833 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
26834 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
26835 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
26836 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
26837 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
26838 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
26839 .display
26840 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
26841 .endd
26842 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
26843 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
26844
26845 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
26846 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
26847 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
26848 of &'p'&.
26849
26850 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
26851 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
26852 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
26853 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
26854 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
26855 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
26856 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
26857 changing its overall sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
26858 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
26859
26860 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
26861 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
26862 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
26863 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
26864
26865 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
26866 sending rate. This data is stored in a database maintained by Exim in its spool
26867 directory, alongside the retry and other hints databases. The default key is
26868 &$sender_host_address$&, which applies the limit to each client host IP address.
26869 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
26870 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
26871 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
26872 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
26873 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
26874 authenticated, and you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition.
26875
26876 If you want to limit the rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can
26877 use the key &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in
26878 a RCPT ACL.
26879
26880 Internally, Exim includes the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options in the
26881 lookup key because they alter the meaning of the stored data. This is not true
26882 for the limit &'m'&, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will
26883 still remember clients' past behaviour, but if you alter the other ratelimit
26884 parameters Exim forgets past behaviour.
26885
26886 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to three options. One option
26887 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, and the second specifies how Exim
26888 handles excessively fast clients. The third option can be &`noupdate`&, to
26889 disable updating of the ratelimiting database (see section &<<rearatdat>>&).
26890 The options are separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may
26891 appear in any order.
26892
26893 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
26894 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate.
26895
26896 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
26897 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified.
26898
26899 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. Note that it is
26900 best to use this option in the DATA ACL; if it is used in an earlier ACL it
26901 relies on the SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or
26902 completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K,
26903 M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
26904
26905 .new
26906 The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which
26907 recipients are accepted. To be effective, it would need to be used in
26908 either the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& or the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. In the
26909 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACL, the number of recipients is incremented by one.
26910 In the case of a locally submitted message in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL,
26911 the number of recipients incremented is equal to &%$recipients_count%&
26912 for the entire message. Note that in either case the rate limiting
26913 engine will see a message with many recipients as a large high-speed
26914 burst.
26915
26916 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
26917 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate.
26918 This command is essentially an alias of &%per_rcpt%& to make it clear
26919 that the effect is to limit the rate at which individual commands,
26920 rather than recipients, are accepted.
26921 .wen
26922
26923 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratophanfas"
26924 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
26925 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
26926 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& options. This is independent of the other
26927 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
26928 rest of the ACL. The default mode is leaky, which avoids a sender's
26929 over-aggressive retry rate preventing it from getting any email through.
26930
26931 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always updated.
26932 The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate of attempts
26933 to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum &new("it is actually
26934 allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
26935 counter-measures in the ACL until it slows down below the maximum rate.") The
26936 smoothing period determines the time it takes for a high sending rate to decay
26937 exponentially to 37% of its peak value, which means that you can work out the
26938 time (the number of smoothing periods) that a client is subjected to
26939 counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this formula:
26940 .code
26941 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
26942 .endd
26943 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
26944 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
26945 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
26946 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
26947 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
26948 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
26949 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
26950
26951 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
26952 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
26953 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
26954 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
26955 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
26956 message. For example:
26957 .code
26958 # Log all senders' rates
26959 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
26960 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
26961
26962 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
26963 # at the decimal point.
26964 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
26965 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
26966 $sender_rate_limit }s
26967
26968 # Keep authenticated users under control
26969 deny authenticated = *
26970 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
26971
26972 # System-wide rate limit
26973 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
26974 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
26975
26976 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
26977 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
26978 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
26979 messages per $sender_rate_period
26980 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
26981 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
26982 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
26983 .endd
26984 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
26985 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
26986 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
26987 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
26988 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
26989 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
26990 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
26991
26992
26993 .section "Reading ratelimit data without updating" "rearatdat"
26994 .cindex "rate limitint" "reading data without updating"
26995 If the &%noupdate%& option is present on a &%ratelimit%& ACL condition, Exim
26996 computes the rate and checks the limit as normal, but it does not update the
26997 saved data. This means that, in relevant ACLs, it is possible to lookup the
26998 existence of a specified (or auto-generated) ratelimit key without incrementing
26999 the ratelimit counter for that key. In order for this to be useful, another ACL
27000 entry must set the rate for the same key (otherwise it will always be zero).
27001 For example:
27002 .code
27003 acl_check_connect:
27004 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / noupdate
27005 log_message = RATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27006 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27007 .endd
27008 .display
27009 &'... some other logic and tests...'&
27010 .endd
27011 .code
27012 acl_check_mail:
27013 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd
27014 condition = ${if le{$sender_rate}{$sender_rate_limit}}
27015 logwrite = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27016 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27017 .endd
27018 In this example, the rate is tested and used to deny access (when it is too
27019 high) in the connect ACL, but the actual computation of the remembered rate
27020 happens later, on a per-command basis, in another ACL.
27021
27022
27023
27024 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27025 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27026 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27027 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27028 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27029 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27030 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27031 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27032 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27033 .code
27034 verify = sender/callout
27035 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27036 .endd
27037 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27038 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27039 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27040 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27041 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27042 The available options are as follows:
27043
27044 .ilist
27045 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27046 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27047 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27048 .next
27049 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27050 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27051 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27052 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27053 .next
27054 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27055 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27056 .next
27057 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27058 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27059 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27060 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27061 .endlist
27062
27063 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27064 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27065 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27066 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27067 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27068 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27069 coding like this:
27070 .code
27071 warn !verify = sender
27072 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27073 .endd
27074 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27075 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27076 verification failure.
27077
27078 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27079 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27080
27081 .ilist
27082 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27083 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27084 .next
27085 &%route%&: Routing failed.
27086 .next
27087 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27088 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27089 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27090 .next
27091 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27092 .next
27093 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27094 .endlist
27095
27096 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27097 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27098
27099
27100
27101
27102 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27103 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27104 .cindex "callout" "verification"
27105 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27106 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27107 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27108 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27109 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27110 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27111 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27112 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27113 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27114 sender's domain.
27115
27116 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27117 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27118 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27119 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27120 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27121 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27122
27123 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27124 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27125 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27126 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27127 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27128
27129 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27130 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27131 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27132 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27133 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27134 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27135 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27136 supplies a host list.
27137
27138 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27139 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27140 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27141 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27142 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27143 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27144 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27145
27146 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27147 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27148 following SMTP commands are sent:
27149 .display
27150 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27151 &`MAIL FROM:<>`&
27152 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27153 &`QUIT`&
27154 .endd
27155 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27156 set to &"lmtp"&.
27157
27158 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27159 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27160 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27161 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27162 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27163 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27164
27165 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27166 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27167 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27168 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27169 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27170
27171 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27172 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27173 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27174 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
27175 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
27176
27177
27178
27179
27180 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
27181 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
27182 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
27183 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
27184 .code
27185 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
27186 .endd
27187 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
27188 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
27189 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
27190
27191
27192 .vlist
27193 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
27194 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
27195 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
27196 For example:
27197 .code
27198 verify = sender/callout=5s
27199 .endd
27200 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
27201 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
27202 the &%connect%& parameter.
27203
27204
27205 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27206 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
27207 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
27208 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
27209 .code
27210 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
27211 .endd
27212 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
27213
27214 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
27215 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
27216 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
27217 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
27218 updated in this circumstance.
27219
27220 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
27221 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
27222 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
27223 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
27224 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
27225 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
27226
27227
27228 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27229 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
27230 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
27231 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
27232 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
27233 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
27234 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
27235 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
27236 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
27237 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
27238 .code
27239 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
27240 .endd
27241 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
27242
27243
27244 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27245 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
27246 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
27247 For example:
27248 .code
27249 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
27250 .endd
27251 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
27252 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
27253 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
27254 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
27255 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
27256
27257
27258 .vitem &*no_cache*&
27259 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
27260 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
27261 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
27262
27263 .vitem &*postmaster*&
27264 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
27265 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
27266 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
27267 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
27268 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
27269 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
27270 made, until the cache record expires.
27271
27272 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27273 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
27274 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
27275 For example:
27276 .code
27277 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
27278 .endd
27279 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
27280 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
27281 .code
27282 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
27283 .endd
27284 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
27285 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
27286 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
27287 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
27288
27289
27290 .vitem &*random*&
27291 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
27292 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
27293 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
27294 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
27295 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
27296 .code
27297 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
27298 .endd
27299 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
27300 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
27301 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
27302 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
27303 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
27304
27305 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
27306 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
27307 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27308 .code
27309 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
27310 .endd
27311 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
27312 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
27313 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
27314 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
27315 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
27316
27317 .vitem &*use_sender*&
27318 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27319 .code
27320 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
27321 .endd
27322 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
27323 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
27324 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
27325 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
27326 usefulness of callout caching.
27327 .endlist
27328
27329 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
27330 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
27331 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
27332 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
27333 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
27334 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
27335 these circumstances.
27336
27337 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
27338 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
27339 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
27340 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
27341 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
27342 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
27343 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
27344
27345 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
27346 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
27347 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
27348 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
27349
27350
27351
27352
27353 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
27354 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
27355 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
27356 .cindex "caching" "callout"
27357 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
27358 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
27359 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
27360 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
27361 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
27362 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
27363
27364 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
27365 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
27366 is not available.
27367
27368 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
27369 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
27370 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
27371
27372 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
27373 commands up to and including
27374 .code
27375 MAIL FROM:<>
27376 .endd
27377 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
27378 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
27379 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
27380 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
27381 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
27382 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
27383 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
27384
27385 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
27386 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
27387 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
27388 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
27389 will eventually be noticed.
27390
27391 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
27392 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
27393 behaviour will be the same.
27394
27395
27396
27397 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
27398 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
27399 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
27400 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
27401 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
27402 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
27403 you might see:
27404 .code
27405 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
27406 250 OK
27407 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
27408 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
27409 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
27410 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
27411 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
27412 550 Sender verification failed
27413 .endd
27414 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
27415 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
27416 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
27417 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
27418 example:
27419 .code
27420 verify = sender/no_details
27421 .endd
27422
27423 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
27424 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
27425 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
27426 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
27427 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
27428 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
27429 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
27430
27431 .ilist
27432 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
27433 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
27434 verification also fails.
27435 .next
27436 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
27437 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
27438 .endlist
27439
27440 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
27441 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
27442 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
27443 .code
27444 A.Wol: aw123
27445 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
27446 .endd
27447 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
27448 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
27449 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
27450 verification to succeed.
27451
27452 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
27453 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
27454 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
27455 option. For example:
27456 .code
27457 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
27458 .endd
27459 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
27460 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
27461
27462 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
27463 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
27464 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
27465 address and a report is output for each of them.
27466
27467
27468
27469 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
27470 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
27471 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
27472 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
27473 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
27474 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
27475 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
27476 .code
27477 verify = csa
27478 .endd
27479 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
27480 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
27481 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
27482 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
27483 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
27484 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
27485
27486 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
27487 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
27488 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
27489 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
27490
27491 .ilist
27492 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
27493 .next
27494 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
27495 .next
27496 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
27497 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
27498 .next
27499 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
27500 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
27501 .endlist
27502
27503 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
27504 use for the DNS query. The default is:
27505 .code
27506 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
27507 .endd
27508 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
27509 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
27510 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
27511 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
27512 meaningful to say:
27513 .code
27514 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
27515 .endd
27516 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
27517 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
27518 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
27519
27520 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
27521 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
27522 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
27523 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
27524 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
27525 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
27526 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
27527 of legitimate HELO domains.
27528
27529 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
27530 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
27531 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
27532 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
27533 lookup such as:
27534 .code
27535 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
27536 .endd
27537 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
27538 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
27539 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
27540
27541
27542
27543
27544 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
27545 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
27546 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
27547 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
27548 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
27549 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
27550 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
27551 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
27552
27553 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
27554 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
27555 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
27556 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
27557 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
27558 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
27559 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
27560
27561 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
27562 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
27563 like this:
27564 .code
27565 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
27566 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
27567 }{$value}}
27568 .endd
27569 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
27570 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
27571 use this:
27572 .code
27573 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
27574 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
27575 senders = :
27576 recipients = +batv_senders
27577
27578 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
27579 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
27580 senders = :
27581 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
27582 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
27583 !condition = $prvscheck_result
27584 .endd
27585 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
27586 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
27587 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
27588 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
27589 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
27590
27591 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
27592 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
27593 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
27594 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
27595 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
27596 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
27597 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
27598
27599 There are two more issues you must consider when implementing prvs-signing.
27600 Firstly, you need to ensure that prvs-signed addresses are not blocked by your
27601 ACLs. A prvs-signed address contains a slash character, but the default Exim
27602 configuration contains this statement in the RCPT ACL:
27603 .code
27604 deny message = Restricted characters in address
27605 domains = +local_domains
27606 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
27607 .endd
27608 This is a conservative rule that blocks local parts that contain slashes. You
27609 should remove the slash in the last line.
27610
27611 Secondly, you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
27612 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
27613 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
27614 .code
27615 batv_redirect:
27616 driver = redirect
27617 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
27618 .endd
27619 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
27620 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
27621 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
27622 local addresses.
27623
27624 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
27625 can be used:
27626 .code
27627 external_smtp_batv:
27628 driver = smtp
27629 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
27630 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
27631 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
27632 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
27633 {$value}fail}}}
27634 .endd
27635 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
27636
27637
27638
27639 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
27640 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
27641 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
27642 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
27643 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
27644 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
27645 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
27646 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
27647 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
27648 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
27649
27650 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
27651 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
27652 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
27653 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
27654 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
27655 same host is fulfilling both functions,
27656 . ///
27657 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
27658 . ///
27659 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
27660 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
27661 system to arbitrary domains.
27662
27663
27664 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
27665 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
27666 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
27667 example, suppose you want to do the following:
27668
27669 .ilist
27670 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
27671 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
27672 &'my.dom2.example'&.
27673 .next
27674 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
27675 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
27676 .next
27677 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
27678 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
27679 .endlist
27680
27681
27682 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
27683 .code
27684 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
27685 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
27686 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
27687 .endd
27688 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
27689 command:
27690 .code
27691 acl_check_rcpt:
27692 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
27693 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
27694 .endd
27695 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
27696 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
27697 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
27698 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
27699 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
27700 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
27701 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27702
27703
27704
27705 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
27706 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
27707 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
27708 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
27709 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27710
27711 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
27712 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
27713 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
27714 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
27715 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
27716 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
27717 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
27718 .ecindex IIDacl
27719
27720
27721
27722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27723 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27724
27725 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
27726 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
27727 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
27728 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
27729 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
27730 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
27731 specification.
27732
27733 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
27734 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
27735 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
27736 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
27737 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
27738
27739 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
27740 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
27741 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
27742
27743 .ilist
27744 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
27745 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
27746 .next
27747 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
27748 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
27749 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
27750 .next
27751 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
27752 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
27753 .next
27754 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
27755 conditions.
27756 .next
27757 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
27758 .endlist
27759
27760 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
27761 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
27762 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
27763
27764 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
27765 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
27766 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
27767 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
27768 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
27769 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
27770
27771 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
27772 temporarily created in a file called:
27773 .display
27774 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
27775 .endd
27776 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
27777 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
27778 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
27779 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
27780 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
27781 .code
27782 control = no_mbox_unspool
27783 .endd
27784 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
27785 same directory by default.
27786
27787
27788
27789 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
27790 .cindex "virus scanning"
27791 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
27792 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
27793 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
27794 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
27795 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
27796 in memory and thus are much faster.
27797
27798 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
27799 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
27800 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
27801 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
27802 .display
27803 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
27804 .endd
27805 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
27806 .code
27807 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
27808 .endd
27809 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
27810 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
27811
27812 .vlist
27813 .vitem &%aveserver%&
27814 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27815 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
27816 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
27817 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
27818 example:
27819 .code
27820 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
27821 .endd
27822
27823 .vitem &%clamd%&
27824 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
27825 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
27826 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
27827 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
27828 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
27829 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
27830 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
27831 .code
27832 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
27833 av_scanner = clamd:192.168.2.100 1234
27834 .endd
27835 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
27836 contributing the code for this scanner.
27837
27838 .vitem &%cmdline%&
27839 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
27840 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
27841 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
27842 type takes 3 mandatory options:
27843
27844 .olist
27845 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
27846 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
27847
27848 .next
27849 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
27850 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
27851 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
27852 the &"trigger"& expression.
27853
27854 .next
27855 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
27856 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
27857 &"name"& expression.
27858 .endlist olist
27859
27860 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
27861 .code
27862 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
27863 .endd
27864 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
27865 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
27866 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
27867 configuration setting:
27868 .code
27869 av_scanner = cmdline:\
27870 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
27871 found in file:'(.+)'
27872 .endd
27873 .vitem &%drweb%&
27874 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
27875 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
27876 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
27877 separated by white space, as in these examples:
27878 .code
27879 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
27880 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
27881 .endd
27882 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
27883 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
27884
27885 .vitem &%fsecure%&
27886 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
27887 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
27888 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
27889 .code
27890 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
27891 .endd
27892 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
27893 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
27894
27895 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
27896 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27897 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
27898 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
27899 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
27900 For example:
27901 .code
27902 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
27903 .endd
27904 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
27905
27906 .vitem &%mksd%&
27907 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
27908 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
27909 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
27910 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
27911 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
27912 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
27913 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
27914 .code
27915 av_scanner = mksd:2
27916 .endd
27917 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
27918
27919 .vitem &%sophie%&
27920 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
27921 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
27922 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
27923 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
27924 client communication. For example:
27925 .code
27926 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
27927 .endd
27928 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
27929 the option.
27930 .endlist
27931
27932 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
27933 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
27934 ACL.
27935
27936 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
27937 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
27938 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
27939 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
27940 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
27941 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
27942 message.
27943
27944 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
27945 use. It can then be one of
27946
27947 .ilist
27948 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
27949 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
27950 recommended usage.
27951 .next
27952 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
27953 the condition fails immediately.
27954 .next
27955 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
27956 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
27957 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
27958 .endlist
27959
27960 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
27961 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
27962 causes the ACL to defer.
27963
27964 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
27965 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
27966 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
27967 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
27968 logging data.
27969
27970 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
27971 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
27972 &%malware%& condition.
27973
27974 Here is a very simple scanning example:
27975 .code
27976 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27977 demime = *
27978 malware = *
27979 .endd
27980 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
27981 .code
27982 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27983 demime = *
27984 malware = */defer_ok
27985 .endd
27986 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
27987 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
27988 .code
27989 av_scanner = $acl_m0
27990 .endd
27991 in the main Exim configuration.
27992 .code
27993 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27994 set acl_m0 = sophie
27995 malware = *
27996
27997 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
27998 set acl_m0 = aveserver
27999 malware = *
28000 .endd
28001
28002
28003 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
28004 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
28005 .cindex "spam scanning"
28006 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
28007 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
28008 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
28009 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
28010 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
28011 .code
28012 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
28013 .endd
28014 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
28015 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
28016 nicely, however.
28017
28018 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
28019 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
28020 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
28021 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
28022 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
28023 .code
28024 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
28025 .endd
28026 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
28027 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
28028 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28029 address/port pair:
28030 .code
28031 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28032 .endd
28033 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28034 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28035 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28036 option, separated with colons:
28037 .code
28038 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28039 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28040 192.168.2.12 783
28041 .endd
28042 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28043 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28044 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28045 condition defers.
28046
28047 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28048 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28049
28050 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
28051 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
28052 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
28053 expansion.
28054
28055 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28056 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28057 .code
28058 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28059 spam = joe
28060 .endd
28061 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28062 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28063 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28064 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28065 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28066
28067 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28068 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28069 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28070 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28071 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28072 are not set.
28073
28074 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28075 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28076 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28077
28078
28079 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28080 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28081 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28082 example:
28083 .code
28084 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28085 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28086 spam = nobody
28087 .endd
28088
28089 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28090 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28091 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28092 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28093
28094 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28095 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28096 variables. With the exception of &$spam_score_int$&, these are usable only
28097 within ACLs; their values are not retained with the message and so cannot be
28098 used at delivery time.
28099
28100 .vlist
28101 .vitem &$spam_score$&
28102 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28103 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28104
28105 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28106 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28107 example &"34"& or &"305"&. This is useful for numeric comparisons in
28108 conditions. This variable is special; its value is saved with the message, and
28109 written to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used during the whole
28110 life of the message on your Exim system, in particular, in routers or
28111 transports during the later delivery phase.
28112
28113 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
28114 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28115 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28116 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28117 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28118
28119 .vitem &$spam_report$&
28120 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28121 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28122 .endlist
28123
28124 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
28125 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
28126 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
28127
28128 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
28129 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
28130 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
28131 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
28132 spam condition, like this:
28133 .code
28134 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28135 spam = joe/defer_ok
28136 .endd
28137 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28138
28139 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28140 condition:
28141 .code
28142 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28143 warn spam = nobody:true
28144 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28145 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28146
28147 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28148 # is over threshold
28149 warn spam = nobody
28150 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28151
28152 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28153 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28154 spam = nobody:true
28155 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28156 .endd
28157
28158
28159
28160 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28161 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28162 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28163 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28164 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28165 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28166 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28167 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28168 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28169 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28170 cases.
28171
28172 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28173 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28174 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28175 message contains a &new(&'Content-Type:'&) header line. When a call to a MIME
28176 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
28177 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
28178 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
28179
28180 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
28181 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
28182 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
28183 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
28184 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
28185
28186 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
28187 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
28188 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
28189 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
28190 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
28191 syntax is:
28192 .display
28193 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
28194 .endd
28195 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
28196 the value can be:
28197
28198 .olist
28199 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
28200 .next
28201 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
28202 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
28203 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
28204 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
28205 .next
28206 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
28207 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
28208 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
28209 the full path and file name.
28210 .next
28211 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
28212 filename, and the default path is then used.
28213 .endlist
28214 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
28215 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
28216 a file with its original, proposed filename using
28217 .code
28218 decode = $mime_filename
28219 .endd
28220 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
28221 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
28222 automatically unlinked.
28223
28224 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
28225 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
28226 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
28227 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
28228 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
28229
28230 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
28231 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
28232 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
28233
28234 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
28235 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
28236 available in the MIME ACL:
28237
28238 .vlist
28239 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
28240 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
28241 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
28242 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
28243 contains the empty string.
28244
28245 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
28246 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
28247 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
28248 .code
28249 us-ascii
28250 gb2312 (Chinese)
28251 iso-8859-1
28252 .endd
28253 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
28254 case-insensitively.
28255
28256 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
28257 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
28258 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
28259 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
28260 only used for display purposes.
28261
28262 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
28263 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
28264 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
28265
28266 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
28267 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
28268 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
28269
28270 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
28271 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28272 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
28273 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
28274 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
28275
28276 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
28277 This variable contains the normalized content of the
28278 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
28279 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
28280
28281 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
28282 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
28283 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
28284 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
28285 .code
28286 text/plain
28287 text/html
28288 application/octet-stream
28289 image/jpeg
28290 audio/midi
28291 .endd
28292 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
28293 empty string.
28294
28295 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
28296 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28297 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
28298 containing the decoded data.
28299 .endlist
28300
28301 .cindex "RFC 2047"
28302 .vlist
28303 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
28304 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
28305 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
28306 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
28307 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
28308 found, this variable contains the empty string.
28309
28310 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
28311 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
28312 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
28313 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
28314
28315 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
28316 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
28317 follows:
28318
28319 .olist
28320 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
28321
28322 .next
28323 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
28324 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
28325
28326 .next
28327 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
28328 and the rest are attachments.
28329
28330 .next
28331 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
28332 .endlist olist
28333
28334 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
28335 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
28336 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
28337 .code
28338 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
28339 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
28340 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
28341 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
28342 .endd
28343 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
28344 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
28345 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
28346 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
28347 want to carry out specific actions on them.
28348
28349 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
28350 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
28351 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
28352 decoding is fully recursive.
28353
28354 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
28355 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
28356 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
28357 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
28358 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
28359 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
28360 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
28361 .endlist
28362
28363
28364
28365 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
28366 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
28367 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
28368 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
28369 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
28370
28371 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
28372 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
28373 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
28374 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
28375 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
28376
28377 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
28378 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
28379 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
28380 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
28381 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
28382 32K characters are checked.
28383
28384 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
28385 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
28386 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
28387 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
28388 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
28389 .code
28390 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
28391 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
28392 .endd
28393 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
28394 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
28395 matching regular expression.
28396
28397 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
28398 CPU-intensive.
28399
28400
28401
28402
28403 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
28404 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
28405 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28406 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
28407 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
28408 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
28409 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
28410 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
28411 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
28412 use the &%demime%& condition.
28413
28414 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
28415 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
28416 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
28417 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
28418 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
28419 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
28420
28421 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
28422 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
28423 example:
28424 .code
28425 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
28426 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
28427 .endd
28428 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
28429 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
28430 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
28431 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
28432
28433 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
28434 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
28435 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
28436
28437 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
28438
28439 .vlist
28440 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
28441 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
28442 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
28443 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
28444 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
28445 zero, no error occurred.
28446
28447 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
28448 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
28449 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
28450 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
28451 .endlist
28452
28453 .vlist
28454 .vitem &$found_extension$&
28455 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
28456 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
28457 extension it found.
28458 .endlist
28459
28460 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
28461 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
28462
28463 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
28464 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
28465 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
28466 facility:
28467 .code
28468 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
28469 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
28470 demime = *
28471 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
28472
28473 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
28474 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
28475 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
28476 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
28477
28478 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
28479 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
28480 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
28481 demime = exe:doc
28482 control = freeze
28483 .endd
28484 .ecindex IIDcosca
28485
28486
28487
28488
28489 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28490 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28491
28492 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
28493 "Local scan function"
28494 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
28495 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
28496 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
28497 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
28498 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
28499
28500 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
28501 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
28502 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
28503 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
28504 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
28505
28506 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
28507 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
28508 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
28509 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
28510
28511 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
28512 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
28513 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
28514 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
28515
28516 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
28517 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
28518 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
28519 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
28520 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
28521 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
28522 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
28523 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
28524 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
28525
28526
28527
28528 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
28529 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
28530 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
28531 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
28532 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
28533 directory, so you might set
28534 .code
28535 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
28536 .endd
28537 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
28538 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
28539 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
28540 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
28541 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
28542 _src/local_scan.c_.
28543
28544 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
28545 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
28546 .code
28547 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28548 .endd
28549 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
28550
28551
28552
28553
28554 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
28555 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
28556 You must include this line near the start of your code:
28557 .code
28558 #include "local_scan.h"
28559 .endd
28560 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
28561 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
28562 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
28563 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
28564 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
28565 strings and pointers to character strings:
28566 .code
28567 #define CS (char *)
28568 #define CCS (const char *)
28569 #define CSS (char **)
28570 #define US (unsigned char *)
28571 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
28572 #define USS (unsigned char **)
28573 .endd
28574 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
28575 .code
28576 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
28577 .endd
28578 The arguments are as follows:
28579
28580 .ilist
28581 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
28582 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
28583 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
28584
28585 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
28586 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
28587 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
28588 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
28589 case this changes in some future version.
28590 .next
28591 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
28592 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
28593 .endlist
28594
28595 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
28596
28597 .vlist
28598 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
28599 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
28600 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
28601 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
28602 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
28603 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
28604
28605 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
28606 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28607 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
28608
28609 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
28610 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28611 queued without immediate delivery.
28612
28613 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
28614 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
28615 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
28616 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
28617 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
28618 used.
28619
28620 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
28621 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
28622 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
28623 problem"& is used.
28624
28625 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28626 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
28627 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
28628 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
28629 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
28630 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
28631 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28632
28633 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28634 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
28635 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28636 .endlist
28637
28638 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
28639 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
28640 &%-oe%& command line options.
28641
28642
28643
28644 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
28645 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
28646 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
28647 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
28648 want to do this, you must have the line
28649 .code
28650 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28651 .endd
28652 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
28653 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
28654 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
28655 to define them.
28656
28657 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
28658 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
28659 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
28660 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
28661 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
28662 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
28663 .code
28664 static int my_integer_option = 42;
28665 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
28666
28667 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
28668 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
28669 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
28670 };
28671
28672 int local_scan_options_count =
28673 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
28674 .endd
28675 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
28676 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
28677 .code
28678 begin local_scan
28679 my_integer = 99
28680 my_string = some string of text...
28681 .endd
28682 The available types of option data are as follows:
28683
28684 .vlist
28685 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
28686 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
28687 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
28688 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
28689 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
28690 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
28691 values.)
28692
28693 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
28694 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
28695 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
28696 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
28697
28698 .vitem &*opt_int*&
28699 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
28700 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
28701 Exim.
28702
28703 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
28704 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
28705 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
28706 printed with the suffix K or M.
28707
28708 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
28709 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
28710 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
28711 always output in octal.
28712
28713 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
28714 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
28715 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
28716
28717 .vitem &*opt_time*&
28718 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
28719 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
28720 .endlist
28721
28722 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
28723 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
28724
28725
28726
28727 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
28728 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
28729 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
28730 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
28731 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
28732 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
28733 C variables are as follows:
28734
28735 .vlist
28736 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
28737 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
28738
28739 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
28740 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
28741
28742 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
28743 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
28744 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
28745 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
28746
28747 .ilist
28748 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
28749 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
28750 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
28751
28752 .next
28753 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
28754 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
28755 of debugging bits.
28756 .endlist ilist
28757
28758 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
28759 selected, you should use code like this:
28760 .code
28761 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28762 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28763 .endd
28764 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
28765 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
28766 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
28767
28768 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
28769 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
28770 discussed below.
28771
28772 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
28773 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
28774
28775 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
28776 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
28777
28778 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
28779 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
28780 &%-bh%& command line option.
28781
28782 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
28783 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
28784 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
28785
28786 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
28787 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
28788 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
28789 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
28790
28791 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
28792 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
28793 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
28794
28795 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
28796 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
28797
28798 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
28799 The number of accepted recipients.
28800
28801 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
28802 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
28803 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
28804 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
28805 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
28806 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
28807 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
28808 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
28809 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
28810 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
28811 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
28812 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
28813
28814 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
28815 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
28816
28817 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
28818 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
28819 locally-submitted messages.
28820
28821 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
28822 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
28823 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
28824
28825 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
28826 The name of the sending host, if known.
28827
28828 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
28829 The port on the sending host.
28830
28831 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
28832 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
28833
28834 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
28835 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
28836
28837 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
28838 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
28839 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
28840 .endlist
28841
28842
28843 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
28844 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
28845 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
28846 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
28847 their type to *.
28848
28849
28850 .vlist
28851 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
28852 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
28853
28854 .vitem &*int&~type*&
28855 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
28856 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
28857 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
28858 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
28859 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
28860 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
28861
28862 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
28863 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
28864 internal newlines.
28865
28866 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
28867 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
28868 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
28869 .endlist
28870
28871
28872
28873 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
28874 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
28875
28876 .vlist
28877 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
28878 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
28879
28880 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
28881 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
28882 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
28883 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
28884
28885 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
28886 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
28887 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
28888 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
28889 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
28890 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
28891 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
28892 is NULL for all recipients.
28893 .endlist
28894
28895
28896
28897 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
28898 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
28899 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
28900 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
28901 release:
28902
28903 .vlist
28904 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
28905 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
28906
28907 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
28908 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
28909 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
28910 for the process in &%newumask%&.
28911
28912 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
28913 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
28914 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
28915 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
28916 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
28917
28918 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
28919
28920 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
28921 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
28922 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
28923 return value is as follows:
28924
28925 .ilist
28926 >= 0
28927
28928 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
28929 ending status.
28930
28931 .next
28932 < 0 and > &--256
28933
28934 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
28935 signal number.
28936
28937 .next
28938 &--256
28939
28940 The process timed out.
28941 .next
28942 &--257
28943
28944 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
28945 .endlist
28946
28947 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
28948 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
28949 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
28950 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
28951 forks a subprocess that is running
28952 .code
28953 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
28954 .endd
28955 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
28956 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
28957 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
28958 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
28959
28960 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
28961 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
28962 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
28963 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
28964
28965
28966 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
28967 *sender_authentication)*&
28968 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
28969 that it runs is:
28970 .display
28971 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
28972 .endd
28973 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
28974
28975
28976 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
28977 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
28978 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
28979 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
28980 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
28981 .code
28982 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28983 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28984 .endd
28985
28986 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
28987 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
28988 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
28989 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
28990 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
28991 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
28992 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
28993 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
28994
28995 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
28996 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
28997 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
28998 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
28999 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
29000 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
29001
29002 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29003 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
29004 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
29005 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
29006
29007 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
29008 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
29009 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
29010 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
29011 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
29012 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
29013 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
29014 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
29015 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
29016 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
29017 .code
29018 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
29019 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
29020 .endd
29021 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
29022 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
29023
29024
29025 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
29026 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29027 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29028 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29029 match the specification, the function does nothing.
29030
29031
29032 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29033 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29034 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29035 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29036 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29037 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29038 .code
29039 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29040 .endd
29041 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29042 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29043 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29044 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29045 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29046 zero-terminated.
29047
29048 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29049 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29050 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29051 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29052 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29053 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29054 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29055 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29056
29057 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29058 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29059 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29060 .display
29061 &`OK `& match succeeded
29062 &`FAIL `& match failed
29063 &`DEFER `& match deferred
29064 .endd
29065 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29066 inability to contact a database.
29067
29068 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29069 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
29070 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29071 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29072 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29073
29074 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29075 BOOL&~caseless)*&"
29076 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29077 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29078 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29079
29080 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29081 uschar&~*list)*&"
29082 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29083 expected to be
29084 .code
29085 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29086 .endd
29087 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29088 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29089 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29090 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29091 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29092 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29093 failed.
29094
29095 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29096 *format,&~...)*&"
29097 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29098 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29099 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29100 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29101 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29102 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29103
29104
29105 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29106 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29107 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29108 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29109
29110 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29111 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29112 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29113 value afterwards. For example:
29114 .code
29115 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29116 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29117 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29118 .endd
29119
29120 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29121 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29122 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29123 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29124 address.
29125 .endlist
29126
29127
29128 .cindex "RFC 2047"
29129 .vlist
29130 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29131 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29132 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29133 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29134 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29135 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29136 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29137 binary string is returned with an error message.
29138
29139 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29140 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29141 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29142
29143 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29144 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29145 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29146 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29147 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29148
29149 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29150 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29151 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29152
29153 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29154 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29155 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29156 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29157 with translation.
29158
29159
29160 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29161 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29162 below.
29163
29164 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29165 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29166 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29167 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29168 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29169 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29170 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29171 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29172 is involved.
29173
29174 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29175 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
29176
29177 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
29178 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
29179 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
29180 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
29181 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
29182 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
29183 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
29184 .code
29185 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
29186 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
29187 .endd
29188 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
29189 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
29190 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
29191 multiple output lines.
29192
29193 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
29194 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
29195 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
29196 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
29197 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
29198 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
29199 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
29200 is an error.
29201
29202 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
29203 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
29204 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
29205 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29206
29207 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
29208 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
29209 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29210
29211 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
29212 See below.
29213
29214 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
29215 See below.
29216
29217 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
29218 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
29219 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
29220 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
29221 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
29222 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
29223 more discussion.
29224 .endlist
29225
29226
29227
29228 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
29229 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
29230 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
29231 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
29232 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
29233 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
29234 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
29235 terminates.
29236
29237 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
29238 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
29239 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
29240 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
29241
29242 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
29243 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
29244 .code
29245 store_pool = POOL_PERM
29246 .endd
29247 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
29248 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
29249 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
29250 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
29251
29252 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
29253 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
29254 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
29255 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
29256 &%store_pool%&.
29257 .ecindex IIDlosca
29258
29259
29260
29261
29262 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29263 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29264
29265 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
29266 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
29267 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
29268 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
29269 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
29270 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
29271 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
29272 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
29273
29274 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
29275 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
29276 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
29277 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
29278 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
29279
29280 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
29281 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
29282 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
29283 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
29284 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
29285 prevent it happening on retries.
29286
29287 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29288 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29289 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
29290 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
29291 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
29292 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
29293 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
29294 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
29295
29296
29297 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
29298 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
29299 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
29300 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
29301 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
29302 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
29303 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
29304 .code
29305 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
29306 system_filter_user = exim
29307 .endd
29308 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
29309 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
29310 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
29311 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
29312 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
29313 by the &%reply%& command.
29314
29315
29316 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
29317 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
29318 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
29319 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
29320
29321 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
29322 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
29323
29324
29325
29326 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
29327 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
29328 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
29329 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
29330 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
29331 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
29332 they cause errors.
29333
29334 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
29335 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
29336 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
29337 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
29338 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
29339 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
29340 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
29341
29342 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
29343 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
29344 succeed, it will not be tried again.
29345 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
29346 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
29347
29348 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
29349 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
29350 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
29351 to which users' filter files can refer.
29352
29353
29354
29355 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
29356 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
29357 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
29358 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
29359 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
29360
29361
29362
29363 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
29364 .cindex "freezing messages"
29365 .cindex "message" "freezing"
29366 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
29367 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
29368 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
29369 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
29370 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
29371 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
29372 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
29373 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
29374 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
29375 .code
29376 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
29377 .endd
29378 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
29379
29380 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
29381 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
29382 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
29383 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
29384 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
29385 run.
29386
29387 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
29388 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
29389 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
29390 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
29391
29392 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
29393 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
29394 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
29395 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
29396 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
29397 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
29398 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
29399 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
29400 message. For example:
29401 .code
29402 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
29403 because it contains attachments that we are \
29404 not prepared to receive."
29405 .endd
29406
29407 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
29408 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
29409 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
29410 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
29411 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
29412 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
29413 use, for example
29414 .code
29415 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
29416 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
29417 .endd
29418 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
29419 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
29420 generated by the filter.
29421
29422 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
29423 &%defer%&,
29424 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
29425 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
29426 as
29427 .code
29428 mail ...
29429 freeze
29430 .endd
29431 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
29432 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
29433 take place.
29434
29435
29436
29437 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
29438 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
29439 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
29440 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
29441 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
29442 .code
29443 headers add <string>
29444 headers remove <string>
29445 .endd
29446 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
29447 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
29448 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
29449 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
29450 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
29451
29452 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
29453 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
29454 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
29455 example:
29456 .code
29457 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
29458 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
29459 X-header-2: ...."
29460 .endd
29461 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
29462 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
29463 space after input continuations is ignored.
29464
29465 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
29466 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
29467 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
29468 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
29469 header with the same name, they are all removed.
29470
29471 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
29472 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
29473 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
29474 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
29475 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
29476 used for all recipients of the message.
29477
29478 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
29479 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
29480 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
29481 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
29482 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
29483 until the message is actually being written (see section
29484 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
29485
29486 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
29487 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
29488 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
29489 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
29490 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
29491 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
29492 modified more than once.
29493
29494 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
29495 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
29496 For example:
29497 .code
29498 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
29499 headers remove "Subject"
29500 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
29501 headers remove "Old-Subject"
29502 .endd
29503
29504
29505
29506 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
29507 .cindex "envelope sender"
29508 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
29509 .code
29510 errors_to <some address>
29511 .endd
29512 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
29513 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
29514 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
29515 might use
29516 .code
29517 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
29518 .endd
29519 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
29520 address if its delivery failed.
29521
29522
29523
29524 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
29525 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29526 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29527 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
29528 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
29529 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
29530 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
29531 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
29532 which implements such a filter:
29533 .code
29534 central_filter:
29535 check_local_user
29536 driver = redirect
29537 domains = +local_domains
29538 file = /central/filters/$local_part
29539 no_verify
29540 allow_filter
29541 allow_freeze
29542 .endd
29543 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
29544 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
29545 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
29546 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
29547
29548 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
29549 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
29550 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
29551 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
29552 normal way.
29553 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
29554 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
29555 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
29556
29557
29558
29559
29560
29561
29562 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29563 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29564
29565 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
29566 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
29567 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
29568 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
29569 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
29570 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
29571 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
29572 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
29573
29574 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
29575 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
29576 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
29577 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
29578 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
29579
29580 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
29581 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
29582 loopback interface specially in any way.
29583
29584 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
29585 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
29586
29587
29588
29589
29590 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
29591 .cindex "message" "submission"
29592 .cindex "submission mode"
29593 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
29594 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
29595 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
29596 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
29597 .code
29598 control = submission
29599 .endd
29600 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
29601 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
29602 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
29603 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
29604 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
29605 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
29606 .code
29607 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
29608 control = submission
29609 .endd
29610 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
29611 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
29612 is used to separate options. For example:
29613 .code
29614 control = submission/sender_retain
29615 .endd
29616 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
29617 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
29618 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
29619 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
29620 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
29621 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
29622 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
29623
29624 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
29625 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
29626 example:
29627 .code
29628 control = submission/domain=some.domain
29629 .endd
29630 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
29631 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
29632 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
29633 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
29634 .code
29635 accept authenticated = *
29636 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
29637 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
29638 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
29639 .endd
29640 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
29641 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
29642 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
29643 .code
29644 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
29645 .endd
29646 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
29647 line would be:
29648 .code
29649 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
29650 .endd
29651 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
29652 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
29653 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
29654 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
29655
29656 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
29657 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
29658 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
29659 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
29660 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
29661 spoof another's address.
29662
29663 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
29664 .cindex "line endings"
29665 .cindex "carriage return"
29666 .cindex "linefeed"
29667 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
29668 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
29669 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
29670 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
29671 use CRLF or just CR.
29672
29673 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
29674 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
29675 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
29676 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
29677 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
29678 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
29679 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
29680 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
29681 follows:
29682
29683 .ilist
29684 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
29685 .next
29686 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
29687 is ignored.
29688 .next
29689 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
29690 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
29691 terminator.
29692 .next
29693 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
29694 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
29695 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
29696 people trying to play silly games.
29697 .next
29698 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
29699 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
29700 line.
29701 .endlist
29702
29703
29704
29705
29706
29707 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
29708 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
29709 .cindex "address" "qualification"
29710 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
29711 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
29712 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
29713 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
29714 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
29715
29716 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
29717 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
29718 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
29719 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
29720 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
29721
29722 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
29723 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
29724 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
29725 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
29726 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
29727 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
29728 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
29729 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
29730
29731
29732
29733
29734 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
29735 .cindex "&""From""& line"
29736 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
29737 .cindex "sender" "address"
29738 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
29739 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
29740 .cindex "envelope sender"
29741 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29742 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
29743 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
29744 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
29745 .code
29746 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
29747 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
29748 .endd
29749 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
29750 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
29751 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
29752 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
29753 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
29754 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
29755 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
29756 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
29757 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
29758
29759 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
29760 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
29761 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
29762 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
29763 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
29764 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
29765 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
29766
29767 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
29768 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
29769 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
29770
29771 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
29772 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
29773 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
29774 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
29775
29776
29777
29778 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
29779 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
29780 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
29781 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
29782 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
29783 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
29784 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
29785
29786 .blockquote
29787 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
29788 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
29789 .endblockquote
29790
29791 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
29792 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
29793 follows:
29794
29795 .ilist
29796 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
29797 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
29798 .next
29799 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
29800 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
29801 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
29802 .next
29803 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
29804 also removed.
29805 .next
29806 For a locally-submitted message,
29807 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
29808 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
29809 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
29810 included in log lines in this case.
29811 .next
29812 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
29813 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
29814 .endlist
29815
29816
29817
29818
29819 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
29820 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
29821 includes the header line:
29822 .code
29823 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
29824 .endd
29825
29826 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
29827 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
29828 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
29829 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
29830 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
29831 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
29832
29833
29834 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
29835 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
29836 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
29837 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
29838 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
29839
29840 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
29841 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
29842 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
29843 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
29844 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
29845 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
29846 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
29847 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
29848 messages.
29849
29850
29851 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
29852 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
29853 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
29854 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
29855 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
29856 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
29857 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
29858 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
29859 messages.
29860
29861
29862 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
29863 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
29864 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29865 .cindex "message" "submission"
29866 .cindex "submission mode"
29867 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
29868 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
29869
29870 .ilist
29871 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
29872 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
29873 .next
29874 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29875 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
29876 .olist
29877 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29878 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
29879 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
29880 .next
29881 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
29882 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
29883 .next
29884 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
29885 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
29886 .endlist
29887 .endlist
29888
29889 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
29890
29891 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
29892 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
29893 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
29894 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29895 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
29896 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
29897 &%qualify_domain%&.
29898
29899 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
29900 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
29901 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
29902 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29903
29904
29905 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
29906 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
29907 .cindex "message" "submission"
29908 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
29909 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
29910 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
29911 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
29912 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
29913 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
29914 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
29915 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
29916 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
29917 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
29918
29919
29920 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
29921 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
29922 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
29923 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
29924 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
29925
29926 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
29927 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
29928 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
29929 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
29930
29931 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
29932 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
29933 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
29934
29935
29936 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
29937 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
29938 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
29939 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
29940 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
29941 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
29942 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
29943 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
29944 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
29945 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
29946 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
29947
29948
29949
29950 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
29951 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
29952 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
29953 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
29954 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
29955 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
29956 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
29957 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
29958
29959
29960
29961 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
29962 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
29963 .cindex "message" "submission"
29964 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
29965 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
29966 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
29967 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
29968 control setting.
29969
29970 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
29971 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
29972 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
29973 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
29974 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
29975 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
29976 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
29977 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
29978 line is added to the message.
29979
29980 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
29981 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
29982 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
29983 options true at the same time.
29984
29985 .cindex "submission mode"
29986 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
29987 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
29988 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
29989 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
29990
29991 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29992 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
29993 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
29994 created as follows:
29995
29996 .ilist
29997 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29998 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
29999 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30000 .next
30001 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
30002 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30003 .next
30004 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30005 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30006 .endlist
30007
30008 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
30009 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
30010 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
30011 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
30012
30013 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
30014 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
30015 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
30016 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
30017
30018
30019
30020 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
30021 "SECTheadersaddrem"
30022 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
30023 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
30024 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
30025 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
30026 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30027 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30028 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30029
30030 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30031 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30032 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30033 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30034 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30035 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30036
30037 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30038 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30039 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30040
30041 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30042 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30043 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30044 .code
30045 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30046 X-added-second: another added header line
30047 .endd
30048 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30049
30050 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30051 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30052 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30053 not part of the names. For example:
30054 .code
30055 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30056 .endd
30057 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30058 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30059 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30060 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30061 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30062
30063 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
30064 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30065 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30066 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30067
30068 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30069 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30070 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30071 requirements.
30072
30073 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30074 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30075 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30076 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30077 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30078 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30079 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30080
30081 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30082 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30083 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30084 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30085
30086 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30087 the following consequences:
30088
30089 .ilist
30090 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30091 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30092 to it, at all times.
30093 .next
30094 Header lines that are added by a router's
30095 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30096 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30097 .next
30098 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30099 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30100 .next
30101 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30102 a later router or by a transport.
30103 .next
30104 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30105 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30106 .code
30107 headers_remove = subject
30108 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30109 .endd
30110 .endlist
30111
30112 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30113 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30114
30115
30116
30117
30118
30119 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30120 .cindex "address" "constructed"
30121 .cindex "constructed address"
30122 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30123 the form
30124 .display
30125 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30126 .endd
30127 For example:
30128 .code
30129 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30130 .endd
30131 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30132 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30133 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30134 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30135 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30136 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30137 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30138 there is no password file entry.
30139
30140 .cindex "RFC 2047"
30141 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30142 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30143 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30144 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30145 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30146 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30147 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30148 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30149
30150
30151
30152 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30153 .cindex "case of local parts"
30154 .cindex "local part" "case of"
30155 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30156 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30157 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30158 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30159 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30160 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30161 router option.
30162
30163 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
30164 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30165 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30166 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30167 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30168 .code
30169 correct_case:
30170 driver = redirect
30171 domains = +local_domains
30172 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30173 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
30174 @$domain
30175 .endd
30176 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
30177 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
30178 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
30179 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
30180 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
30181
30182
30183
30184 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
30185 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
30186 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
30187 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
30188 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
30189 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
30190 empty components for compatibility.
30191
30192
30193
30194 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
30195 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
30196 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
30197 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
30198 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
30199 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
30200
30201 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
30202 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
30203 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
30204 example, a header such as
30205 .code
30206 To: hare@teaparty
30207 .endd
30208 might get rewritten as
30209 .code
30210 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
30211 .endd
30212 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
30213 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
30214 been routed.
30215
30216 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
30217 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
30218 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
30219 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
30220 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
30221 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
30222 .ecindex IIDmesproc
30223
30224
30225
30226 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30228
30229 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
30230 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
30231 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
30232 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
30233 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
30234 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
30235 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
30236
30237 .ilist
30238 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
30239 .next
30240 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
30241 .next
30242 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
30243 .endlist
30244
30245 For mail delivery, the following are available:
30246
30247 .ilist
30248 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
30249 .next
30250 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
30251 &"lmtp"&);
30252 .next
30253 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
30254 transport);
30255 .next
30256 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
30257 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
30258 .endlist
30259
30260 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
30261 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
30262 used to contain the envelope information.
30263
30264
30265
30266 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
30267 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
30268 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
30269 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
30270 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
30271 .cindex "EHLO"
30272 .cindex "HELO"
30273 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30274 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
30275 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
30276 processing is the same in both cases.
30277
30278 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
30279 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
30280 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
30281 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
30282 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
30283 .cindex "transport" "filter"
30284 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
30285 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
30286 suppressed.
30287
30288 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
30289 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
30290 required for the transaction.
30291
30292 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
30293 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
30294 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
30295
30296 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
30297 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
30298 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
30299
30300 .cindex "carriage return"
30301 .cindex "linefeed"
30302 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30303 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
30304 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30305 line terminator.
30306
30307 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
30308 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
30309 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
30310 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
30311 of the &%max_rcpts%& option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
30312 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpts%& addresses
30313 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
30314 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
30315 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
30316
30317 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
30318 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
30319 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
30320 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
30321
30322 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
30323 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
30324 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
30325 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
30326
30327 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
30328 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
30329 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
30330 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
30331 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
30332 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
30333 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
30334 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
30335 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
30336 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
30337
30338 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
30339 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
30340
30341 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
30342 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
30343 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
30344 square bracket of the IP address.
30345
30346
30347
30348
30349 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
30350 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
30351 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
30352 .cindex "host" "error"
30353 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
30354 message errors, and recipient errors.
30355
30356 .vlist
30357 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
30358 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
30359 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
30360
30361 .ilist
30362 Connection refused or timed out,
30363 .next
30364 Any error response code on connection,
30365 .next
30366 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
30367 .next
30368 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
30369 .next
30370 I/O errors at any time,
30371 .next
30372 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
30373 the &"."& at the end of the data.
30374 .endlist ilist
30375
30376 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
30377 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
30378 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
30379 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
30380 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
30381 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
30382 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
30383 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
30384
30385 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
30386 .cindex "message" "error"
30387 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
30388 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
30389 message errors are:
30390
30391 .ilist
30392 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
30393 the data,
30394 .next
30395 Timeout after MAIL,
30396 .next
30397 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
30398 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
30399 connection at any other time.
30400 .endlist ilist
30401
30402 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
30403 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
30404 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
30405 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
30406 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
30407 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
30408 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
30409 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
30410 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
30411 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
30412
30413 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
30414 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
30415 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
30416 response to MAIL.
30417
30418 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
30419 .cindex "recipient" "error"
30420 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
30421 recipient errors are:
30422
30423 .ilist
30424 Any error response to RCPT,
30425 .next
30426 Timeout after RCPT.
30427 .endlist
30428
30429 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
30430 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
30431 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
30432 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
30433 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
30434 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
30435 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
30436 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
30437 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
30438 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
30439 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
30440 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
30441 the retry clock is reset.
30442
30443 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
30444 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
30445 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
30446 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
30447 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
30448 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
30449 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
30450 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
30451 recipient's retry time.
30452 .endlist
30453
30454 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
30455 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
30456 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
30457 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
30458 until the next delivery attempt.
30459
30460 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
30461 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
30462 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
30463 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
30464 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
30465 is created.
30466
30467 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
30468 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
30469 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
30470 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
30471 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
30472 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
30473 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
30474
30475 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
30476 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
30477 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
30478 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
30479 then to be treated as a host error.
30480
30481 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
30482 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
30483 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
30484 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
30485 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
30486
30487
30488
30489
30490 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
30491 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
30492 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
30493 .cindex "inetd"
30494 .cindex "daemon"
30495 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
30496 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
30497 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
30498 .code
30499 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
30500 .endd
30501 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
30502 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
30503 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
30504 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
30505 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
30506 stream and exits with an error code.
30507
30508 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
30509 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
30510 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
30511 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
30512
30513 .cindex "carriage return"
30514 .cindex "linefeed"
30515 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30516 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
30517 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30518 line terminator.
30519 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
30520 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
30521 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
30522
30523 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
30524 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
30525 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
30526 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
30527 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
30528 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
30529 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
30530 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
30531
30532 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30533 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
30534 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
30535 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
30536 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
30537 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
30538 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
30539 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
30540 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
30541
30542 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
30543 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
30544 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
30545
30546 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
30547 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
30548 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
30549 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
30550 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
30551
30552 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
30553 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
30554 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
30555 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
30556 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
30557 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
30558 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
30559
30560 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
30561 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
30562 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
30563 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
30564 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
30565
30566 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
30567 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
30568 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
30569 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
30570 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
30571 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
30572 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
30573 a delivery process.
30574
30575 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
30576 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
30577 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
30578 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
30579 however, available with &'inetd'&.
30580
30581 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
30582 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
30583 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
30584 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
30585
30586 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
30587 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
30588 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
30589
30590
30591
30592 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
30593 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
30594 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
30595 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
30596 the error response to the last command. The default value for
30597 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
30598 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
30599 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
30600
30601
30602 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
30603 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
30604 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
30605 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
30606 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
30607 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
30608 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
30609 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
30610 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
30611 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
30612 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
30613
30614
30615
30616 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
30617 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
30618 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
30619 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
30620 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
30621 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
30622 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
30623 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
30624
30625 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
30626 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
30627 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
30628 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
30629 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
30630 counted.
30631
30632 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
30633 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
30634 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
30635
30636 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
30637 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
30638 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
30639 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
30640 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
30641
30642
30643
30644
30645 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
30646 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
30647 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
30648 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
30649 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30650
30651 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
30652 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
30653 called with the &%-bv%& option.
30654
30655 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
30656 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
30657 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
30658 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
30659 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
30660 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
30661 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
30662 RCPT failures.
30663
30664
30665
30666 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
30667 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
30668 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
30669 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
30670 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
30671 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
30672 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30673
30674 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
30675 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
30676 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
30677 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
30678 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
30679 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
30680 argument. For example,
30681 .code
30682 ETRN #brigadoon
30683 .endd
30684 runs the command
30685 .code
30686 exim -R brigadoon
30687 .endd
30688 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
30689 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
30690 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
30691 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
30692 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
30693
30694 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
30695 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
30696 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
30697 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
30698 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
30699 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
30700 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
30701 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
30702
30703 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
30704 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
30705 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
30706 whatever the form of its argument. For
30707 example:
30708 .code
30709 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
30710 $sender_host_address
30711 .endd
30712 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30713 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
30714 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
30715 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
30716 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
30717 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
30718 for it to change them before running the command.
30719
30720
30721
30722 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
30723 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
30724 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
30725 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
30726 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
30727 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
30728 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
30729 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
30730 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
30731 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
30732 runs for RCPT commands:
30733 .code
30734 accept hosts = :
30735 .endd
30736 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
30737
30738
30739
30740 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
30741 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
30742 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
30743 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
30744 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
30745 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
30746 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
30747 envelope along with the message.
30748
30749 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
30750 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
30751 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
30752 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
30753 can be used to specify it.
30754
30755 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
30756 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
30757 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
30758 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
30759 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
30760
30761 .vindex "&$host$&"
30762 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
30763 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
30764 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
30765 router:
30766 .code
30767 begin routers
30768 route_append:
30769 driver = manualroute
30770 transport = smtp_appendfile
30771 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
30772
30773 begin transports
30774 smtp_appendfile:
30775 driver = appendfile
30776 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
30777 batch_max = 1000
30778 use_bsmtp
30779 user = exim
30780 .endd
30781 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
30782 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
30783 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
30784
30785
30786
30787 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
30788 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
30789 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
30790 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
30791 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
30792 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
30793 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
30794 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
30795 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
30796 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
30797
30798 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
30799 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
30800
30801 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
30802 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
30803 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
30804 make some use of automatically, for example:
30805 .code
30806 554 Unexpected end of file
30807 Transaction started in line 10
30808 Error detected in line 14
30809 .endd
30810 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
30811 file, for example:
30812 .code
30813 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
30814 The error message was:
30815
30816 501 '>' missing at end of address
30817
30818 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
30819 The error was detected in line 12.
30820 The SMTP command at fault was:
30821
30822 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
30823
30824 1 previous message was successfully processed.
30825 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
30826 .endd
30827 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
30828 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
30829 accepted.
30830 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
30831 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
30832
30833
30834
30835 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30836 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30837
30838 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
30839 "Customizing messages"
30840 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
30841 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
30842 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
30843 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
30844 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
30845
30846 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
30847 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
30848 option. Exim also adds the line
30849 .code
30850 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
30851 .endd
30852 to all warning and bounce messages,
30853
30854
30855 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
30856 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
30857 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
30858 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
30859 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
30860 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
30861 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
30862
30863 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
30864 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
30865 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
30866 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
30867 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
30868 item.
30869
30870 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
30871 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
30872 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
30873 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
30874 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
30875 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
30876 option, rounded to a whole number.
30877
30878 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
30879
30880 .ilist
30881 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30882 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30883 .next
30884 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
30885 failing addresses with their error messages.
30886 .next
30887 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
30888 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
30889 .next
30890 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
30891 as part of the error report.
30892 .next
30893 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
30894 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
30895 .next
30896 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
30897 .endlist
30898
30899 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
30900 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
30901 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
30902 .code
30903 Subject: Mail delivery failed
30904 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30905 {: returning message to sender}}
30906 ****
30907 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30908
30909 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30910 {that you sent }{sent by
30911
30912 <$sender_address>
30913
30914 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
30915 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
30916 ****
30917 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
30918 ****
30919 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
30920 ------
30921 ****
30922 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
30923 only the first
30924 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
30925 ****
30926 .endd
30927 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
30928 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
30929 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
30930 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
30931 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
30932 text sections:
30933
30934 .ilist
30935 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30936 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30937 .next
30938 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
30939 the delayed addresses.
30940 .next
30941 The third item then ends the message.
30942 .endlist
30943
30944 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
30945 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
30946 .code
30947 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
30948 $warn_message_delay
30949 ****
30950 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30951
30952 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
30953 {that you sent }{sent by
30954
30955 <$sender_address>
30956
30957 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
30958 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
30959
30960 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
30961 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
30962 The date of the message is: $h_date
30963
30964 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
30965 ****
30966 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
30967 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
30968 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
30969 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
30970 the message will be returned to you.
30971 .endd
30972 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
30973 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
30974 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
30975 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
30976 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
30977 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
30978 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
30979 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
30980 handled them.
30981
30982
30983
30984
30985 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30986 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30987
30988 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
30989 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
30990 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
30991
30992
30993
30994 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
30995 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
30996 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
30997 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
30998 routing explicitly:
30999 .code
31000 send_to_smart_host:
31001 driver = manualroute
31002 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
31003 transport = remote_smtp
31004 .endd
31005 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
31006 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
31007 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
31008 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
31009 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
31010
31011
31012
31013
31014 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
31015 .cindex "mailing lists"
31016 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
31017 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
31018 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
31019
31020 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
31021 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
31022 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
31023 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31024 .code
31025 lists:
31026 driver = redirect
31027 domains = lists.example
31028 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31029 forbid_pipe
31030 forbid_file
31031 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31032 no_more
31033 .endd
31034 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31035 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31036 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31037 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31038
31039 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31040 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31041 a mailing list.
31042
31043 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31044 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31045 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31046 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31047 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31048
31049 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31050 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31051 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31052 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31053 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31054 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31055 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31056 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31057 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31058
31059
31060
31061 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31062 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31063 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31064 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31065 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31066 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31067 addresses are not rigorously checked.
31068
31069 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31070 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31071 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31072 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31073 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31074
31075
31076
31077 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31078 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31079 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31080 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31081 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31082 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31083 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31084 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31085 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31086 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31087
31088 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31089 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31090 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31091 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31092 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31093 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31094 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31095 pre-existing messages.
31096
31097 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31098 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31099 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31100 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31101 one level of expansion anyway.
31102
31103
31104
31105 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31106 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31107 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31108 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31109 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31110 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31111
31112 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31113 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31114 .code
31115 lists_request:
31116 driver = redirect
31117 domains = lists.example
31118 local_part_suffix = -request
31119 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31120 no_more
31121
31122 lists_post:
31123 driver = redirect
31124 domains = lists.example
31125 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31126 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31127 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31128 forbid_pipe
31129 forbid_file
31130 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31131 no_more
31132
31133 lists_closed:
31134 driver = redirect
31135 domains = lists.example
31136 allow_fail
31137 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31138 .endd
31139 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31140 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31141 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31142 mailing list.
31143
31144 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31145 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31146 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31147 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31148 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31149 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31150 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31151 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31152 &"unrouteable address"& error.
31153
31154 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31155 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31156 the address, giving a suitable error message.
31157
31158
31159
31160
31161 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31162 .cindex "VERP"
31163 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31164 .cindex "envelope sender"
31165 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31166 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31167 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31168 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31169 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31170 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31171
31172 .oindex &%errors_to%&
31173 .oindex &%return_path%&
31174 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31175 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
31176 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
31177 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
31178 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
31179 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
31180 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
31181 .code
31182 verp_smtp:
31183 driver = smtp
31184 max_rcpt = 1
31185 return_path = \
31186 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31187 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31188 .endd
31189 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
31190 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
31191 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
31192 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
31193 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
31194 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
31195 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
31196 rewritten as
31197 .code
31198 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
31199 .endd
31200 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31201 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
31202 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
31203 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
31204 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
31205 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
31206
31207 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
31208 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
31209 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
31210 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
31211 .code
31212 dnslookup:
31213 driver = dnslookup
31214 domains = ! +local_domains
31215 transport = \
31216 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31217 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
31218 no_more
31219 .endd
31220 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
31221 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
31222 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
31223 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
31224 address.
31225
31226 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
31227 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
31228 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
31229 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
31230 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
31231 .code
31232 verp_dnslookup:
31233 driver = dnslookup
31234 domains = ! +local_domains
31235 transport = remote_smtp
31236 errors_to = \
31237 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
31238 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31239 no_more
31240 .endd
31241 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
31242 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
31243 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
31244 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
31245 them.
31246
31247 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
31248 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
31249 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
31250 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
31251 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
31252 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
31253 used).
31254
31255
31256
31257
31258
31259
31260 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
31261 .cindex "virtual domains"
31262 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
31263 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
31264 meanings:
31265
31266 .ilist
31267 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
31268 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
31269 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
31270 .next
31271 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
31272 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
31273 have login accounts on that host.
31274 .endlist
31275
31276 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
31277 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
31278 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
31279 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
31280 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
31281 to a router of this form:
31282 .code
31283 virtual:
31284 driver = redirect
31285 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
31286 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
31287 no_more
31288 .endd
31289 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
31290 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
31291 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
31292 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
31293 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
31294 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
31295
31296 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
31297 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
31298 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
31299 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
31300
31301 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
31302 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
31303 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
31304 .code
31305 my_domains:
31306 driver = accept
31307 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
31308 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
31309 transport = my_mailboxes
31310 .endd
31311 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
31312 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
31313 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
31314 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
31315 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
31316 follows:
31317 .code
31318 my_mailboxes:
31319 driver = appendfile
31320 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
31321 user = mail
31322 .endd
31323 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
31324 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
31325
31326 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
31327 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
31328 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
31329 information about the domains.
31330
31331
31332
31333 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
31334 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
31335 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
31336 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
31337 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
31338 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
31339 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
31340 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
31341 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
31342 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
31343 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
31344 example, consider this router:
31345 .code
31346 userforward:
31347 driver = redirect
31348 check_local_user
31349 file = $home/.forward
31350 local_part_suffix = -*
31351 local_part_suffix_optional
31352 allow_filter
31353 .endd
31354 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
31355 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
31356 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
31357 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
31358 .code
31359 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
31360 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
31361 endif
31362 .endd
31363 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
31364 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
31365 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
31366 control over which suffixes are valid.
31367
31368 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
31369 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
31370 another MTA:
31371 .code
31372 userforward:
31373 driver = redirect
31374 check_local_user
31375 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
31376 local_part_suffix = -*
31377 local_part_suffix_optional
31378 allow_filter
31379 .endd
31380 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
31381 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
31382 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
31383 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
31384 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
31385
31386
31387
31388 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
31389 .cindex "vacation processing"
31390 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
31391 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
31392 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
31393 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
31394 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
31395
31396 .ilist
31397 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
31398 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
31399 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
31400 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
31401 .code
31402 spqr, vacation-spqr
31403 .endd
31404 .next
31405 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
31406 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
31407 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
31408 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
31409 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
31410 message.
31411 .endlist
31412
31413 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
31414 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
31415
31416
31417
31418 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
31419 .cindex "message" "copying every"
31420 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
31421 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
31422 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
31423 each day's messages.
31424
31425 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
31426 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
31427 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
31428 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
31429
31430
31431
31432 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
31433 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
31434 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
31435 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
31436 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
31437 permanently connected.
31438
31439 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
31440 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
31441 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
31442
31443
31444 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
31445 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
31446 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
31447 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
31448 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
31449 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
31450 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
31451 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
31452
31453 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
31454 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
31455 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
31456 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
31457 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
31458 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
31459 if required.
31460
31461 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
31462 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
31463 intermittent host. For example:
31464 .code
31465 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
31466 .endd
31467 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
31468 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
31469 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
31470 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
31471 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
31472 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
31473 immediately.
31474
31475 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
31476 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
31477 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
31478 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
31479 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
31480 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
31481 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
31482
31483
31484
31485 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
31486 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
31487 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
31488 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
31489 delivered immediately.
31490
31491 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31492 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
31493 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
31494 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
31495 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
31496 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
31497 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
31498 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
31499 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
31500 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
31501 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
31502 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
31503 single SMTP connection.
31504
31505
31506
31507 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31508 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31509
31510 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
31511 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
31512 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
31513 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
31514 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
31515 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
31516 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
31517 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
31518 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
31519 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
31520 messages this way.
31521
31522 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
31523 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
31524 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
31525 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
31526 email is not desirable.
31527
31528 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
31529 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
31530 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
31531 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
31532 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
31533 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
31534 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
31535
31536 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
31537 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
31538 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
31539 before sending a message to the smart host.
31540
31541 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
31542 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
31543 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
31544
31545 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
31546 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
31547 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
31548 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
31549 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
31550 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
31551 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
31552
31553 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
31554 following ways:
31555
31556 .ilist
31557 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
31558 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
31559 .next
31560 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
31561 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
31562 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
31563 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
31564 successful, a zero return code is given.
31565 .next
31566 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
31567 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
31568 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
31569 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
31570 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
31571 are.
31572 .next
31573 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
31574 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
31575 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
31576 .next
31577 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
31578 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
31579 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
31580 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
31581 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
31582 .next
31583 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
31584 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
31585 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
31586 .next
31587 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
31588 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
31589 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
31590 are ever generated.
31591 .next
31592 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
31593 .next
31594 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
31595 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
31596 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
31597 .endlist
31598
31599 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
31600 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
31601 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
31602 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
31603 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
31604 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
31605
31606
31607
31608
31609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31610 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31611
31612 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
31613 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
31614 .cindex "log" "types of"
31615 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
31616 and the panic log:
31617
31618 .ilist
31619 .cindex "main log"
31620 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
31621 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
31622 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
31623 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
31624 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
31625 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
31626 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
31627 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
31628 .next
31629 .cindex "reject log"
31630 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
31631 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
31632 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
31633 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
31634 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
31635 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
31636 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
31637 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
31638 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
31639 false.
31640 .next
31641 .cindex "panic log"
31642 .cindex "system log"
31643 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
31644 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
31645 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
31646 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
31647 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
31648 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
31649 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
31650 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
31651 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
31652 .endlist
31653
31654 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
31655 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
31656 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
31657 .code
31658 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
31659 by QUIT
31660 .endd
31661 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
31662 ways of changing this:
31663
31664 .ilist
31665 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
31666 you set
31667 .code
31668 timezone = UTC
31669 .endd
31670 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
31671 .next
31672 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
31673 example:
31674 .code
31675 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
31676 .endd
31677 .endlist
31678
31679 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
31680 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
31681 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
31682 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
31683 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
31684 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
31685
31686
31687
31688
31689 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
31690 .cindex "log" "destination"
31691 .cindex "log" "to file"
31692 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
31693 .cindex "syslog"
31694 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
31695 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
31696 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
31697 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
31698 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
31699 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
31700 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
31701
31702 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
31703 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
31704 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
31705 references to the host name:
31706 .code
31707 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
31708 .endd
31709 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
31710 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
31711 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
31712 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
31713 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
31714 log at all.
31715
31716 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
31717 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
31718 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
31719 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
31720 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
31721 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
31722 implying the use of a default path.
31723
31724 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
31725 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
31726 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
31727 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
31728 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
31729 equivalent to the setting:
31730 .code
31731 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
31732 .endd
31733 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
31734 logs are written.
31735
31736 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& if datestamped log file names are in
31737 use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
31738
31739 Here are some examples of possible settings:
31740 .display
31741 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
31742 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
31743 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
31744 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
31745 .endd
31746 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
31747 error is logged.
31748
31749
31750
31751 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
31752 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
31753 .cindex "cycling logs"
31754 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
31755 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
31756 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
31757 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
31758 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
31759 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
31760 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
31761
31762 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
31763 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
31764 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
31765 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
31766 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
31767 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
31768 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
31769 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
31770 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
31771 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
31772 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
31773 renamed.
31774
31775
31776
31777 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
31778 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
31779 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
31780 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
31781 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_&.
31782 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
31783 &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& at the point where the
31784 datestamp is required. For example:
31785 .code
31786 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
31787 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
31788 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
31789 .endd
31790 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
31791 examples of names generated by the above examples:
31792 .code
31793 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
31794 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
31795 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
31796 .endd
31797 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
31798 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
31799 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
31800 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
31801
31802 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
31803 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
31804 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& is removed from the string.
31805 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
31806 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
31807 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
31808 .code
31809 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31810 /var/log/exim-panic.log
31811 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31812 .endd
31813
31814
31815 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
31816 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
31817 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
31818 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
31819 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
31820 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
31821 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
31822 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
31823 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
31824 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
31825 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
31826 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
31827 the time and host name to each line.
31828 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
31829
31830 .ilist
31831 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
31832 .next
31833 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
31834 .next
31835 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
31836 .endlist
31837
31838 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
31839 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
31840 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
31841 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
31842
31843 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
31844 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
31845 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
31846 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
31847 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
31848 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
31849 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
31850 RFC 3164, you should set
31851 .code
31852 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
31853 .endd
31854 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
31855 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
31856
31857 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
31858 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
31859 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
31860 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
31861 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
31862 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
31863 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
31864 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
31865 name, and pid as added by syslog:
31866 .code
31867 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
31868 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
31869 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
31870 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
31871 [5/5] mple>)
31872 .endd
31873 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
31874 (LOG_NOTICE):
31875 .code
31876 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
31877 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
31878 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
31879 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
31880 [5\18] .example>)
31881 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
31882 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
31883 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
31884 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
31885 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
31886 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
31887 [12\18] F From: <>
31888 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
31889 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
31890 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
31891 [16\18] le>
31892 [17\18] B Bcc:
31893 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
31894 .endd
31895 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
31896 without modification.
31897
31898 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
31899 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
31900 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
31901 where it is.
31902
31903
31904
31905 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
31906 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
31907 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
31908 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
31909 timestamp. The flags are:
31910 .display
31911 &`<=`& message arrival
31912 &`=>`& normal message delivery
31913 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
31914 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
31915 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
31916 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
31917 .endd
31918
31919
31920 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
31921 .cindex "log" "reception line"
31922 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
31923 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
31924 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
31925 .code
31926 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
31927 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
31928 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
31929 .endd
31930 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
31931 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
31932 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
31933 .code
31934 R=<message id>
31935 .endd
31936 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
31937
31938 .cindex "HELO"
31939 .cindex "EHLO"
31940 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
31941 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
31942 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
31943 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
31944 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
31945 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
31946 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
31947 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
31948 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
31949 name in parentheses.
31950
31951 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
31952 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
31953 the log containing text like these examples:
31954 .code
31955 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
31956 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
31957 .endd
31958 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
31959 on.
31960
31961 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
31962 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
31963 of Exim.
31964
31965 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
31966 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
31967 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
31968 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
31969 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
31970 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
31971 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
31972 suite that was used.
31973
31974 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
31975 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
31976 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
31977 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
31978 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
31979 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
31980 authenticator name.
31981
31982 .cindex "size" "of message"
31983 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
31984 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
31985 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
31986 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
31987 other).
31988
31989 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
31990 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
31991
31992
31993
31994 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
31995 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
31996 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
31997 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
31998 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
31999 to fit it on the page:
32000 .code
32001 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
32002 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
32003 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
32004 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
32005 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
32006 .endd
32007 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
32008 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
32009 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
32010 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
32011 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
32012
32013 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
32014 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
32015 .display
32016 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
32017 .endd
32018 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
32019 parentheses afterwards.
32020
32021 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32022 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
32023 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
32024 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
32025 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
32026 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32027
32028 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32029 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32030
32031 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32032 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32033
32034
32035 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32036 .cindex "discarded messages"
32037 .cindex "message" "discarded"
32038 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32039 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32040 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32041 .code
32042 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32043 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32044 .endd
32045 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32046 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32047 .code
32048 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32049 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32050 .endd
32051
32052
32053 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32054 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32055 .code
32056 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32057 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32058 .endd
32059 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32060 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32061 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32062 .code
32063 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32064 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32065 .endd
32066 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32067 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32068 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32069
32070
32071
32072 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32073 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32074 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32075 following form is logged:
32076 .code
32077 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32078 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32079 .endd
32080 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32081 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32082 .code
32083 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32084 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32085 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32086 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32087 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32088 .endd
32089 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32090 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32091 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32092 flagged with &`**`&.
32093
32094
32095
32096 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32097 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32098 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32099 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32100 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32101
32102
32103
32104 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
32105 A line of the form
32106 .code
32107 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32108 .endd
32109 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32110 at the end of its processing.
32111
32112
32113
32114
32115 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32116 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32117 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32118 the following table:
32119 .display
32120 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32121 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32122 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32123 &`CV `& certificate verification status
32124 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32125 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32126 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32127 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32128 &`H `& host name and IP address
32129 &`I `& local interface used
32130 &`id `& message id for incoming message
32131 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32132 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32133 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32134 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32135 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32136 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32137 &`S `& size of message
32138 &`ST `& shadow transport name
32139 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32140 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32141 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32142 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
32143 .endd
32144
32145
32146 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32147 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32148 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32149
32150 .ilist
32151 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32152 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32153 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32154 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32155 during the first delivery attempt.
32156 .next
32157 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32158 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32159 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32160 .next
32161 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32162 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32163 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32164 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32165 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32166 doing.
32167 .next
32168 .cindex "error" "ignored"
32169 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
32170 message:
32171 .olist
32172 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
32173 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
32174 .next
32175 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
32176 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32177 .next
32178 A delivery set up by a router configured with
32179 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
32180 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
32181 .code
32182 errors_to = <>
32183 .endd
32184 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32185 .endlist olist
32186 .endlist ilist
32187
32188
32189
32190
32191
32192 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
32193 .cindex "log" "selectors"
32194 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
32195 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
32196 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
32197 example:
32198 .code
32199 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
32200 .endd
32201 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
32202 selection marked by asterisks:
32203 .display
32204 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
32205 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
32206 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
32207 &` arguments `& command line arguments
32208 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
32209 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
32210 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
32211 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
32212 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
32213 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
32214 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
32215 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
32216 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
32217 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
32218 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
32219 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
32220 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
32221 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
32222 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
32223 &` pid `& Exim process id
32224 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
32225 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
32226 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
32227 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
32228 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
32229 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
32230 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
32231 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
32232 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
32233 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
32234 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
32235 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
32236 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
32237 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
32238 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
32239 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
32240 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
32241 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
32242 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
32243 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
32244
32245 &` all `& all of the above
32246 .endd
32247 More details on each of these items follows:
32248
32249 .ilist
32250 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
32251 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
32252 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
32253 this log selector is set.
32254 .next
32255 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
32256 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
32257 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
32258 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
32259 such users cannot access the log).
32260 .next
32261 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
32262 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
32263 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
32264 parentheses between them.
32265 .next
32266 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
32267 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
32268 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
32269 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
32270 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
32271 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
32272 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
32273 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
32274 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
32275 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
32276 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
32277 between the caller and Exim.
32278 .next
32279 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
32280 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
32281 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
32282 .next
32283 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
32284 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
32285 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
32286 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
32287 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
32288 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
32289 .next
32290 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
32291 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
32292 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
32293 .next
32294 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
32295 .cindex "size" "of message"
32296 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
32297 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
32298 .next
32299 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
32300 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
32301 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32302 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
32303 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
32304 .next
32305 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
32306 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
32307 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
32308 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
32309 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
32310 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
32311 .next
32312 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
32313 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
32314 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
32315 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
32316 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
32317 .next
32318 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
32319 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
32320 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
32321 client's ident port times out.
32322 .next
32323 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
32324 .cindex "interface" "logging"
32325 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
32326 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
32327 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
32328 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
32329 rejection lines.
32330 .next
32331 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
32332 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
32333 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
32334 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
32335 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
32336 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
32337 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
32338 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
32339 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
32340 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
32341 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
32342 .next
32343 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
32344 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
32345 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
32346 .next
32347 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
32348 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
32349 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
32350 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
32351 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
32352 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
32353 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
32354 .next
32355 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32356 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32357 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
32358 immediately after the time and date.
32359 .next
32360 .cindex "log" "queue run"
32361 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
32362 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
32363 .next
32364 .cindex "log" "queue time"
32365 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
32366 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
32367 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
32368 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
32369 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
32370 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
32371 message has been successfully received.
32372 .next
32373 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
32374 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
32375 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
32376 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
32377 .next
32378 .cindex "log" "recipients"
32379 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
32380 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
32381 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
32382 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
32383 has taken place.
32384 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
32385 in the list.
32386 .next
32387 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
32388 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
32389 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
32390 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
32391 .next
32392 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
32393 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
32394 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
32395 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
32396 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
32397 .next
32398 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
32399 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
32400 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
32401 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
32402 attempt.
32403 .next
32404 .cindex "log" "return path"
32405 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
32406 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
32407 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
32408 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
32409 .next
32410 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
32411 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
32412 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
32413 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
32414 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
32415 .next
32416 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
32417 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
32418 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
32419 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
32420 detail is lost.
32421 .next
32422 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
32423 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
32424 it is too big.
32425 .next
32426 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
32427 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
32428 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
32429 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
32430 it.
32431 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
32432 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
32433 .next
32434 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
32435 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
32436 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
32437 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
32438 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
32439 response.
32440 .next
32441 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
32442 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
32443 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
32444 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
32445 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
32446 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
32447 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
32448 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
32449 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
32450 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
32451
32452 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
32453 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
32454 reset if the daemon is restarted.
32455 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
32456 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
32457 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
32458 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
32459 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
32460 .next
32461 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
32462 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
32463 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
32464 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
32465 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
32466 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
32467 .next
32468 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
32469 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
32470 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
32471 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
32472 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
32473 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
32474 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
32475 already have their own log lines.
32476
32477 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
32478 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
32479 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
32480 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
32481 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
32482 the same logging options.
32483
32484 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
32485 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
32486 .code
32487 C=EHLO,QUIT
32488 .endd
32489 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
32490 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
32491 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
32492 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
32493 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
32494 .next
32495 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
32496 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
32497 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
32498 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
32499 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
32500 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
32501 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
32502 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
32503 .next
32504 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
32505 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
32506 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
32507 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
32508 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
32509 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
32510 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
32511 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
32512 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
32513 .next
32514 .cindex "log" "subject"
32515 .cindex "subject, logging"
32516 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
32517 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
32518 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
32519 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
32520 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
32521 .next
32522 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
32523 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
32524 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
32525 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
32526 .next
32527 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
32528 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
32529 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32530 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
32531 .next
32532 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
32533 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
32534 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32535 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
32536 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
32537 .next
32538 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
32539 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
32540 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
32541 .endlist
32542
32543
32544 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
32545 .cindex "message" "log file for"
32546 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
32547 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
32548 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
32549 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
32550 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
32551 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
32552 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
32553 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
32554 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
32555 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
32556 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
32557
32558 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
32559 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
32560 &%message_logs%& option false.
32561 .ecindex IIDloggen
32562
32563
32564
32565
32566 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32567 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32568
32569 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
32570 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
32571 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
32572 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
32573 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
32574
32575 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
32576 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
32577 "list what Exim processes are doing"
32578 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
32579 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
32580 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
32581 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
32582 various criteria"
32583 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
32584 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
32585 "extract statistics from the log"
32586 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
32587 "check address acceptance from given IP"
32588 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
32589 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
32590 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
32591 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
32592 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
32593 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
32594 .endtable
32595
32596 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
32597 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
32598 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
32599
32600
32601
32602
32603 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
32604 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
32605 .cindex "process, querying"
32606 .cindex "SIGUSR1"
32607 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
32608 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
32609 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
32610 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
32611 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
32612 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
32613 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
32614 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
32615
32616 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
32617 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
32618 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
32619
32620
32621 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
32622 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
32623 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
32624 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
32625 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
32626 options:
32627 .display
32628 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
32629 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
32630 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
32631 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
32632 .endd
32633 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
32634 .code
32635 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
32636 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
32637 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
32638 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
32639 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
32640 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
32641 .endd
32642 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
32643 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
32644
32645
32646
32647 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
32648 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
32649 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
32650 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
32651 .code
32652 exim -bpu
32653 .endd
32654 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
32655 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
32656 options are available:
32657
32658 .vlist
32659 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
32660 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
32661 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
32662 .code
32663 exiqgrep -f '^<>$'
32664 .endd
32665 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
32666 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
32667 brackets.
32668
32669 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
32670 Match against the size field.
32671
32672 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32673 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
32674
32675 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32676 Match messages that are older than the given time.
32677
32678 .vitem &*-z*&
32679 Match only frozen messages.
32680
32681 .vitem &*-x*&
32682 Match only non-frozen messages.
32683 .endlist
32684
32685 The following options control the format of the output:
32686
32687 .vlist
32688 .vitem &*-c*&
32689 Display only the count of matching messages.
32690
32691 .vitem &*-l*&
32692 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
32693 the default.
32694
32695 .vitem &*-i*&
32696 Display message ids only.
32697
32698 .vitem &*-b*&
32699 Brief format &-- one line per message.
32700
32701 .vitem &*-R*&
32702 Display messages in reverse order.
32703 .endlist
32704
32705 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
32706
32707
32708
32709 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
32710 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
32711 .cindex "queue" "summary"
32712 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
32713 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
32714 running a command such as
32715 .code
32716 exim -bp | exiqsumm
32717 .endd
32718 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
32719 it, as in the following example:
32720 .code
32721 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
32722 .endd
32723 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
32724 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
32725 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
32726 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
32727
32728 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
32729 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
32730 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
32731 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
32732 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
32733 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
32734 sender.
32735
32736 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
32737 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
32738 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
32739 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
32740 level"& addresses).
32741
32742
32743
32744
32745 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
32746 "SECTextspeinf"
32747 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
32748 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
32749 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
32750 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
32751 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
32752 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
32753 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
32754 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
32755 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
32756 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
32757 .display
32758 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
32759 .endd
32760 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
32761
32762 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
32763 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
32764 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
32765
32766 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
32767 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
32768 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
32769 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
32770 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
32771
32772 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
32773 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
32774 regular expression.
32775
32776 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
32777 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
32778
32779 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
32780 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
32781 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
32782
32783
32784 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
32785 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
32786 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
32787 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
32788 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
32789 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
32790 the &%--help%& option.
32791
32792
32793 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
32794 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32795 .cindex "cycling logs"
32796 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32797 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
32798 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
32799 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
32800 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
32801 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
32802 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
32803 .ilist
32804 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
32805 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
32806 .next
32807 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
32808 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
32809 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
32810 configuration.
32811 .endlist
32812
32813 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
32814 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
32815 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
32816 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
32817 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
32818 logs are handled similarly.
32819
32820 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
32821 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
32822 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
32823 any existing log files.
32824
32825 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
32826 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
32827 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
32828 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
32829 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
32830 .code
32831 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
32832 .endd
32833 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
32834 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
32835
32836
32837
32838 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
32839 .cindex "statistics"
32840 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
32841 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
32842 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
32843 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
32844 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
32845
32846 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
32847 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
32848 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
32849 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
32850 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
32851 .code
32852 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
32853 .endd
32854 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
32855 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
32856 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
32857 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
32858 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
32859 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
32860 also produced per user.
32861
32862 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
32863 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
32864 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
32865 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
32866 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
32867
32868 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
32869 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
32870 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
32871 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
32872 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
32873 an entirely separate message.
32874
32875 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
32876 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
32877 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
32878 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
32879 least one address that failed.
32880
32881 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
32882 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
32883 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
32884 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
32885 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
32886 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
32887 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
32888
32889 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
32890 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
32891 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
32892
32893 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
32894 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
32895 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
32896 .code
32897 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
32898 .endd
32899
32900 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
32901 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
32902 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
32903 .cindex "checking access"
32904 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
32905 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
32906 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
32907 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
32908 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
32909 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
32910
32911 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
32912 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
32913 .code
32914 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
32915 .endd
32916 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
32917 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
32918 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
32919 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
32920 .code
32921 Rejected:
32922 550 Relay not permitted
32923 .endd
32924 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
32925 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
32926 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
32927 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
32928 you can use:
32929 .code
32930 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
32931 -f himself@there.example
32932 .endd
32933 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
32934 mandatory arguments.
32935
32936 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
32937 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
32938 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
32939
32940
32941
32942 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
32943 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
32944 .cindex "building DBM files"
32945 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
32946 .cindex "lower casing"
32947 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
32948 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
32949 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
32950 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
32951 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
32952 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
32953
32954 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
32955 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
32956 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
32957 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
32958 files.
32959
32960 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
32961 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
32962 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
32963 well.
32964
32965 .cindex "USE_DB"
32966 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
32967 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
32968 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
32969 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
32970 .code
32971 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
32972 .endd
32973 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
32974 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
32975
32976 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
32977 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
32978 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
32979 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
32980 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
32981 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
32982
32983 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
32984 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
32985 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
32986 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
32987 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
32988 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
32989 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
32990 return code is 2.
32991
32992
32993
32994
32995 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
32996 .cindex "retry" "times"
32997 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
32998 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
32999 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
33000 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
33001 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
33002 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
33003 output. For example:
33004 .code
33005 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
33006 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
33007 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33008 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33009 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
33010 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
33011 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
33012 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
33013 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
33014 past final cutoff time
33015 .endd
33016 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
33017 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
33018 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
33019 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
33020 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
33021 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
33022 run very often.
33023
33024 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
33025 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
33026 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33027 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33028 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33029 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33030
33031
33032
33033 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33034 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33035 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33036 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33037 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33038 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33039 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33040
33041 .ilist
33042 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
33043 .next
33044 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33045 for remote hosts
33046 .next
33047 &'callout'&: the callout cache
33048 .next
33049 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33050 .next
33051 &'misc'&: other hints data
33052 .endlist
33053
33054 The &'misc'& database is used for
33055
33056 .ilist
33057 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33058 .next
33059 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33060 &(smtp)& transport)
33061 .endlist
33062
33063
33064
33065 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33066 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33067 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33068 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33069 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33070 .code
33071 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33072 .endd
33073 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33074 .code
33075 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
33076 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33077 .endd
33078 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33079 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33080 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33081 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33082 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33083 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33084 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33085 and a textual description of the error.
33086
33087 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33088 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33089 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33090 exceeded.
33091
33092 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33093 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33094 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33095 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33096 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33097 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33098 cross-references.
33099
33100
33101
33102 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33103 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33104 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33105 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33106 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33107 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33108 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33109 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33110 updated sufficiently often.
33111
33112 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33113 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33114 the retry database:
33115 .code
33116 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33117 .endd
33118 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33119 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33120 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33121 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33122 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33123 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33124 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33125 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33126 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33127 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33128 whenever it removes information from the database.
33129
33130 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33131 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33132 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33133 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33134 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33135
33136 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33137 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33138 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33139 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33140 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33141 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33142 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33143 tidied.
33144
33145 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33146 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33147
33148
33149
33150
33151 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33152 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33153 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33154 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33155 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33156 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33157 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33158 displayed.
33159
33160 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33161 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33162 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33163 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33164 by new data, for example:
33165 .code
33166 > 4 951102:1000
33167 .endd
33168 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33169 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33170 used as optional separators.
33171
33172
33173
33174
33175 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
33176 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
33177 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
33178 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
33179 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
33180 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
33181 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
33182 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
33183 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
33184 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
33185 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
33186 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
33187 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
33188
33189 .vlist
33190 .vitem &%-fcntl%&
33191 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
33192
33193 .vitem &%-flock%&
33194 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
33195 supports it.
33196
33197 .vitem &%-interval%&
33198 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
33199 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
33200
33201 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
33202 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
33203
33204 .vitem &%-mbx%&
33205 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
33206
33207 .vitem &%-q%&
33208 Suppress verification output.
33209
33210 .vitem &%-retries%&
33211 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
33212 the lock (default 10).
33213
33214 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
33215 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
33216 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
33217 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
33218 subsequently sees.
33219
33220 .vitem &%-timeout%&
33221 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
33222 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
33223 default), a non-blocking call is used.
33224
33225 .vitem &%-v%&
33226 Generate verbose output.
33227 .endlist
33228
33229 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
33230 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
33231 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
33232 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
33233 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
33234 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
33235 more than 30 minutes old.
33236
33237 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
33238 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
33239 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
33240 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
33241 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
33242 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
33243
33244 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
33245 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
33246 suppresses all output except error messages.
33247
33248 A command such as
33249 .code
33250 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
33251 .endd
33252 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
33253 .display
33254 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
33255 <&'some commands'&>
33256 &`End`&
33257 .endd
33258 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
33259 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
33260 such as
33261 .code
33262 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
33263 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
33264 .endd
33265 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
33266 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
33267 .ecindex IIDutils
33268
33269
33270 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33271 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33272
33273 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
33274 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
33275 .cindex "X-windows"
33276 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
33277 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
33278 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
33279 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
33280 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
33281 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
33282 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
33283 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
33284
33285
33286
33287 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
33288 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
33289 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
33290 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
33291 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
33292 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
33293 parameters are for.
33294
33295 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
33296 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
33297 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
33298 .code
33299 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
33300 .endd
33301 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
33302 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
33303 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
33304 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
33305 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
33306
33307 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
33308 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
33309 .code
33310 Eximon*background: gray94
33311 .endd
33312 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
33313 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
33314 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
33315 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
33316 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
33317 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
33318 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
33319 .code
33320 xrdb -merge <<End
33321 Eximon*highlight: gray
33322 End
33323 .endd
33324 .cindex "admin user"
33325 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
33326 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
33327
33328 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
33329 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
33330 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
33331 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
33332 different parts of the display.
33333
33334
33335
33336
33337 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
33338 .cindex "stripchart"
33339 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
33340 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33341 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
33342 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
33343 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
33344 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
33345 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
33346 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
33347 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33348
33349 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
33350 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
33351 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
33352 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
33353
33354 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
33355 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
33356 to a single partition.
33357
33358 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
33359 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
33360 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
33361 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
33362 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
33363 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33364 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33365
33366
33367
33368
33369 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
33370 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
33371 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
33372 .cindex "window size"
33373 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
33374 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
33375 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
33376 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
33377 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
33378 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
33379
33380 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
33381 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
33382 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
33383 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
33384
33385 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
33386 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
33387 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
33388 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
33389 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
33390 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33391
33392 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
33393 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
33394 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33395
33396
33397
33398 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
33399 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
33400 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
33401 the main log is maintained.
33402 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
33403 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
33404 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
33405 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
33406 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
33407
33408 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
33409 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
33410 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
33411 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
33412 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
33413 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
33414 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
33415 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
33416 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
33417 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
33418 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33419
33420 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
33421 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
33422 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
33423 It cannot go further back up the log.
33424
33425 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
33426 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
33427 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
33428 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
33429 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
33430 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
33431
33432 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
33433 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
33434 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
33435 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
33436 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
33437 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
33438
33439 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
33440 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
33441 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
33442 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
33443 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
33444 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
33445 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
33446 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
33447 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
33448 window.
33449
33450
33451
33452 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
33453 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
33454 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
33455 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
33456 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
33457 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
33458 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
33459 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
33460 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
33461 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
33462
33463 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
33464 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
33465 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
33466 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
33467 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
33468 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
33469 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
33470
33471 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
33472 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
33473 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
33474 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
33475 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
33476 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
33477 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
33478
33479 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
33480 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
33481 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
33482 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
33483
33484 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
33485 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
33486 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
33487 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
33488 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
33489 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
33490 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
33491 not shown.
33492
33493 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
33494 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
33495
33496 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
33497 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
33498 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
33499 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
33500 display is updated.
33501
33502
33503
33504 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
33505 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
33506 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
33507 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
33508 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
33509 any selected text.
33510
33511 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
33512 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
33513 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
33514 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
33515 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
33516 .code
33517 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
33518 .endd
33519 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
33520 follows:
33521
33522 .ilist
33523 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
33524 in a new text window.
33525 .next
33526 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
33527 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
33528 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
33529 .next
33530 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
33531 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
33532 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
33533 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
33534 .next
33535 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
33536 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
33537 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
33538 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
33539 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
33540 .next
33541 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
33542 that the message be frozen.
33543 .next
33544 .cindex "thawing messages"
33545 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
33546 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
33547 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
33548 that the message be thawed.
33549 .next
33550 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
33551 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
33552 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
33553 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
33554 .next
33555 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
33556 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
33557 message.
33558 .next
33559 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
33560 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33561 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33562 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33563 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
33564 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
33565 which case no action is taken.
33566 .next
33567 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
33568 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33569 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33570 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33571 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
33572 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
33573 case no action is taken.
33574 .next
33575 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
33576 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
33577 .next
33578 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
33579 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
33580 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
33581 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
33582 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
33583 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
33584 the address is qualified with that domain.
33585 .endlist
33586
33587 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
33588 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
33589 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
33590 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
33591 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
33592 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
33593 if no output is generated.
33594
33595 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
33596 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
33597 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
33598 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
33599
33600 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
33601 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
33602 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
33603 .ecindex IIDeximon
33604
33605
33606
33607
33608
33609 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33610 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33611
33612 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
33613 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
33614 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
33615 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
33616
33617 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
33618 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
33619 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
33620 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
33621 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
33622 its security as compared with other MTAs.
33623
33624 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
33625 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
33626 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
33627 as soon as possible.
33628
33629
33630 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
33631 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
33632 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
33633 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
33634 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
33635 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
33636
33637 .ilist
33638 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
33639 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
33640 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
33641 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
33642 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
33643 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
33644
33645 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
33646 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
33647 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
33648 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
33649 .next
33650 If ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined, root privilege is retained for &%-C%&
33651 and &%-D%& only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
33652 also use &%-C%& and &%-D%& and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
33653 the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message
33654 reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
33655 that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
33656 privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost.
33657 However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
33658 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is not set by default.
33659 .next
33660 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
33661 is disabled.
33662 .next
33663 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
33664 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
33665 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
33666 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
33667 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
33668 .endlist
33669
33670
33671
33672
33673 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
33674 .cindex "setuid"
33675 .cindex "root privilege"
33676 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
33677 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
33678 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
33679 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
33680 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
33681 is required for two things:
33682
33683 .ilist
33684 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
33685 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
33686 not required.
33687 .next
33688 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
33689 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
33690 configuration.
33691 .endlist
33692
33693 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
33694 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
33695 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
33696 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
33697 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
33698 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
33699 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
33700 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
33701
33702 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
33703 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
33704 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
33705
33706 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
33707 uid and gid in the following cases:
33708
33709 .ilist
33710 .oindex "&%-C%&"
33711 .oindex "&%-D%&"
33712 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
33713 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
33714 calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
33715 changed to those of the calling process.
33716 However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, only
33717 root callers may use &%-C%& and &%-D%& without losing privilege, and if
33718 DISABLE_D_OPTION is set, the &%-D%& option may not be used at all.
33719 .next
33720 .oindex "&%-be%&"
33721 .oindex "&%-bf%&"
33722 .oindex "&%-bF%&"
33723 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
33724 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
33725 calling process.
33726 .next
33727 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
33728 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
33729 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
33730 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
33731 testing address verification
33732 .oindex "&%-bv%&"
33733 .oindex "&%-bh%&"
33734 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
33735 option).
33736 .next
33737 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
33738 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
33739 .endlist
33740
33741 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
33742
33743 .ilist
33744 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
33745 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
33746 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
33747 will be used during message reception.
33748 .next
33749 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
33750 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
33751 .next
33752 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
33753 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
33754 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
33755 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
33756 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
33757 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
33758 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
33759 generating bounce and warning messages.
33760
33761 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
33762 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
33763 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
33764 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
33765 .next
33766 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
33767 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
33768 .endlist
33769
33770
33771
33772
33773 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
33774 .cindex "privilege, running without"
33775 .cindex "unprivileged running"
33776 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
33777 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
33778 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
33779 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
33780 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
33781 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
33782 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
33783 to any other uid.
33784
33785 .cindex SIGHUP
33786 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
33787 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
33788 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
33789 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
33790
33791 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
33792 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
33793 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
33794 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
33795 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
33796
33797 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
33798 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
33799 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
33800 effect.
33801
33802 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
33803 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
33804 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
33805
33806 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
33807 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
33808 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
33809 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
33810 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
33811 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
33812 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
33813 address this problem at this time.
33814
33815 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
33816 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
33817 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
33818 be used in the most straightforward way.
33819
33820 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
33821 number of restrictions on what you can do:
33822
33823 .ilist
33824 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
33825 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
33826 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
33827 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
33828 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
33829 .next
33830 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
33831 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
33832 .next
33833 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
33834 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
33835 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
33836 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
33837 .next
33838 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
33839 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
33840
33841 .olist
33842 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
33843 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
33844 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
33845 .next
33846 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
33847 owned by the Exim user.
33848 .next
33849 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
33850 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
33851 mailboxes need to be created manually.
33852 .endlist olist
33853 .endlist ilist
33854
33855
33856 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
33857 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
33858 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
33859 gives more security at essentially no cost.
33860
33861 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
33862 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
33863
33864
33865
33866
33867 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
33868 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
33869 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
33870
33871
33872
33873 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
33874 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
33875 .cindex "IP source routing"
33876 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
33877 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
33878 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
33879 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
33880
33881
33882
33883 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
33884 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
33885 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
33886
33887
33888
33889
33890 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
33891 .cindex "trusted users"
33892 .cindex "admin user"
33893 .cindex "privileged user"
33894 .cindex "user" "trusted"
33895 .cindex "user" "admin"
33896 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
33897 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
33898 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
33899 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
33900 permit a remote host to be specified.
33901
33902 .oindex "&%-f%&"
33903 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
33904 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
33905 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
33906 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
33907 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
33908 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
33909
33910 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
33911 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
33912 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
33913 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
33914 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
33915
33916 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
33917 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
33918 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
33919 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
33920 includes the contents of files on the spool.
33921
33922 .oindex "&%-M%&"
33923 .oindex "&%-q%&"
33924 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
33925 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
33926 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
33927 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
33928 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
33929 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
33930
33931 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
33932 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
33933 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
33934 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
33935 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
33936 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
33937 files.
33938
33939
33940
33941 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
33942 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
33943 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
33944 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
33945 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
33946 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
33947
33948
33949
33950 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
33951 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
33952 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
33953 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
33954 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
33955 this.
33956
33957
33958
33959 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
33960 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
33961 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
33962 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
33963 converted output.
33964
33965
33966
33967 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
33968 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
33969 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
33970 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
33971 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
33972
33973
33974
33975 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
33976 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
33977 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
33978 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
33979 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
33980 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
33981 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
33982
33983 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
33984 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
33985 string.
33986
33987
33988
33989 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
33990 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
33991 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
33992 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
33993
33994
33995
33996 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
33997 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
33998 enough to hold the result.
33999 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
34000
34001
34002
34003
34004 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34005 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34006
34007 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
34008 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
34009 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
34010 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
34011 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
34012 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
34013 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
34014 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
34015 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
34016 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
34017 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
34018 themselves are recoverable.
34019
34020 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
34021 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
34022 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
34023
34024 .ilist
34025 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
34026 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34027 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34028 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34029 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34030 .next
34031 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34032 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34033 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34034 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34035 will always be the case.
34036 .next
34037 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34038 .next
34039 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34040 signature.
34041 .endlist
34042 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34043
34044 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34045 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34046 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34047 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34048 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34049 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34050 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34051 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34052 attempt.
34053
34054 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34055 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34056 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34057 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34058 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34059 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34060 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34061 normally the Exim user.
34062
34063 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34064 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34065 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34066 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34067 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34068 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34069 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34070 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34071
34072 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34073 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34074 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34075 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34076
34077 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34078 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34079
34080 .vlist
34081 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34082 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34083 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34084 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34085 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34086 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34087 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34088 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34089 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34090 newlines.
34091
34092 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34093 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34094 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34095 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34096 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34097 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34098
34099 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34100 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34101 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34102 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34103 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34104 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34105
34106 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34107 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34108 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34109
34110 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34111 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34112 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34113 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34114 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34115
34116 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34117 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34118 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34119 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34120 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34121
34122 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34123 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34124 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34125
34126 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34127 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34128 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34129
34130 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34131 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34132 present.
34133
34134 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34135 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34136 present if the number is greater than zero.
34137
34138 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34139 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34140 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34141
34142 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34143 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34144 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34145
34146 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34147 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34148 command.
34149
34150 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34151 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34152 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
34153 messages.
34154
34155 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
34156 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
34157 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
34158 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
34159
34160 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
34161 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
34162 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
34163
34164 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34165 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
34166 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
34167 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
34168 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
34169 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
34170
34171 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
34172 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
34173 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
34174 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
34175 supplied by the remote host, if any.
34176
34177 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34178 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
34179 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
34180 generated messages.
34181
34182 .vitem &%-local%&
34183 The message is from a local sender.
34184
34185 .vitem &%-localerror%&
34186 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
34187
34188 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
34189 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
34190 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
34191 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
34192
34193 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
34194 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
34195 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
34196
34197 .vitem &%-N%&
34198 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
34199 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
34200 &%-N%& is assumed.
34201
34202 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
34203 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
34204 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34205
34206 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
34207 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
34208 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
34209
34210 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
34211 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
34212 of &$spam_score_int$&.
34213
34214 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
34215 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
34216 certificate was verified by the server.
34217
34218 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
34219 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
34220 name of the cipher suite that was used.
34221
34222 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
34223 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
34224 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
34225 certificate.
34226 .endlist
34227
34228 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
34229 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
34230 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
34231 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
34232 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
34233 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
34234 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
34235 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
34236 addresses are complete.
34237
34238 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
34239 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
34240 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
34241 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
34242 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
34243 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
34244 .code
34245 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
34246 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
34247 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34248 .endd
34249 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
34250 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
34251 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
34252 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
34253 example:
34254 .code
34255 4
34256 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34257 darcy@austen.fict.example
34258 rdo@foundation
34259 alice@wonderland.fict.example
34260 .endd
34261 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
34262 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
34263 line is of the following form:
34264 .display
34265 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
34266 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
34267 .endd
34268 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
34269 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
34270 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
34271 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
34272 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
34273 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
34274 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
34275 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
34276
34277
34278 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
34279 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
34280 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
34281 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
34282 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
34283 following:
34284
34285 .table2 50pt
34286 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
34287 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
34288 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
34289 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
34290 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
34291 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
34292 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
34293 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
34294 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
34295 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
34296 .endtable
34297
34298 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
34299 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
34300 typical set of headers:
34301 .code
34302 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
34303 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34304 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
34305 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
34306 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
34307 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
34308 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
34309 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34310 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
34311 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34312 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34313 .endd
34314 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
34315 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
34316 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
34317 .ecindex IIDforspo1
34318 .ecindex IIDforspo2
34319 .ecindex IIDforspo3
34320
34321
34322
34323
34324 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34326
34327 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID12" &&&
34328 "Adding drivers or lookups"
34329 .cindex "adding drivers"
34330 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
34331 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
34332 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
34333 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
34334
34335 .olist
34336 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
34337 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
34338 .next
34339 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
34340 .display
34341 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
34342 .endd
34343 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
34344 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
34345 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
34346 .next
34347 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
34348 .code
34349 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
34350 .endd
34351 .next
34352 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
34353 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
34354 .next
34355 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
34356 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
34357 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
34358 .next
34359 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
34360 &_src_&.
34361 .next
34362 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
34363 as for other drivers and lookups.
34364 .endlist
34365
34366 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
34367 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
34368 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
34369 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
34370 searched using a binary chop procedure.
34371
34372 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
34373 the interface that is expected.
34374
34375
34376
34377
34378 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34379 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34380
34381 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34382 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
34383 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
34384 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
34385 . processors.
34386 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34387
34388 .literal xml
34389 <?sdop
34390 format="newpage"
34391 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
34392 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
34393 ?>
34394 .literal off
34395
34396 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
34397 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
34398 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
34399
34400
34401 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34402 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////